Standards of Transfusion Medicine

Transcription

Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Società Italiana di
Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
iz
i
SIMTI
M
TI
Se
rv
Standards
of
Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
SI
June 2010
©
Editorial board
P. Bonomo, G. Alfano, G. Gandini, G. Garozzo,
I. Menichini, I. Tomasini, G. Grazzini
Edizioni SIMTI
1
1
©
M
TI
SI
Se
rv
iz
i
©
SI
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
I
II
©
M
TI
SI
Se
rv
iz
i
Società Italiana di
Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Se
rv
iz
i
SIMTI
M
TI
Standards
of
Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
SI
June 2010
©
Editorial board
P. Bonomo, G. Alfano, G. Gandini, G. Garozzo,
I. Menichini, I. Tomasini, G. Grazzini
Edizioni SIMTI
III
iz
i
Se
rv
M
TI
SI
©
© Copyright SIMTI Servizi Srl - Via Desiderio, 21 - 20131 Milano (Italy)
All right reserved. No part of this book may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means,
electronic or mechanical, including photocopying, recording or by any information storage and retrieval
system, without permission in writing from the Publisher.
1st Edition November 2010
IV
Editorial group
iz
i
Pietro Bonomo (Coordinator)
Generoso Alfano
Giorgio Gandini
Giovanni Garozzo
Ivana Tomasini
Ivana Menichini (Necstep Srl)
Giuliano Grazzini
Reviewers
Se
rv
Giuseppe Aprili, Vincenzo De Angelis, Gabriella Girelli, Mauro Girotto, Michela
Macrì, Anna Lucia Massaro, Mario Piani, Paolo Rebulla, Claudio Velati.
Regional SIMTI Delegate Reviewers
M
TI
Giuseppe Curciarello, Alba Giovanna D’Agosta, Augusto D’Angiolino, Luigi Dell’Orso,
Giuseppina Facco, Francesco Fiorin, Ivo Gentilini, Maria Antonietta Lupi, Francesco
Paolo Maccarione, Antonio Minerva, Maria Pafundi, Eugenio Peres, Mirella Perluzzo,
Anna Reina, Gina Rossetti, Gianpaolo Russi, Augusto Scaccetti, Luca Sciariada,
Sebastiano Sofi, Vivianna Totis, Franca Tousco.
Reviewers for the Coordinamento Interassociativo Volontari Italiani Sangue
(Joint Committee for the Italian Associations of Blood Donors, CIVIS)
SI
Vincenzo Saturni (AVIS National President)
Aldo Ozino Caligaris (FIDAS National President)
Luigi Cardini (FRATRES National President)
Maria Vittoria Torresi (Italian Red Cross Blood Donors National Inspector)
Validation
©
SIMTI Board of Directors
President: Giuseppe Aprili
Validation coordinators: Giuseppe Aprili, Pietro Bonomo
Organisational support
SIMTI National Secretariat
Manager: Roberta Frisenda
Via Principe Amedeo, 149/d
00185 Roma
www.simti.it
V
VI
©
M
TI
SI
Se
rv
iz
i
PREFACE
The publication of the Transfusion Medicine Standards marks one of the most
important steps in the cultural, ethical and professional advancement of the Italian
Society for Transfusion Medicine and Immunohaematology (Società Italiana di
Medicina Trasfusionale e di Immunoematologia; SIMTI) and of the Italian blood
system as a whole.
Se
rv
iz
i
The work of preparing and revising this document involved not only the scientific
society, but also the other components of the blood system, especially the
institutions and voluntary associations. This enabled the scientific community to
provide professionals operating in this sector with explicit reference material for
the professional, organizational and management requirements that they need to
meet in order to fulfil their mission.
The cultural and professional growth of a discipline such as Transfusion Medicine
- characterised by an ongoing, lively expansion and a constant need to improve
its products and services - demands the capacity to analyse and reconsider one’s
actions continuously and critically, comparing them with the various other ways in
which the same principles are applied elsewhere around the world.
M
TI
This was the premise behind SIMTI’s commitment to this translation project,
which benefited from a great deal of support from Immucor (which took care
of the organizational issues): the purpose of creating an English version of the
Standards is to enable this document to become known internationally, and
consequently be submitted to expert comparison and constructive criticism.
Given the particular way in which the transfusion system works in Italy, it seems a
good idea to provide a brief account of the organizational and institutional model
on which it is based.
©
SI
In Italy, the blood system is run under an entirely public governance scheme. Blood
collection, testing, processing, storage and distribution, as well as transfusion
medicine services, are recognized as “essential healthcare services” (LEA - “Livelli
Essenziali di Assistenza”), to be homogeneously delivered nationwide - equitably,
impartially and free of charge to any citizen needing them. Blood establishments
(BEs) are exclusively public and hospital-based. Most of them are organized in
large blood departments and are locally coordinated by Regional Blood Centres
(RBCs) operating in the 21 Regions whose health authorities are appointed by law
to deliver healthcare services with a considerable degree of autonomy within the
comprehensive national framework of welfare and healthcare governance. The
National Blood Centre – designated as the competent authority operating on behalf
of the Ministry of Health - coordinates and supervises the 21 RBCs, with the goal
of guaranteeing blood and blood product self-sufficiency and a homogeneous and
standardized application of national and European blood regulations throughout
the blood supply and transfusion chain, particularly as concerns quality and
safety. Voluntary, anonymous, non-remunerated blood donation is recognized as
a strategic issue of the National Health Service and the social value and strategic
role of qualified associations and federations of voluntary blood donors are
institutionally recognized. The promotion and development of blood and blood
component donation is recognized as an “essential healthcare service” (LEA) and
the associations and federations of voluntary blood donors participate by law in
the institutional framework of the national and regional blood network. Blood
VII
and blood component collection can be outsourced to specifically licensed and
accredited, qualified blood donor associations under the technical supervision and
responsibility of BEs. In Italy, blood and blood components may not generate
any financial gains, in accordance with the national transposition of the European
principles and conventions on human rights and biomedicine.
Claudio Velati
Presidente SIMTI
©
SI
M
TI
Se
rv
Giuliano Grazzini
Direttore Centro Nazionale Sangue
iz
i
The English text coincides with the second edition of the Standards, published
in Italian in 2010. The next revision of the Standards will hopefully also draw
inspiration from constructive exchanges with experts in other countries, who are
sure to be able to enrich the Italian experience in this field.
VIII
PRINCIPAL CHANGES IN THE SECOND EDITION
INTRODUCTION
The “Definitions” and “References” have been revised.
SECTION A - GENERAL ORGANISATIONAL REQUIREMENTS
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Addition of a Standard
Changes to the title of the paragraph and related introduction
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the title of the paragraph and related introduction
Addition of a Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Standard
Addition of a Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the title of the paragraph
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the title of the paragraph
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Addition of a Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Addition of a paragraph and the related Standard and Application guidelines
Changes to the Foreword and text, Tables of professional skills
SI
A.1.1.1.1
A.1.2.2
A.2.1.1
A.2.2.1.3
A.4.2
A.4.2.1
A.4.3
A.4.3.1
A.4.3.2
A.4.3.5
A.5.1.1
A.5.1.2.1
A.5.1.4
A.6.3
A.6.3.1
A.6.4
A.6.4.1
A.6.4.1.2
A.6.4.2
A.6.6.1
A.8
Annex 1
SECTION B - COLLECTION OF BLOOD AND BLOOD COMPONENTS
©
/
B.1.2
B.2.2.1
B.2.2.1.3
B.2.2.1.5
B.3.3.1.6
B.4.3
B.4.5
B.5
B.6.3
B.7.1
B.8.6
B.8.7
B.9
B.9
Addition of an introduction to the Section
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Addition of a paragraph and the related Standard and Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Omission of Indicator n. 3 in the previous Edition
Changes to Indicator n. 10 in the current Edition
IX
SECTION C - PRODUCTION, QUALIFICATION AND BIOLOGICAL VALIDATION
OF BLOOD COMPONENTS
Se
rv
iz
i
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Addition of a Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Omission of Indicator n. 3 in the previous Edition
M
TI
C.1.1.1
C.1.1.3
C.1.1.3.1
C.1.1.3.2
C.1.1.3.6
C.1.1.3.7
C.1.2.2
C.1.2.2.1
C.1.2.2.3
C.1.2.2.4
C.1.2.2.5
C.2.1
C.2.1.1
C.2.2
C.2.2.1
C.3.1
C.4.1
C.5.1
C.6.1
C.6.2.1
C.6.2.6
C.7
SECTION D - ALLOCATION AND DISTRIBUTION OF ALLOGENEIC BLOOD
COMPONENTS
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
to
to
to
to
to
to
to
to
to
to
to
to
to
to
the
the
the
the
the
the
the
the
the
the
the
the
the
the
Application guidelines
Application guidelines
Application guidelines
Application guidelines
Standard and related Application
Application guidelines
Application guidelines
Application guidelines
Standard and related Application
title of the paragraph
Standard and related Application
Application guidelines
Standard and related Application
Standard and related Application
©
SI
D.1.1.1
D.1.2.6
D.1.2.7
D.3.1.1
D.4.1
D.4.1.2
D.4.1.7
D.4.2.5
D.5.1
D.6
D.6.1
D.7.1
D.8.1.2.2
D.8.2.1
X
guidelines
guidelines
guidelines
guidelines
guidelines
SECTION E - LABORATORY DIAGNOSTIC ACTIVITIES
iz
i
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Standard and related Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Addition of Process control indicators n. 4 and n. 5 in the current Edition
Changes to the Process control indicator n. 9 in the current Edition
Se
rv
E.1.1
E.2.1.1
E.2.2.2.2
E.2.4.1
E.2.5.1
E.2.6.1
E.3.1.1
E.3.2.2
E.3.3.2
E.4.1
E.6.1
E.7
E.7
SECTION F - AUTOTRANSFUSION
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
Changes
to
to
to
to
to
to
to
the
the
the
the
the
the
the
Application guidelines
Application guidelines
Application guidelines
Application guidelines
Application guidelines
Standard and related Application guidelines
Standard and related Application guidelines
M
TI
F.2.1
F.2.1.1
F.2.2.3
F.2.2.4
F.2.2.5
F.2.2.7
F.2.3
SECTION G - COLLECTION OF HAEMOPOIETIC STEM CELLS AND OTHER
CLINICAL ACTIVITIES IN TRANSFUSION MEDICINE
Changes to the title of the Section
Changes to the Application guidelines
Changes to the Application guidelines
Addition of a chapter and the related Standard and Application guidelines
Changes to the title of the paragraph
Changes to the Application guidelines
Addition of Process control indicators n. 5 and n. 6 in the current Edition
©
SI
/
G.2.1.2
G.2.1.6
G.3
G.4
G.4.3
G.5
XI
CONTENTS
INTRODUCTION
APPLICABILITY OF THE STANDARDS
.............................................................................................
XVII
................................................
XVII
DEFINITIONS
.....................................................................................................................................................
XVIII
REFERENCES
......................................................................................................................................................
XXV
TECHNICAL-SCIENTIFIC REFERENCES
iz
i
GUIDE TO THE INTERPRETATION OF THE STANDARDS
.........................................................................
Se
rv
TRANSFUSION MEDICINE STANDARDS
XXV
SECTION A - GENERAL ORGANISATIONAL REQUIREMENTS
A.1
.....................................................................
3
.................................................................................
3
...............................................................................................................
6
ELEMENTS OF MANAGEMENT STRATEGY
A.1.1 POLICIES AND OBJECTIVES
A.1.2 ORGANISATION
A.2
MANAGEMENT OF DOCUMENTS AND DATA
...............................................................
M
TI
A.2.1 MANAGEMENT OF PRESCRIPTIVE DOCUMENTS
..................................
MANAGEMENT OF HUMAN RESOURCES
9
........................................................................
12
A.3.1 MAINTENANCE, DEVELOPMENT
AND ASSESSMENT OF THE PERSONNEL’S SKILLS
A.3.2 OPERATOR SAFETY
............................
12
.......................................................................................................
14
MANAGEMENT OF TECHNOLOGIES
...................................................................................
15
A.4.1 MANAGEMENT OF SYSTEMS, EQUIPMENT
AND INSTRUMENTS .....................................................................................................
15
A.4.2 MANAGEMENT OF EQUIPMENT USED
FOR THE STORAGE OF BLOOD, BLOOD COMPONENTS
AND HAEMATOPOIETIC STEM CELLS ............................................................
18
A.4.3 MANAGEMENT OF
INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY (IT) SYSTEMS
.........................................
19
...............................................
21
...............................................................................................
22
©
SI
A.4
A.4.4 RECONDITIONING OF MEDICAL DEVICES
A.5
MANAGEMENT OF MATERIALS
A.5.1 QUALIFICATION, CONTROL AND STORAGE OF MATERIALS
XII
7
............................
A.2.2 MANAGEMENT OF QUALITY DATA AND RECORDS
A.3
6
.....
22
PROCESS MANAGEMENT
............................................................................................................
...................................................................................................
25
26
A.6.3 STORAGE OF BLOOD, BLOOD COMPONENTS
AND HAEMATOPOIETIC STEM CELLS ............................................................
28
A.6.4 PACKAGING AND TRANSPORTATION OF BLOOD, BLOOD
COMPONENTS AND HAEMATOPOIETIC STEM CELLS .......................
29
A.6.5 IDENTIFICATION AND TRACEABILITY
.........................................................
31
A.6.6 MANAGEMENT OF ORGANISATIONAL AND TECHNOLOGICAL
EMERGENCIES ..................................................................................................................
32
QUALITY MONITORING, ANALYSIS AND IMPROVEMENT
................................
33
.............................................................................................
33
iz
i
A.7
25
A.6.2 QUALITY CONTROL ON THE PROCESSES, PRODUCTS
AND SERVICES, AND MANAGEMENT OF NON CONFORMITIES .....
A.6.1 PROCESS PLANNING
Se
rv
A.6
A.7.1 QUALITY MONITORING
A.7.2 CORRECTIVE AND PREVENTIVE ACTIONS
...............................................
36
A.8
INFORMATION REPORTING
......................................................................................................
37
A.9
PARTICIPATION AS PARTNERS IN RESEARCH
AND DEVELOPMENT SCHEMES .............................................................................................
38
A.9.1 RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT PARTNERSHIPS
38
...............................
M
TI
ANNEX 1 - PROFESSIONAL SKILLS OF HEALTH-CARE PERSONNEL
....................
39
SECTION B - COLLECTION OF BLOOD AND BLOOD COMPONENTS
PROGRAMMING THE COLLECTION OF BLOOD
AND BLOOD COMPONENTS .....................................................................................................
50
B.2
MANAGEMENT OF DONORS OF BLOOD AND BLOOD
COMPONENTS .....................................................................................................................................
52
B.2.1 AWARENESS, INFORMATION AND EDUCATION OF DONORS
OF BLOOD AND BLOOD COMPONENTS .......................................................
52
B.2.2 SELECTION OF DONORS OF BLOOD
AND BLOOD COMPONENTS ...................................................................................
54
B.2.3 MANAGEMENT OF DEFERRED DONORS
......................................................
60
WHOLE BLOOD COLLECTION AND APHERESIS
......................................................
63
©
SI
B.1
B.3
B.3.1 PREPARATION AND CONTROL OF MATERIALS
AND INSTRUMENTS FOR COLLECTING WHOLE BLOOD
...............
63
B.3.2 PREPARATION AND CONTROL OF MATERIALS
AND INSTRUMENTS USED FOR APHERESIS .........................................
64
B.3.3 WHOLE BLOOD COLLECTION AND APHERESIS PROCEDURES
66
.....
XIII
B.4
DONOR CARE DURING WHOLE BLOOD COLLECTION
AND APHERESIS PROCEDURES ...........................................................................................
70
B.5
DONOR HAEMOVIGILANCE
72
B.6
DIAGNOSTIC INVESTIGATIONS CONDUCTED FOR EVERY DONATION,
AT REGULAR INTERVALS, AND IN PARTICULAR SITUATIONS ...................
73
B.7
MANAGEMENT OF DONORS’ DATA
75
B.8
REGULATION AND CONTROL OF ACTIVITIES
AT BLOOD COLLECTION SITES .............................................................................................
77
B.9
PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
82
......................................................................................................
iz
i
.....................................................................................
Se
rv
......................................................................................
SECTION C - PRODUCTION, BIOLOGICAL QUALIFICATION
AND VALIDATION OF BLOOD COMPONENTS
C.1
PRODUCTION OF ALLOGENEIC BLOOD COMPONENTS
FROM WHOLE BLOOD AND BY APHERESIS ................................................................
86
C.1.1 PRODUCTION OF “1 -LEVEL” BLOOD COMPONENTS
........................
86
C.1.2 PRODUCTION OF “2nd-LEVEL” BLOOD COMPONENTS
.......................
91
...............................................................................
96
C.3
PRODUCTION OF BLOOD COMPONENTS FOR USES OTHER
THAN TRANSFUSION .....................................................................................................................
98
C.4
IDENTIFICATION AND TRACEABILITY OF BLOOD
AND BLOOD COMPONENTS .....................................................................................................
99
st
M
TI
FREEZING AND THAWING OF RBC
AND PLATELETS FOR TRANSFUSION
SI
C.2
QUALITY CONTROL ON BLOOD COMPONENTS
C.6
BIOLOGICAL QUALIFICATION AND VALIDATION
OF ALLOGENEIC BLOOD COMPONENTS ........................................................................ 102
©
C.5
C.7
PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
.......................................................
......................................................................................
100
107
SECTION D - ALLOCATION AND DISTRIBUTION
OF ALLOGENEIC BLOOD COMPONENTS
110
D.1
INFORMATION FOR USERS
D.2
ACCEPTING TRANSFUSION REQUESTS
D.3
ASSESSING THE APPROPRIATENESS OF TRANSFUSION
REQUESTS AND PROVIDING SPECIALIST ADVICE ............................................ 117
XIV
......................................................................................................
.........................................................................
116
D.4
SELECTION AND ALLOCATION OF BLOOD COMPONENTS
D.5
ISSUING BLOOD COMPONENTS
D.6
HAEMOVIGILANCE ON RECIPIENTS
D.7
MANAGEMENT OF BLOOD COMPONENT STOCKS
D.8
DISTRIBUTION OF BLOOD COMPONENTS
.............................
120
..........................................................................................
129
.................................................................................
.................................................
132
..................................................................
134
......................................................................
.......
137
....................................................................................
138
D.8.2 DELIVERY OF PLASMA TO PHARMACEUTICAL COMPANIES
PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
Se
rv
D.9
134
iz
i
D.8.1 BLOOD COMPONENT EXCHANGE
131
SECTION E - LABORATORY DIAGNOSTIC ACTIVITIES
E.1
LIST OF LABORATORY DIAGNOSTIC SERVICES
AND INFORMATION FOR USERS .......................................................................................... 145
E.2
GENERAL CRITERIA FOR THE MANAGEMENT
OF LABORATORY DIAGNOSTIC ACTIVITIES .............................................................. 146
E.2.1 VALIDATION OF ANALYTICAL PROCESSES
.............................................
146
M
TI
E.2.2 MANAGEMENT OF ACTIVITIES
IN THE PRE-ANALYTICAL STAGE....................................................................... 147
E.2.3 MANAGEMENT OF ACTIVITIES IN THE ANALYTICAL PHASE ..... 149
E.2.4 MANAGEMENT OF ACTIVITIES
IN THE POST-ANALYTICAL PHASE.................................................................... 152
E.2.5 EXTERNAL QUALITY ASSESSMENT
.................................................................
SI
E.2.6 OUTSOURCING LABORATORY DIAGNOSTIC ACTIVITIES
SPECIFIC STANDARDS
FOR ERYTHROCYTE IMMUNOHAEMATOLOGY TESTS
..........................................
154
155
E.3.1 MANAGEMENT OF ERYTHROCYTE
IMMUNOHAEMATOLOGY TESTS ........................................................................
155
E.3.2 ABO AND RhD TYPING: DONORS
156
©
E.3
...........
153
....................................................................
E.3.3 ABO AND RhD TYPING: PATIENTS
.................................................................
158
E.3.4 SCREENING FOR IRREGULAR ERYTHROCYTE ANTIBODIES
AND CROSSMATCHING ............................................................................................ 159
E.3.5 IDENTIFICATION OF
IRREGULAR ERYTHROCYTE ANTIBODIES
.................................................
E.3.6 IMMUNOHAEMATOLOGICAL INVESTIGATIONS
ON THE HAEMOLYTIC DISEASE OF THE NEWBORN
.........................
E.3.7 STUDY OF AUTOIMMUNE HAEMOLYTIC DISORDERS
.....................
160
161
162
XV
E.4
SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR MICROBIOLOGICAL TESTS PERFORMED
FOR THE QUALIFICATION OF ALLOGENEIC BLOOD COMPONENTS ....... 163
E.5
SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR LEUKOCYTE AND PLATELET
IMMUNOHAEMATOLOGY TESTS ............................................................................................ 164
E.6
SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR EXTEMPORANEOUS
PREDONATION DIAGNOSTIC TESTS ................................................................................ 165
E.7
PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
SECTION F - AUTOLOGOUS BLOOD TRANSFUSION
165
iz
i
......................................................................................
170
INFORMATION FOR USERS
F.2
MANAGEMENT OF PRE-OPERATIVE AUTOLOGOUS
BLOOD DONATION PROGRAMMES ..................................................................................... 171
F.3
MANAGEMENT OF OTHER AUTOLOGOUS
BLOOD TRANSFUSION ACTIVITIES .................................................................................. 178
F.4
PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
Se
rv
F.1
......................................................................................................
......................................................................................
179
M
TI
SECTION G - HAEMOPOIETIC STEM CELL COLLECTION AND OTHER
CLINICAL ACTIVITIES IN TRANSFUSION MEDICINE
...........................................
182
G.2 GENERAL CRITERIA FOR MANAGING
CLINICAL ACTIVITIES IN TRANSFUSION MEDICINE
...........................................
183
SI
G.1 LIST OF SERVICES AND INFORMATION FOR USERS
G.3 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR HAEMOPOIETIC STEM CELL (HSC)
COLLECTION ACTIVITIES ........................................................................................................... 188
G.3.1 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR COLLECTING BONE MARROW
AND PERIPHERAL HAEMOPOIETIC STEM CELLS ................................... 188
©
G.3.2 SPECIFIC STANDARDS
FOR UMBILICAL CORD BLOOD DONATION
...............................................
191
G.4 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR OTHER CLINICAL ACTIVITIES
IN TRANSFUSION MEDICINE ................................................................................................... 193
G.5 PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
XVI
........................................................................................
196
INTRODUCTION
APPLICABILITY OF THE STANDARDS
This Manual applies to blood establishments (including any related branches)
authorised/accredited in the light of the national and regional legislation applicable
to the sector.
Se
rv
iz
i
The Manual is arranged in Sections, each of which applies to a specific type of
organisation, as a function of the products/services it provides:
● Section A - General organisational requirements;
● Section B - Collection of blood and blood components;
● Section C - Production, qualification and biological validation of blood
components;
● Section D - Allocation and distribution of allogeneic blood components;
● Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities;
● Section F - Autotransfusion;
● Section G - Collection of haemopoietic stem cells and other clinical activities in
transfusion medicine;
Section A establishes the General standards of an organisational and managerial
nature applicable to all blood establishments, irrespective of the type of
product/service they provide.
M
TI
Sections B, C, D, E, F, G establish Specific organisational-managerial and
technical/professional standards applicable to blood establishments depending
on the type of product/service they provide.
GUIDE TO THE INTERPRETATION OF THE STANDARDS
SI
The Standards in each Section of the Manual are organised into chapters and are
identified by means of alphanumerical codes.
©
Each Standard is generally complete with Application guidelines, which explain the
criteria to adopt for the purposes of a proper interpretation and application of the
standard, defining:
● the guarantees that must necessarily be provided and/or the activities that must
necessarily be conducted to ensure alignment with the standard concerned
(identified by means of the term “shall” - or equivalent expressions - in bold
type). Where the Guidelines provide explicit indications in this sense, they
have the same prescriptive value as the standards to which they refer;
● recommendations relating to certain aspects of the organisation, i.e. guarantees
that should preferably be provided and/or the related instruments/methods,
even though compliance is not compulsory (identified by means of the term
“should” - or equivalent expressions - in italics and bold type);
● any applicable alternative approaches to the performance of the activities that
are considered equivalent to the content described in the two previous items
(identified by means of the term “may” - or its equivalent expressions - in
italics).
XVII
DEFINITIONS
An unexpected event relating to the donation or transfusion
process that can cause unintentional and unwanted harm to
the donor/patient.
Adverse
reaction
An undesirable effect seen in an individual relating to
a donation, a transfusion or a diagnostic or therapeutic
procedure.
Analyte
A substance identified/measured by a laboratory test.
Back-up
A procedure for duplicating information (data or software)
saved in a workstation or production server on different
support media, normally done according to an established
schedule.
Benchmarking
A method for comparing the characteristics of an
organisation, activity or institution with those of other,
similar organisations, activities or institutions to establish
which performs best and to identify the most appropriate
management methods and strategies. It is used as an
improvement tool.
Biological
validation
Final assessment of the set of elements needed for the
biological qualification of a donation and the related products,
with a view to declaring it suitable for transfusion purposes
(subject to verification of immunological compatibility) and
allowing its definitive labelling.
The elements that biologically qualify a donation and the
related products include:
- the results of microbiological and immunohaematological
tests required by current legislation;
- the treatment of the available details relating to the
donation and the donor, particularly concerning any
specific findings in their medical history or emerging from
their clinical examination during the selection phase, and
any post-donation findings/information;
- any biological qualification tests not required by law,
conducted to satisfy particular blood component safety
demands and/or specific clinical requirements.
©
SI
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
Adverse
event
XVIII
A permanent or mobile site for collecting blood and blood
components, managed by associations and federations of blood
donors operating in connection with the blood establishment
and under its technical responsibility in accordance with the
applicable national and regional standards. Any collection
sites managed directly by the blood establishment as
branches of its own organisation (at separate units or hospital
or inter-hospital departments) are considered for all intents
and purposes as an integral part of the blood establishment.
Blood
establishment
In the formulation of the Standards and the related
Application guidelines, the term “blood establishment”
implicitly refers to different levels of responsibility defined
therein (from the BE management to the various levels of
responsibility attributed thereby).
Blood
establishment
manager
(BE manager)
The person responsible for the BE. In Italy, according to a more
stringent transposition of Directive 2002/98/EC, a BE manager
can only be a physician officially qualified in transfusion
medicine having successfully completed a university specialty
course and gained at least five years of experience in the field
of blood and blood component collection, testing, processing,
storage, issuing and distribution.
Clinical
guidelines
A set of clinical behavioural recommendations developed
by adopting a formal methodological procedure involving a
systematic review of the available scientific information and its
multidisciplinary and multi-professional interpretation. They
are designed to orient clinical decisions so as to facilitate the
adoption of measures of documented efficacy in appropriate
clinical circumstances and organisational settings.
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
Blood
collection
site
A sign, symptom, syndrome, anomaly or unfavourable
condition observed in a donor or patient, temporarily
associated with an action taken, which may or may not have
a causal relationship with the action concerned.
Corrective action
An action designed to prevent any repetition of a
nonconformity to a given standard by eliminating its cause.
©
SI
Complication
Cut-off
In a laboratory quality test, the value that discriminates
between a reactive and a non-reactive test result, depending
on the method being used.
Donor’s file
A set of all the details relating to a given donor, recorded on
printed paper and/or in electronic form.
External
quality audit
Periodic monitoring activity on a cooperative basis to
assess the precision and accuracy of the analytical methods
employed at a test laboratory.
XIX
A standardised document (on printed paper or in electronic
format) for recording details or activities, adopted to ensure
homogeneity in data collection by the personnel involved.
Grey zone
In biological qualification tests, a set of values - defined as a
percentage below and/or above the cut-off - coinciding with
which the test result cannot be considered non-reactive.
Haemovigilance
A set of procedures for identifying and monitoring unwanted
or unexpected severe adverse reactions and severe incidents
relating to the transfusion process and to surveillance of
transfusion-transmitted infectious diseases.
Haemovigilance systems are governed by specific EC
requirements as transposed in national legislation; see Decree of
21 December 2007 on the creation of the Italian transfusion
services’ IT system (SISTRA), with the following objectives:
- to constitute a European network of
basic
epidemiological information for orienting strategies
and programmes for the continual improvement of
transfusion process and product quality and safety, and
to support evidence-based decision-making processes;
- to establish a system for monitoring severe incidents
potentially influencing the quality and safety of blood and
blood components, and the safety of recipients and donors,
to enable undertake corrective and preventive actions,
also with a view to developing early warning models.
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
Form
An individual’s expression of consent to undergo a specific
healthcare treatment after they have been suitably informed
about its purposes and any risks involved.
Internal quality
control
(laboratory)
A set of activities designed to minimise analytical errors and
promote the reliability of laboratory data.
A set of procedures adopted by a laboratory to continuously
monitor whether the results obtained in a set of analyses
are sufficiently reliable, and whether there are any trends
associated with a given variation are identifiable before the
established quality limits are exceeded.
©
SI
Informed consent
to treatment
XX
A retrospective investigation and assessment relating to a
given donor’s risk of transfusion-transmitted diseases if one
or more donations made by said donor are found to be at
risk, or potentially at risk of transmitting disease, based on
diagnostic and clinical examinations and the donor’s medical
history, or if said donation(s) are implicated in cases of
suspected transfusion-transmitted disease. The investigation
is also designed to guarantee the performance of any action
associated with the involvement of donations being made in
situations at risk of transmitting disease via the resulting blood
components or plasma-derived medicinal products, to be
taken in relation to third parties affected (e.g. pharmaceutical
industries with agreements for handling the conversion of
plasma, organisations responsible for the regulations governing
compensation for personal injury attributable to transfusions).
Medical device
See the definitions in the specific Community Directives on
the matter, transposed by the Italian Legislative Decree (D.
Lgs.) n. 46 of 24/02/1997.
Near miss
A hazardous situation that narrowly avoided developing into
an adverse event.
Any situation that could have generated an adverse event,
but did not due to chance or capable management.
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
Look back
A deviation from a specified standard.
Objective evidence
Information that is demonstrably reliable on the grounds of
observations, measurements, test or other links.
Organisation chart
A method for representing the hierarchy in an organisation,
showing the various levels of responsibility.
SI
Nonconformity
©
Organisational
emergency,
technological
emergency
An unexpected “critical” organisational or technological
situation that the organisation has to cope with, adopting
prompt and effective solutions to guarantee user and
operator safety, and the continuity of the service at the
established quality levels.
Outsourcing
A strategy consisting in contracting out certain activities,
allocating them to other organisations (for reasons of cost,
technology, etc.).
Post-transfusion
follow-up
Period of observation based on an established protocol
of clinical investigations to monitor some of a recipient’s
biological and/or clinical variables to obtain information on
the effects of the transfusion.
XXI
All documents, on printed paper or electronic support
media, defining the rules and standards to apply within an
organisation.
Preventive action
An action designed to prevent the occurrence of a potential
nonconformity to a specified standard or other critical
situation by removing its cause.
Procedure
A document defining the sequence of activities, responsibilities
and methods involved in regulating a process or activity in
the light of the established objectives. A procedure’s scope
and level of detail differ according to the complexity of the
processes/activities it governs and the competence of the
personnel responsible its application.
Process
A structured sequence of activities designed to produce a
result that has value for the (internal or external) end user.
Process control
An activity for auditing certain process variables considered
crucial to the proper performance of the related activities and
consequently to the quality of the outputs of said process.
Process control
indicator
A tool for measuring the characteristics of a process, product
or service.
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
Prescriptive
documents
Inter-laboratory tests are conducted according to established
programmes and used as a means for ensuring a laboratory’s
quality, documenting the referability of its measurements,
validating its test methods, certifying its reference materials,
and evaluating its personnel’s technical expertise.
Protocol
A locally agreed, predefined optimal set of actions to take as
a starting point in clinical (or operational) activities. It gives
an account of the reasons, constraints and objectives of the
activities involved.
SI
Proficiency test
(laboratory)
©
Qualification
As a part of validation, the action of verifying that any
personnel, premises, equipment or material works correctly
and delivers the expected results. (European Commission
Directive 2005/62/CE).
Quality
Conformity of a product, process or parts thereof to
established standards.
Quality audit
An independent, documented, systematic assessment
to establish whether quality-related activities and their
outcomes comply with the planned requirements and
whether any provisions are effectively implemented and
appropriate for achieving the objectives.
XXII
Activity designed to ascertain the conformity of the
characteristics of products (or parts of a product),
documents, equipment, materials or other elements of a
process to established standards.
Quality data
and records
All data and records, on printed paper or electronic and
magnetic support media, needed to provide evidence of the
systematic performance of an organisation’s programmed
activities and/or the satisfaction of its management and
working standards.
Quality monitoring
system
A chart for assessing the relevant aspects of a product,
service or process, consisting of a set of indicators that
are measured to provide useful elements for monitoring
activities and results, and consequently for identifying any
critical areas and enabling improvements.
Recipient
The person allocated to receive one or more blood
components, or who has received the blood components
allocated thereto.
Reconditioning of
medical devices
A set of activities for cleaning, washing, drying, lubricating,
decontaminating and sterilising instruments, equipment and
systems used in the process for providing the service with a
view to preventing contamination.
Se
rv
A biological sample containing a known concentration or
activity level of a given analyte, that is processed in the
same analytical session and under the same conditions as
the biological samples from donors/patients being tested.
A representative fraction of an entity or population.
SI
Sample
M
TI
Run control
iz
i
Quality control
The action of collecting or constituting a sample.
Test validation
Confirmation of the validity and representative value of an
analytical finding based on a study of the values identified
and a comparison between different parameters.
©
Sampling
Traceability
The capacity to retrace the history, usage or location of a
given element. Applied to a blood unit or a blood component
derived therefrom, traceability refers to the ability to retrace
the steps from the donor to the final destination, or vice
versa.
Transfusion
emergency
Situation where a patient’s clinical conditions are such that
deferring the transfusion may put the patient’s life at risk,
making it impossible to follow the normal pre-transfusion
blood unit selection and compatibility procedures.
XXIII
A situation where a patient’s clinical conditions allow for the
short-lived postponement of a transfusion.
Validation
The establishment of documented and objective evidence
that the pre-defined requirements for a specific procedure or
process can be consistently fulfilled (European Commission
Directive 2005/62/CE).
Certification of the efficacy of a process/activity (method,
resources used, times, etc) in satisfying the established
aims, achieved as a result of planned activities including:
- the definition of the results to achieve;
- the definition of the acceptance criteria;
- the identification of the critical variables in the process/
activity;
- the planning and performance of tests designed to produce
statistically significant evidence, where applicable;
- the consequent production of documentary evidence
providing assurance of the capacity of the process/
activity to achieve the established results.
©
SI
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
Transfusion
emergency
XXIV
REFERENCES
The standards contained in this Manual are defined in accordance with current
Italian and European legislation and recommendations.
Technical-scientific references
College of American Pathologists. Standards for Laboratory Accreditation.
2000 Edition.
2)
Schreiber GB, Glynn SA, Busch MP, Sharma UK, Wright DJ, Kleinman SH;
Retrovirus Epidemiology Donor Study. Incidence rates of viral infections
among repeat donors: are frequent donors safer? Transfusion. 2001 Jun;
41(6):730-5.
3)
Società Italiana di Medicina Trasfusionale e Immunoematologia (SIMTI), in
collaborazione con GITMO, IBMDR, SIdE, SIE. Linee guida per la raccolta
delle cellule staminali ai fini di un trapianto allogenico di midollo osseo.
Edizioni SIMTI, 2001.
4)
Dodd RY, Notari EP 4th, Stramer SL. Current prevalence and incidence of
infectious disease markers and estimated window-period risk in the American
Red Cross blood donor population. Transfusion. 2002 Aug; 42(8):975-9.
5)
Schreiber GB, Glynn SA, Damesyn MA, Wright DJ, Tu Y, Dodd RY, Murphy EL;
Retrovirus Epidemiology Donor Study. Lapsed donors: an untapped resource.
Transfusion. 2003 Jan; 43(1):17-24.
6)
Glynn SA, Busch MP, Schreiber GB, Murphy EL, Wright DJ, Tu Y, Kleinman
SH; National Heart, Lung, and Blood Institute Retrovirus Epidemiology Donor
Study. Effect of a national disaster on blood supply and safety: the September
11 experience. JAMA 2003 May 7; 289(17):2246-53.
7)
Bocker W, Clark M, Desaint C et al. ISBT. Guidelines for Validation and
Maintaining the Validation State of Automated Systems in Blood Banking.
Vox Sang. 2003; 85 Suppl 1:S1-14.
Se
rv
M
TI
SI
Stramer SL, Glynn SA, Kleinman SH, Strong DM, Caglioti S, Wright DJ,
Dodd RY, Busch MP; National Heart, Lung, and Blood Institute Nucleic Acid
Test Study Group. Detection of HIV-1 and HCV Infections among AntibodyNegative Blood Donors by Nucleic Acid-Amplification Testing. N Engl J Med.
2004 Aug 19; 351(8):760-8.
©
8)
iz
i
1)
9)
World Health Organization. External Quality Assessment of Transfusion
Laboratory Practice. Guidelines on Establishing an EQA Scheme in Blood Group
Serology. Geneva, 2004. Available at: http://www.who.int/bloodsafety/
EQA_in_Blood_Group_Serology.pdf. Last visited on: 15.05.2010.
10) Zou S, Musavi F, Notari EP 4th, Fujii KE, Dodd RY; ARCNET Study Group.
Prevalence of selected viral infections among temporarily deferred donors
who returned to donate blood: American Red Cross blood donor study.
Transfusion 2005 Oct; 45(10):1593-600.
XXV
11) UK Blood Transfusion & Tissue Transplantation Services. Guidelines for the
Blood Transfusion Services in the United Kingdom. 7th Edition, 2005. Available
at: http://www.transfusionguidelines.org.uk. Last visited on: 15.05.2010.
12) Società Italiana di Medicina Trasfusionale e Immunoematologia (SIMTI) e
Società Italiana di Ginecologia e Ostetricia (SIGO). Raccomandazioni per la
gestione della Malattia Emolitica del Neonato. Edizioni SIMTI, 2006.
iz
i
13) Società Italiana di Medicina Trasfusionale e Immunoematologia (SIMTI) e
Società Italiana di Neonatologia (SIN). Recommendations on transfusion
therapy in Neonatology. Blood Transfusion 2006; 4:158-180.
Se
rv
14) Società Italiana di Medicina Trasfusionale e Immunoematologia (SIMTI) e
Società Italiana di Ginecologia e Ostetricia (SIGO). Recommendations for
the management of Haemolytic disease of the newborn. Blood Transfusion
2006; 4: 237-250.
15) Società Italiana di Medicina Trasfusionale e Immunoematologia (SIMTI),
in collaborazione con CIVIS - Coordinamento Interassociativo Volontari
Italiani Sangue. Linee guida per la selezione del donatore di sangue e di
emocomponenti. II Edizione. Edizioni SIMTI, 2006.
16) UK Blood Transfusion & Tissue Transplantation Services. Handbook
of Transfusion Medicine. 4th Edition, 2007. Available at: http://www.
transfusionguidelines.org.uk. Last visited on: 15.05.2010.
M
TI
17) Australian & New Zealand Society of Blood Transfusion inc. Guidelines for
Pretransfusion Testing. 5th edition, 2007. Available at: http://www.anzsbt.
org.au/publications/index.cfm. Last visited on: 15.05.2010.
18) Canadian Society for Transfusion Medicine (CSTM). Standards for Hospital
Transfusion Services. Version 2, 2007.
SI
19) Società Italiana di Medicina Trasfusionale e Immunoematologia (SIMTI).
Raccomandazioni SIMTI sul corretto utilizzo degli emocomponenti e dei
plasmaderivati. Edizioni SIMTI, 1a edizione, settembre 2008.
©
20) FACT (Foundation for the Accreditation of Cellular Therapy) and JACIE (Joint
Accreditation Committee of the ISCT & EBMT). International standards for
cellular therapy product collection, processing, and administration. 4th Edition,
October 2008. Available at: http://www.factwebsite.org/main.aspx?id=526.
Last visited on 15.05.2010.
21) NetCord-FACT. International standard for cord blood collection, processing,
testing, banking, selection and release. 3th edition, version 3.1, December
2008. Available at: http://www.factwebsite.org/main.aspx?id=526. Last
visited on 15.05.2010.
22) Joint Accreditation Committee of the ISCT & EBMT (JACIE), Foundation for the
Accreditation of Cellular Therapy (FACT). International Standards for cellular
therapy product collection, processing and administration. 4th Edition, 2009.
Available at: http://www.jacie.org. Last visited on: 15.05.2010.
23) American Association of Blood Banks (AABB). Standards for Blood Banks and
Transfusion Services. 26th edition, 2009.
XXVI
24) European
Federation
for
Immunogenetics
(EFI).
Standards
for
Histocompatibility Testing. Version 5.6.1, 2009. Available at: www.efiweb.
eu/fileadmin/user_upload/pdf/Accreditation/version_5_6_1_Revision_
April_2010.pdf. Last visited on 15.05.2010.
25) Canadian Standards Association (CSA). Blood and blood components: a
national standard of Canada, CAN/CSA-Z902-F04 (R2009). 2009.
26) Raccomandazioni su terapia con emocomponenti e plasmaderivati nella
preeclampsia. Proposta a AIPE il 30 giugno 2009, bozza.
Se
rv
iz
i
27) Società Italiana di Medicina Trasfusionale e Immunoematologia (SIMTI).
Raccomandazioni SIMTI sulla gestione delle scorte di emocomponenti durante
la pandemia influenzale. Il Servizio Trasfusionale, Bollettino di informazione
sulle attività trasfusionale italiane, settembre-ottobre 2009, anno XXXVIII n.
5, pagg. 48-50.
28) International Society of Blood Transfusion (ISBT). ISBT Guidelines for
Validation of Automated Systems in Blood Establishments. Vox Sanguinis,
vol. 98, supplement 1, February 2010.
29) Etablissement Français du Sang (EFS). Principes de bonne pratique. Available
at:
http://www.afssaps.fr/Afssaps-media/Publications/Recommandationsde-bonne-pratique. Last visited on: 15.05.2010.
©
SI
M
TI
30) Società Italiana di Medicina Trasfusionale e Immunoematologia (SIMTI):
Raccomandazioni SIMTI sul corretto utilizzo della Trasfusione Perioperatoria.
Edizioni SIMTI, 1a edizione, giugno 2010.
XXVII
©
M
SI
TI
zi
Se
rv
i
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
2nd Edition
SECTION A
GENERAL ORGANISATIONAL REQUIREMENTS
A.1 ELEMENTS OF MANAGEMENT STRATEGY
iz
i
CONTENTS
...........................................................
3
.................................................................................
3
...............................................................................................................
6
A.2 MANAGEMENT OF DOCUMENTS AND DATA .....................................................
A.2.1 MANAGEMENT OF PRESCRIPTIVE DOCUMENTS ..................................
6
7
A.1.2 ORGANISATION
Se
rv
A.1.1 POLICIES AND OBJECTIVES
.............................
9
...............................................................
12
A.2.2 MANAGEMENT OF QUALITY DATA AND RECORDS
A.3 MANAGEMENT OF HUMAN RESOURCES
A.3.1 MAINTENANCE, DEVELOPMENT
............................
12
.......................................................................................................
14
M
TI
AND ASSESSMENT OF THE PERSONNEL’S SKILLS
A.3.2 OPERATOR SAFETY
A.4 MANAGEMENT OF TECHNOLOGIES
.........................................................................
15
A.4.1 MANAGEMENT OF SYSTEMS, EQUIPMENT
AND INSTRUMENTS
.....................................................................................................
15
A.4.2 MANAGEMENT OF EQUIPMENT USED
SI
FOR THE STORAGE OF BLOOD, BLOOD COMPONENTS
AND HAEMATOPOIETIC STEM CELLS
............................................................
18
A.4.3 MANAGEMENT OF
..........................................
19
................................................
21
.......................................................................................
22
INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY (IT) SYSTEMS
©
A.4.4 RECONDITIONING OF MEDICAL DEVICES
A.5 MANAGEMENT OF MATERIALS
A.5.1 QUALIFICATION, CONTROL AND STORAGE OF MATERIALS
......
22
1
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
A.6 PROCESS MANAGEMENT
2nd Edition
.......................................................................................................
A.6.1 PROCESS PLANNING
....................................................................................................
25
25
A.6.2 QUALITY CONTROL ON THE PROCESSES, PRODUCTS
AND SERVICES, AND MANAGEMENT OF NON CONFORMITIES ...... 26
A.6.3 STORAGE OF BLOOD, BLOOD COMPONENTS
AND HAEMATOPOIETIC STEM CELLS
............................................................
28
iz
i
A.6.4 PACKAGING AND TRANSPORTATION OF BLOOD, BLOOD
COMPONENTS AND HAEMATOPOIETIC STEM CELLS ....................... 29
..........................................................
31
A.6.6 MANAGEMENT OF ORGANISATIONAL AND TECHNOLOGICAL
EMERGENCIES ..................................................................................................................
32
Se
rv
A.6.5 IDENTIFICATION AND TRACEABILITY
A.7 QUALITY MONITORING, ANALYSIS AND IMPROVEMENT
A.7.1 QUALITY MONITORING
................
33
..............................................................................................
33
................................................
36
..............................................................................................
37
A.7.2 CORRECTIVE AND PREVENTIVE ACTIONS
A.8 INFORMATION REPORTING
A.9 PARTICIPATION AS PARTNERS IN RESEARCH
AND DEVELOPMENT SCHEMES ....................................................................................... 38
M
TI
A.9.1 RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT PARTNERSHIPS
................................
38
©
SI
ANNEX 1 - PROFESSIONAL SKILLS
OF HEALTH-CARE PERSONNEL ................................................................................................. 39
2
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.1 ELEMENTS OF MANAGEMENT STRATEGY
The Blood Establishment (BE) management shall guarantee its commitment to
establishing, implementing, maintaining and developing the BE’s quality standards,
and to adopting mechanisms capable of ensuring its proper management, by
providing clear guidelines that must be shared with all personnel operating within
the BE.
A.1.1 POLICIES AND OBJECTIVES
iz
i
A.1.1.1 The BE management shall develop and formalise the
strategies, the general objectives and the policies to pursue
at the blood establishment.
Se
rv
A.1.1.1.1 The strategies, general objectives and policies to
pursue at the BE shall be circulated to all personnel
operating therein.
A.1.1.1.2 The strategies, general objectives and policies to
pursue at the BE shall be systematically audited at least
once a year to ascertain their ongoing adequacy.
M
TI
A.1.1.2 Consistently with the established strategies, general
objectives and policies, and also in the light of any critical
issues emerging as a result of systematic quality monitoring
activities, the BE management shall define specific quality
improvement objectives that the establishment undertakes
to pursue.
A.1.1.2.1 The specific quality improvement objectives shall be
circulated to all personnel operating at the BE.
SI
A.1.1.2.2 The specific quality improvement objectives shall be
audited at least once a year.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
©
A.1.1.1 The BE management shall develop and formalise the strategies,
the general objectives and the policies to pursue at the blood
establishment.
The BE management shall be responsible for developing and formalising the
strategic guidelines, the general objectives and the policies to pursue at the
establishment, which shall be:
a) appropriate for the establishment’s mission;
b) consistent with the strategies and policies established at higher hospital/health
trust management and institutional levels;
c) designed for the purpose of safeguarding and continually improving the safety
of the blood transfusion process inasmuch as concerns the donors, the patients
and the operators involved;
3
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
Se
rv
iz
i
d) designed for the purpose of satisfying the demand for blood components and
blood products in the healthcare areas served by the BE (particularly for the
needs relating to urgent and emergency situations), as well as in the settings
identified in the regional and national self-sufficiency programmes;
e) focusing on ensuring the appropriate clinical use of blood components and
blood products and an appropriate organisation of the related management
processes;
f) focusing on furthering and emphasising the role of transfusion medicine as a
strategic activity supporting many of the most important healthcare activities,
promoting and contributing to the definition of diagnostic-therapeutic
processes, also in the context of Hospital Transfusion Committees;
g) focusing on making the best use of the personnel and ensuring their continuing
professional development;
h) focusing on compliance with the SIMTI Transfusion Medicine Standards and on
improving the BE’s performance.
A.1.1.1.1 The strategies, general objectives and policies to pursue at the
BE shall be circulated to all personnel operating therein.
The strategies, general objectives and policies to pursue at the establishment
shall be decided in co-operation with the responsible persons at the BE (e.g.
sector managers, coordinating technicians and nurses).
M
TI
They shall also be circulated to all personnel operating at the establishment, and
the action taken to circulate them shall be documented (by means of the minutes
of meetings designed for this purpose or equivalent methods).
SI
A.1.1.1.2 The strategies, general objectives and policies to pursue at
the BE shall be systematically audited at least once a year to
ascertain their ongoing adequacy.
Activities conducted to assess the ongoing adequacy of the strategies, general
objectives and policies to pursue at the BE, and any revision thereof, shall be
documented.
©
A.1.1.2 Consistently with the established strategies, general objectives and
policies, the BE management defines specific quality improvement
objectives that the establishment undertakes to pursue, also in
the light of any critical issues emerging as a result of systematic
quality monitoring activities.
The specific objectives defined by the management shall be:
a) consistent with the established strategies, general objectives and policies;
b) designed to improve the quality of the processes/activities and/or the
corresponding results achieved by the BE, also in relation to the outcome of the
periodic monitoring activities and data analyses relating to the quality of the
processes, products and clinical outcomes (see Ch. A.7.1 Quality monitoring);
4
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
c) designed to improve the technical/professional quality, according to the SIMTI
Transfusion Medicine Standards, and the progress of transfusion medicine and
the related disciplines;
d) suited to the resources actually available;
e) formally recorded in appropriate documents;
f) expressed in measurable or otherwise verifiable form, particularly as concerns
the results of processes for the development and continual improvement of the
BE’s technical/professional performance.
iz
i
For each objective, the corresponding responsible persons, the resources, the
timing, and the methods to use to pursue it shall be clearly defined, as well as
appropriate measurement indicators for assessing its achievement.
Se
rv
A.1.1.2.1 The specific quality improvement objectives shall be circulated
to all personnel operating at the BE.
The quality improvement objectives shall be defined in co-operation with the
persons responsible for the BE’s sectors and shall be assigned and circulated at
all pertinent levels of the BE.
M
TI
The activities conducted to circulate these objectives shall be documented
(by means of the minutes of meetings designed for this purpose or equivalent
methods).
The BE management is responsible for ensuring a thorough understanding of the
established improvement objectives at all levels of the BE.
A.1.1.2.2 The specific quality improvement objectives shall be audited
at least once a year.
SI
The BE management shall periodically audit, at least once a year, the degree to
which the specific quality improvement objectives have been achieved.
©
The objectives shall be systematically monitored, revised and, where necessary,
updated.
5
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.1.2 ORGANISATION
A.1.2.1 The BE management shall guarantee that responsibilities
and authority are clearly defined and communicated within
the establishment.
A.1.2.2 The BE management shall appoint a Quality Assurance
manager
iz
i
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
Se
rv
A.1.2.1 The BE management shall guarantee that responsibilities and
authority are clearly defined and communicated within the
establishment.
The BE management shall formally define and approve the organisation chart for
the establishment and specify the main responsibilities of the various responsible
persons within the BE.
The responsibilities attributed to the designated individuals shall also be clearly
defined in the procedures adopted by the BE.
M
TI
The above-mentioned documents shall be made known to all personnel operating
at the BE.
A.1.2.2 The BE management shall appoint a Quality Assurance manager.
SI
The BE management shall identify a person responsible for Quality Assurance
who, irrespective of any other responsibilities, is made responsible for supervising
all the processes and activities that have a an influence on the quality and safety
of blood and blood components and on the services delivered by the BE.
The BE management shall formally define the specific responsibilities of the
Quality Assurance manager.
©
A.2 MANAGEMENT OF DOCUMENTS AND DATA
The BE management shall adopt and manage a document system designed to
ensure:
a) the availability to all operators of appropriate and up-to-date references for the
proper conduction of the activities for which they are responsible;
b) the identification and traceability of all elements needed to provide evidence
of the systematic performance of the activities required and/or of compliance
with the organisational, managerial, technical/professional requirements
and working standards established by the BE in accordance with the present
Manual.
6
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.2.1 MANAGEMENT OF PRESCRIPTIVE DOCUMENTS
A.2.1.1 The BE shall adopt systems designed to guarantee the
effective management of all prescriptive documents used
for reference in the proper conduction of processes and
activities at the BE.
iz
i
A.2.1.2 The BE shall prepare a specific list of the prescriptive
documents issued and applied by the establishment, and
keep this list up-to-date.
A.2.1.3 The BE shall adopt systems designed to ensure the
identification and the constant retrieval and revision of
documents of external origin applicable at the BE.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
Se
rv
A.2.1.4 The BE shall develop, make available and systematically use
appropriate forms, on printed paper or electronic support,
for recording data and activities in accordance with the
requirements of the procedures adopted at the BE.
M
TI
A.2.1.1 The BE shall adopt systems designed to guarantee the effective
management of all prescriptive documents used for reference in
the proper conduction of processes and activities at the BE.
Prescriptive documents define the rules and standards to apply within a BE.
Examples of prescriptive documents include: procedures, work instructions,
diagnostic-therapeutic protocols, behavioural norms, documents outlining the
organisation of the establishment.
SI
The prescriptive documents adopted at the BE shall be controlled in order to
ensure the availability of appropriate, clear and up-to-date references for operators
involved in conducting the various activities.
©
The systems adopted to manage prescriptive documents shall guarantee that the
following are clearly stated:
a) the criteria for identifying the documents;
b) the responsibilities for the preparation, review and approval of the documents;
c) the methods for managing revisions (changes shall always be dated and
signed by expressly authorised parties and should be highlighted);
d) the responsibilities and the tools used to circulate the documents to the
interested parties (identified in specific lists) every time they are revised;
e) the responsibilities and methods for preserving the originals;
f) the methods for managing obsolete documents (mechanisms for removing
copies from the places where they were in use, preservation times, methods for
eliminating documents after the established preservation times have expired).
7
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
Where specified in the present Manual, or deemed advisable by the BE
management, the prescriptive documents (and particularly the procedures and
work instructions) may be approved only after adequate validation studies have
been performed.
Prescriptive documents should be prepared using standardised formats.
Se
rv
iz
i
They should always indicate:
a) the scope, or purpose for which they were prepared;
b) the field of application;
c) the sources used in their preparation (particularly the reference scientific
literature in the case of documents of a technical/professional nature);
d) the related forms to be used.
A.2.1.2 The BE shall prepare a specific list of the prescriptive documents
issued and applied by the establishment, and keep this list up-todate.
The lists containing the prescriptive documents issued and applied by the
establishment shall always indicate the revision level of the documents concerned.
M
TI
The BE shall identify and define the responsibilities for preparing and revising
these lists.
A.2.1.3 The BE shall adopt systems designed to ensure the identification
and the constant retrieval and revision of documents of external
origin applicable at the BE.
©
SI
In some cases, the requirements applicable to the proper performance of processes
and activities at the BE are stated in documents of external origin, e.g.
a) normative requirements (be they regional, national and international) currently
in force;
b) directives and provisions issued by the body governing the BE (e.g. the hospital
management);
c) guidelines and other technical-scientific reference documents;
d) conventions or memoranda of understanding signed with other bodies/
establishments/associations with which the BE interfaces;
e) technical documentation issued by suppliers (use and maintenance manuals
and subsequent revisions thereof, technical datasheets on materials, safety
data sheets on material, etc.);
f) all other documents considered pertinent and useful for the proper performance
of the activities.
The methods and responsibilities for the retrieval of up-to-date versions of
documents of external origin applicable at the BE shall be clearly defined.
8
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.2.1.4 The BE shall develop, make available and systematically use
appropriate forms, on printed paper or electronic support, for
recording data and activities in accordance with the requirements
of the procedures adopted at the BE.
For a definition of the term “Form”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions.
Se
rv
iz
i
The BE shall adopt controlled methods for managing currently-used forms,
designed to guarantee that:
a) the forms are unequivocally identified;
b) they have been approved by the responsible persons at the BE and included
in specific lists that are systematically revised by the persons responsible, as
identified by the management of the establishment;
c) the level of their revision is always clearly identifiable;
d) obsolete copies are promptly removed and up-to-date versions are always
available to operators at the BE.
The labels adopted by the BE for product identification purposes shall be intended
as forms requiring a controlled management.
M
TI
The BE shall also guarantee the retrieval and distribution to the operators of
up-to-date versions of forms of external origin (originating from the hospital or
elsewhere), the use of which is functional to the proper completion and control of
the processes and activities.
A.2.2 MANAGEMENT OF QUALITY DATA AND RECORDS
A.2.2.1 The BE shall adopt systems designed to guarantee the
proper management of the quality data and records
generated at the BE.
SI
A.2.2.1.1 The BE shall guarantee that the quality data and records
are always legible, identifiable and readily traceable.
A.2.2.1.2 The BE shall ensure the traceability of the operators
responsible for generating quality data and records.
©
A.2.2.1.3 The BE shall guarantee the protection of all information
and data collected.
A.2.2.1.4 The BE shall define and implement emergency
procedures designed to ensure the proper and effective
performance of its activities even in the event of data
on electronic support being momentarily unavailable.
A.2.2.2 The BE shall prepare specific lists indicating the quality
records that it undertakes to generate and to preserve for
established periods of time, and it shall keep these lists upto-date.
9
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
A.2.2.1 The BE shall adopt systems designed to guarantee the proper
management of the quality data and records generated at the BE.
For a definition of the term “Quality data and records “, see the Introduction to the
Transfusion Medicine Standards, Definitions.
iz
i
Quality data and records may be generated both on printed paper and on IT
media.
Se
rv
Either way, their management shall be controlled to guarantee the traceability of
the activities involved and of the results achieved for established periods of time.
M
TI
The BE management is responsible for identifying the types of quality data and
records to be generated in the light of the following criteria:
a) requirements dictated by current legislation and voluntary reference standards;
b) the need to provide the BE manager, the hospital management to which the BE
responds, and auditors sent by competent external organisations/institutions/
bodies for their established auditing activities, with objective evidence of the
activities conducted;
c) the need to process and analyse statistical data for the purposes of quality
improvement;
d) the opportunity to keep a historical record of the activities conducted, or of
certain results achieved.
©
SI
The quality data and records shall always include the following:
a) those prescribed by current legislation or voluntary reference standards;
b) those demonstrating the performance of activities that the BE management
considers crucial for ensuring the quality of the products and services it
delivers;
c) those demonstrating the conduction of auditing/control/monitoring activities
and quality analyses on products, services or processes/activities;
d) those testifying to decisions reached by personnel appointed to do so on
matters crucial to the quality of the service (e.g. process validation activities,
decisions relating to the treatment of nonconformities, decisions relating to the
implementation of preventive or corrective actions, and to the assessment of
their efficacy).
A.2.2.1.1 The BE shall guarantee that the quality data and records are
always legible, identifiable and readily traceable.
The operators responsible for producing quality data and records shall guarantee
that they are legible.
The BE shall adopt criteria designed to guarantee that the quality data and records
are identifiable and readily traceable.
10
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.2.2.1.2 The BE shall ensure the traceability of the operators responsible
for generating the quality data and records.
The BE shall adopt systems designed to systematically ensure the traceability
of the operators responsible for producing quality data and records, as well as
an indication of the dates when they were produced, irrespective of the type of
support used.
iz
i
A.2.2.1.3 The BE shall guarantee the protection of all information and
data collected.
Se
rv
The BE shall ensure the protection of all information and data collected by
adopting measures designed to prevent:
a) additions;
b) cancellations;
c) unauthorised changes (if corrections are necessary, the original record shall
not be cancelled and the traceability of the party making the change shall be
guaranteed);
d) the unauthorised circulation of information.
M
TI
A.2.2.1.4 The BE shall define and implement emergency procedures
designed to ensure the proper and effective performance of
its activities even in the event of data on electronic support
being momentarily unavailable.
The BE shall adopt specific procedures that define the responsibilities and the
working methods to adopt in the event of any data/records on electronic support
being momentarily unavailable.
SI
A.2.2.2 The BE shall prepare specific lists indicating the quality records
that it undertakes to generate and to preserve for established
periods of time, and it shall keep these lists up-to-date.
©
The BE management shall identify the quality data and records that the
establishment undertakes to generate and preserve for established periods of
time, also taking action to have them included in specific lists.
11
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.3 MANAGEMENT OF HUMAN RESOURCES
The BE management shall guarantee that the personnel involved in the processes
and activities conducted at the establishment have and develop the necessary
skills according to the level of responsibility and the tasks assigned to them.
A.3.1 MAINTENANCE, DEVELOPMENT
PERSONNEL’S SKILLS
AND
ASSESSMENT
OF
THE
iz
i
A.3.1.1 The BE management shall identify the skills needed for the
personnel performing activities crucial to the quality of the
processes, products and services it delivers.
Se
rv
A.3.1.2 The BE shall define and implement plans for the induction
of newly-acquired personnel, or when a change of role is
planned at the BE, in order to guarantee their adequate
training before they start work.
A.3.1.2.1 The BE shall document any training activities conducted
for the induction of newly-acquired personnel as well
as the assessment of their efficacy.
M
TI
A.3.1.3 The BE management shall systematically identify the
training needs of personnel operating at the establishment
and plan training activities designed to guarantee that their
skills are constantly updated and developed.
A.3.1.3.1 The BE shall document any training activities conducted
in relation to each individual operating at the BE.
SI
A.3.1.4 The BE shall guarantee the systematic training of operators
on the application of any pertinent procedures, the proper
management of products/materials, the proper use and
maintenance of systems/equipment/instruments, and the
proper use of the computer system.
©
A.3.1.5 The BE shall implement systems for the periodic assessment
of the personnel’s skills in order to ensure that all operators
can adequately perform the tasks assigned to them.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
A.3.1.1 The BE management shall identify the skills needed for the
personnel performing activities crucial to the quality of the
processes, products and services it delivers.
The BE management shall establish the minimum skills that each professional
category operating at the establishment must possess, with reference to the
contents of Annex 1 of this Section, Professional skills of health-care personnel.
12
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.3.1.2 The BE shall define and implement plans for the induction of newlyacquired personnel, or when a change of role is planned at the BE,
in order to guarantee their adequate training before they start work.
Se
rv
iz
i
The plans for the induction of newly-acquired personnel, or when a change of role
is planned for personnel already operating at the BE, shall define at least:
a) the skills that the new employee must acquire;
b) how long the induction is expected to take;
c) the training methods, where applicable;
d) the persons responsible for the induction process;
e) the criteria and methods for assessing the acquisition of skills by the individual
undergoing induction, and the persons responsible for said assessment;
f) any reference documents needed for the induction process.
A.3.1.2.1 The BE shall document any training activities conducted for
the induction of newly-acquired personnel as well as the
assessment of their efficacy.
The training activities conducted for induction purpose and the assessment of
their efficacy shall be documented and they constitute a part of the personal files
of each operator at the BE.
M
TI
A.3.1.3 The BE management shall systematically identify the training
needs of personnel operating at the establishment and plan training
activities designed to guarantee that their skills are constantly
updated and developed.
©
SI
The BE management is responsible for identifying the training needs of all
personnel in the light of:
a) strategies for the evolution of the BE’s activities;
b) the establishment’s improvement and management strategies and objectives;
c) the introduction of new standards or their evolution;
d) the acquisition of new technologies;
e) the need to bring operators’ technical/professional skills up to date, or to
develop specific abilities;
f) the assessment of critical issues identified by the quality monitoring activities.
The training plans shall define at least the following elements:
a) the content of the training activities;
b) the training objectives to pursue;
c) the method for conducting the activities;
d) the criteria/methods for assessing the activities conducted;
e) the personnel to receive training;
f) the timing.
13
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.3.1.3.1 The BE shall document any training activities conducted in
relation to each individual operating at the BE.
iz
i
For all individuals operating at the BE, the training and updating activities in which
they have participated shall be traceable by means of the production and/or
preservation of the corresponding documentation (e.g. individual training files,
certificates of attendance at training events, attendance registers, teaching
material).
Se
rv
A.3.1.4 The BE shall guarantee the systematic training of operators on the
application of any pertinent procedures, the proper management of
products/materials, the proper use and maintenance of systems/
equipment/instruments, and the proper use of the computer
system.
Operator training activities focusing on the application of standard operating
procedures, the proper use of products/materials, the proper use and maintenance
of systems, equipment and instruments, and the proper use of the computer
system shall be planned and documented.
M
TI
A.3.1.5 The BE shall implement systems for the periodic assessment of
the personnel’s skills in order to ensure that all operators can
adequately perform the tasks assigned to them.
SI
The BE shall implement systems for the periodic assessment of its operators’
management and technical/professional skills in relation to the principal activities/
processes characterising the BE in order to:
a) ensure the establishment’s capacity to manage the workload optimally and
consequently ensure the continuity of the service;
b) to make the best use of the contributions of individual operators to the
achievement of the BE’s objectives and purposes;
c) to identify any critical areas and consequently decide effective training and
updating strategies.
©
For each activity, the BE management shall define the criteria adopted in the
assessment of the skills required, and it shall document their outcome.
A.3.2 OPERATOR SAFETY
A.3.2.1 The BE management shall guarantee the circulation of the
hospital management’s provisions for ensuring the safety
of personnel operating at the establishment.
14
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
A.3.2.1 The BE management shall guarantee the circulation of the hospital
management’s provisions for ensuring the safety of personnel
operating at the establishment.
Se
rv
iz
i
The BE management shall identify and make known to the personnel operating
at the establishment all the hospital management’s provisions for minimising the
risks to the health and safety of operators, e.g.
a) regulations on the use of personal protective equipment;
b) emergency plans;
c) procedures to implement in the event of accidents occurring in the workplace;
d) procedures for waste management and disposal.
A.4 MANAGEMENT OF TECHNOLOGIES
The BE management takes responsibility for identifying and making available systems,
equipment and instruments quantitatively and qualitatively appropriate for ensuring
the delivery of products and services compliant with the established standards, and
for ensuring their proper operation and continuous suitability for use.
A.4.1 MANAGEMENT OF SYSTEMS, EQUIPMENT AND INSTRUMENTS
M
TI
The BE shall guarantee that all systems, equipment and support
instruments that have a bearing on the quality of its products and the
services it delivers:
A.4.1.1 Have been qualified prior to their use in order to ascertain
their suitability for their intended purpose.
A.4.1.2 Have been unequivocally identified.
SI
A.4.1.3 Have been indicated in specific lists.
A.4.1.4 Have been connected, where necessary, to a power supply
system designed to guarantee their operation even in the
event of a mains power failure.
©
A.4.1.5 Undergo routine servicing and inspection according to their
level of criticality, based on specific schedules.
A.4.1.5.1 The maintenance and inspection
systematically documented.
activities
are
A.4.1.6 They are not used, and they are suitably identified, if they
are found outside their calibration/setting range and/or in
the event of faults or malfunctions.
A.4.1.7 They are accompanied by appropriate user instructions.
15
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall guarantee that all systems, equipment and support instruments that
have a bearing on the quality of its products and the service it delivers:
A.4.1.1 Have been qualified prior to their use in order to ascertain their
suitability for their intended purpose.
iz
i
The systems, equipment and support instruments that have a bearing on the
quality of the product and the service shall have been qualified by the BE prior to
their use in order to ascertain their suitability for their intended purpose.
Se
rv
For a definition of the term “Qualification”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions.
The equipment may be qualified by relying on analytical data provided by the
manufacturer, in which case the BE shall preserve the documentation providing
evidence of the capacity of the system/equipment/instrument to effectively satisfy
the established requirements.
A.4.1.2 Have been unequivocally identified.
M
TI
Every system, item of equipment or support instrument shall be unequivocally
identified according to previously-established criteria.
Identification codes shall be attributed to them in order to guarantee the
traceability of the scheduled measures and of the action taken on the systems/
equipment/instruments in use at the BE.
SI
The BE may maintain the coding/classification of the systems, equipment and
instruments decided by the parties appointed by the hospital management to
which the BE responds.
A.4.1.3 Have been indicated in specific lists.
©
The systems, equipment and support instruments used by the BE shall be indicated
in specific lists that are kept up-to-date by personnel specifically appointed to do
so by the BE management.
For each type of the equipment/instrument the lists should indicate at least:
a) the identification code
b) the name;
c) the location;
d) the date of purchase.
16
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.4.1.4 Have been connected, where necessary, to a power supply system
designed to guarantee their operation even in the event of a mains
power failure.
iz
i
The BE shall identify the equipment that has to be guaranteed to continue to
function even in the event of a mains power failure, which depends on the level
of criticality of the activities for which they are used, with particular reference to
product quality and the safety of donors, patients and operators.
A.4.1.5 Undergo routine servicing and inspection according to their level of
criticality, based on specific schedules.
Se
rv
The maintenance and inspection activities relating to systems, equipment and
support instruments used at the BE shall be scheduled in the light of the following
criteria:
a) the level of criticality in relation to the quality of the product obtained and the
service delivered;
b) current legislation on the matter of safety for users of the service, operators
and the environment;
c) the need for periodic adjustments or settings;
d) the estimated volumes of activity;
e) the working conditions.
SI
M
TI
The maintenance and inspection plans shall establish at least:
a) the type of action to take and its frequency;
b) the internal/external personnel appointed to take action;
c) the methods for taking action (where applicable) and the technical reference
documents (manufacturers’ use and maintenance manuals, specific working
procedures, applicable standards or guidelines, etc.);
d) the records required for any action taken.
A.4.1.5.1 The maintenance and inspection activities are systematically
documented.
©
The BE shall guarantee the traceability of maintenance and inspection activities
conducted by personnel at the establishment or external qualified parties by
means of the production and/or preservation of appropriate records.
A.4.1.6 Are not used, and are suitably identified, if they are found outside
their calibration/settings range and/or in the event of faults or
malfunctions.
The BE shall take all necessary precautions to prevent the unwitting use of
systems, equipment and support instruments found outside their calibration/
setting range and/or faulty or malfunctioning, through the use of appropriate
methods for their identification and/or segregation.
17
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.4.1.7 Are accompanied by appropriate user instructions.
The BE shall provide personnel using the equipment with the manufacturer’s user
manuals and/or specific work instructions.
iz
i
The manuals shall be written in the Italian language or in at least one of the
languages attributed equal status in bilingual Italian regions.
A.4.2 MANAGEMENT OF EQUIPMENT USED FOR THE STORAGE OF
BLOOD, BLOOD COMPONENTS AND HAEMATOPOIETIC STEM
CELLS
Se
rv
For equipment used for the storage of blood, blood components and haematopoietic
stem cells (HSC) in the various stages of their processing up until their distribution,
in addition to the contents of Ch. A.4.1, the BE shall also guarantee that:
A.4.2.1 they are equipped with a system for monitoring and
recording temperatures or nitrogen levels, and with an
acoustic and visual alarm.
M
TI
A.4.2.2 appropriate instructions have been defined for the
controlled management of the equipment used for the
storage of blood and blood components by other centres
in the area that refer to the BE on the basis of specific
conventions/contracts.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
SI
For equipment used for the storage of blood, blood components and haematopoietic
stem cells (HSC) in the various stages of their processing up until their distribution,
in addition to the contents of Ch. A.4.1, the BE also guarantees that:
A.4.2.1 They are equipped with a system for monitoring and recording
temperatures or nitrogen levels, and with an acoustic and visual alarm.
©
The BE shall guarantee:
a) the use of equipment for the storage of blood and blood components that
comprises an appropriate system for monitoring and recording temperatures,
as well as an acoustic and visual alarm;
b) the use of equipment for the storage of HSC that comprises an appropriate system
for monitoring and recording nitrogen levels, as well as an acoustic and visual alarm.
The BE shall ensure the adoption of specific plans for monitoring the functional
efficiency of these control systems and the systematic auditing of the calibration
status of the devices used to measure temperatures and nitrogen levels,
guaranteeing that the measurements are consistent with samples available at
Italian Calibration Service Centres.
18
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
The BE management shall identify the personnel responsible for periodically
controlling the functional efficiency of the equipment for the storage of blood,
blood components and HSC, and the related records.
These control activities shall be documented.
iz
i
Equipment located in rooms or areas that are not constantly supervised by BE
personnel or other personnel appointed to do so shall be equipped with remote
alarms.
These remote alarm devices shall be both acoustic and visual, or equipped with
equivalent alerting means.
Se
rv
The BE shall define and apply specific procedures for managing alarms and
detailed plans for the evacuation of blood, blood components and HSC from faulty
or malfunctioning equipment.
These procedures shall indicate the methods for managing alarm situations, the
records to produce in order to guarantee the traceability of the event, and the
responsibilities, criteria and methods for restoring the systems to operation.
A.4.2.2 Appropriate instructions have been defined for the controlled
management of the equipment used for the storage of blood and
blood components by other centres in the area that refer to the BE
on the basis of specific conventions/contracts.
M
TI
The BE shall establish and transmit to the other centres in the area that refer to the
BE on the basis of specific conventions/contracts appropriate instructions concerning
the proper management of the equipment used for the storage of blood and blood
components (maintenance and inspection activities, temperature monitoring,
management of alarm situations and evacuation of blood components, etc.).
A.4.3 MANAGEMENT OF INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY (IT) SYSTEMS
SI
For the IT systems, the BE shall guarantee that:
©
A.4.3.1 the hardware, software and backup procedures have been
validated prior to their use, their reliability is periodically
verified, and they periodically undergo servicing to maintain
their established requirements and performance.
A.4.3.2 they are accompanied by appropriate user instructions.
A.4.3.3 the hardware and software are protected
unauthorised uses or unallowable changes.
against
A.4.3.4 periodic backups are performed to prevent any loss of data
or changes thereto in the event of planned or unplanned
periods of inactivity or malfunctions.
A.4.3.5 written procedures to apply in order to guarantee the
continuity of the activities in the event of the IT systems
being out of use are in place.
19
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
For the IT systems, the BE shall guarantee that:
iz
i
A.4.3.1 The hardware, software and backup procedures have been validated
prior to their use, their reliability is periodically verified, and
they periodically undergo servicing to maintain their established
requirements and performance.
Se
rv
The IT systems (hardware, software, back-up procedures) used to deliver the
service shall have been validated prior to their use, their reliability shall be
periodically verified and they shall periodically undergo servicing in order to
maintain their established requirements and performance.
The IT systems may be validated on the basis of analytical data provided by
the supplier, in which case the BE shall preserve the documentation providing
evidence of the capacity of the system/equipment/instrument to satisfy the
established requirements effectively.
A.4.3.2 They are accompanied by appropriate user instructions.
M
TI
The BE shall provide the personnel using the IT system with the manufacturer’s
user manuals and/or specific work instructions.
The manuals shall be written in the Italian language or in at least one of the
languages attributed equal status in bilingual Italian regions.
SI
A.4.3.3 The hardware and software are protected against unauthorised
uses or unallowable changes.
©
The BE shall adopt a method designed to prevent any unauthorised use of, or
unallowable changes to the hardware and software used to deliver the service,
also in compliance with the requirements of current legislation for safeguarding
the privacy of personal data with which the establishment comes into contact in
its dealings with users of the service.
A.4.3.4 Pperiodic backups are performed to prevent any loss of data or
changes thereto in the event of planned or unplanned periods of
inactivity or malfunctions.
The BE shall back up its data at regular intervals, clearly defining the related
responsibilities, in order to prevent any loss of data or changes thereto in the event
of periods of planned or unplanned inactivity or malfunctions of the computer
system in use.
20
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.4.3.5 Written procedures to apply in order to guarantee the continuity of
the activities in the event of the IT systems being out of use are in
place.
The BE shall establish and adopt specific procedures to apply in order to ensure
the continuity of activities in the event of the IT systems being out of use.
A.4.4 RECONDITIONING OF MEDICAL DEVICES
iz
i
These procedures shall include the recording and the complete realignment of the
data in the computer systems once they have been restored to use.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
Se
rv
A.4.4.1 The BE shall apply specific methods to the reconditioning of
medical devices to prevent the risk of product contamination
and to guarantee the safety of users and operators.
A.4.4.1 The BE shall apply specific methods to the reconditioning of
medical devices to prevent the risk of product contamination and
to guarantee the safety of users and operators.
M
TI
The term “Reconditioning of medical devices” is used to refer to the cleaning,
washing, drying, lubrication, decontamination and sterilisation of instruments,
equipment and systems in order to prevent the occurrence of contaminations.
©
SI
The methods used to recondition medical devices shall be formally stated in
dedicated procedures/work instructions, where specified by the specific Standards
defined in the present Manual, and in accordance with the instructions of the
manufacturers of medical devices.
21
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.5 MANAGEMENT OF MATERIALS
A.5.1 QUALIFICATION, CONTROL AND STORAGE OF MATERIALS
A.5.1.1 The BE shall ensure that the materials it uses that have a
particular bearing on the quality of its products/services
comply with current legislation and are qualified before
they are introduced at the establishment in order to assess
their suitability for their intended use.
iz
i
A.5.1.2 The materials used by the BE shall be inspected before
their use in order to ascertain the absence of defects or
nonconformities vis-à-vis the established standards.
Se
rv
A.5.1.2.1 The BE shall ensure the systematic recording of
nonconformities encountered at the time of the
inspection or use of materials that have a bearing on
the quality of the products/services, in order to identify
any critical issues and prompt the relevant corrective
actions.
A.5.1.3 The materials available at the BE shall be unequivocally
and clearly identified.
M
TI
A.5.1.4 The materials used by the BE shall be stored under
controlled conditions designed to prevent any change in
their qualitative characteristics. No materials shall be used
beyond their shelf life.
A.5.1.4.1 The BE shall guarantee the performance of systematic
inspections on the integrity and shelf life of stored
materials.
SI
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
©
A.5.1.1 The BE shall ensure that the materials it uses that have a particular
bearing on the quality of its products/services comply with current
legislation and are qualified before they are introduced at the
establishment in order to assess their suitability for their intended use.
Within the context of the BE, responsibilities shall be clearly defined relating
to the qualification of materials considered crucial to the quality of the products
and/or service, e.g.:
a) reagents;
b) devices for collecting and processing whole blood or blood components;
c) labels;
d) systems for packaging and transporting blood components;
e) transfusion sets and filters;
f) detergents and disinfectants;
g) control materials (for intra-laboratory quality control, calibrators).
22
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
The BE management is responsible for identifying the materials to submit to
qualification activities in order to ensure their suitability for their intended use
before their release.
The qualification activities shall be documented.
iz
i
The materials may be qualified on the basis of data provided by the manufacturers,
in which case the BE shall preserve the documentation providing evidence of the
capacity of the products to satisfy the established requirements effectively.
For a definition of the term “Qualification”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions.
Se
rv
A.5.1.2 The materials used by the BE shall be inspected before their use in
order to ascertain the absence of defects or nonconformities vis-àvis the established standards.
The BE shall ensure that the materials it uses, depending on their level of criticality
in relation to the quality of the product/service, are inspected on arrival at the
establishment, or in any case prior to their use, in order to ascertain the absence
of defects or nonconformities vis-à-vis the established standards.
M
TI
For these materials, the BE shall define in particular the inspection parameters,
the acceptance criteria, the responsibilities for controls and the records to produce.
The material inspection activities shall be documented.
SI
A.5.1.2.1 The BE shall ensure the systematic recording of nonconformities
encountered at the time of the inspection or use of materials
that have a bearing on the quality of the product and service,
in order to identify any critical issues and prompt the relevant
corrective actions.
For a definition of the term “Nonconformity”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions.
©
The BE shall guarantee the proper management of any nonconformities identified
in critical materials following inspections conducted at the time of their use,
defining:
a) the methods for recording nonconformities;
b) the methods for identifying/segregating nonconforming materials to prevent
their unwitting use;
c) the decision-making responsibilities relating to the solution of nonconformities
and the related records;
d) responsibilities for implementing the preventive actions needed to avoid any
repetition of nonconformities encountered;
e) the notification of the episode to the competent authorities, where applicable.
23
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.5.1.3 The materials available at the BE shall be unequivocally and clearly
identified.
The materials available at the BE, including those stored in equipment under
controlled temperature conditions, shall be unequivocally and clearly identified
by means of labels or equivalent means.
iz
i
In the case of reagents that need preparation, the containers used shall be
identified with a label indicating the type of preparation, the date of preparation
and the date of expiry.
Se
rv
The BE shall also ensure that the following are unequivocally identified:
a) any materials produced in-house at the BE (e.g. plated culture media, reagents,
calibrators, control sera);
b) aliquotted calibrators and controls;
c) washing solutions;
d) buffer solutions.
A.5.1.4 The materials used by the BE shall be stored under controlled
conditions designed to prevent any change in their qualitative
characteristics. No materials shall be used beyond their shelf life.
M
TI
The BE shall guarantee that perishable materials are stored in appropriate
conditions so as to prevent any alteration of their qualitative characteristics.
A system shall be in place for monitoring and recording the temperature of the
equipment used to store drugs, reagents and materials.
SI
The BE shall guarantee the recording of the batch numbers and the shelf life of
critical materials and reagents.
No materials may be used beyond their shelf life.
©
A.5.1.4.1 The BE shall guarantee the performance of systematic
inspections on the integrity and shelf life of stored materials.
The BE shall plan and implement systematic inspections in order to ascertain
the integrity and shelf life of the materials as applicable, defining the frequency of
inspections, the related responsibilities and the records to produce.
These inspection activities shall be documented.
Any materials beyond their shelf life shall be managed according to established
procedures.
24
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.6 PROCESS MANAGEMENT
The BE management is responsible for planning the processes carried out at the
establishment and their interrelations, as well as for identifying and implementing
mechanisms designed to ensure their constant monitoring over time in order to
guarantee their efficacy/efficiency and the systematic achievement of outputs
consistent with the established quality standards.
iz
i
The requirements relating to the various processes are indicated as specific
Standards in the context of the single sections of the present Manual. The
Standards that all blood establishments must adopt, irrespective of the specific
type of product/service they provide, are defined below.
Se
rv
A.6.1 PROCESS PLANNING
A.6.1.1 For each process, the BE shall define specific procedures,
the sequence of activities involved, the parties responsible
for them, the standard working procedures adopted, the
prescriptive reference documents and the records to
produce.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
M
TI
A.6.1.1 For each process, the BE shall define specific procedures, the
sequence of activities involved, the parties responsible for them,
the standard working procedures
adopted, the prescriptive
reference documents and the records to produce.
The processes shall be planned by the BE in specific written procedures.
any case, the following shall be clearly stated for each process:
the sequence of activities composing it;
the parties responsible for the single activities;
the working procedures adopted;
the prescriptive reference document(s) for the performance of the activity;
the records to produce at the various stages;
©
In
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
SI
The BE may formalise its processes by means of whatever method it considers
most appropriate (e.g. a detailed description of the process, process charts,
flowcharts, matrices, grids, tables).
in accordance with the contents of the specific Standards defined in the present
Manual.
25
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.6.2 QUALITY CONTROL ON THE PROCESSES, PRODUCTS
SERVICES, AND MANAGEMENT OF NONCONFORMITIES
AND
A.6.2.1 The BE shall identify the critical variables in the main
processes and related support processes, and consequently
plan the related control measures to perform, establishing
the corresponding responsibilities, test parameters and
acceptance criteria, and the records to produce.
the
the
the
and
iz
i
The BE shall identify the critical characteristics of
products being processed, and consequently plan
related control measures to perform, establishing
corresponding responsibilities, test parameters
acceptance criteria, as well as the records to produce.
Se
rv
A.6.2.2
A.6.2.3 The BE shall adopt systems designed to guarantee that the
control status of products and any critical elements identified
in the context of the processes are clearly identifiable.
M
TI
A.6.2.4 The BE shall ensure that any nonconformities identified in
the context of the processes, or pertaining to the products,
are clearly identified, documented and dealt with under the
responsibility of the competent personnel.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
SI
A.6.2.1 The BE shall identify the critical variables in the main processes
and related support processes, and consequently plan the related
control measures to perform, establishing the corresponding
responsibilities, test parameters and acceptance criteria, and the
records to produce.
©
The term “Process control” is used to refer to auditing activities on several
variables of a process, or the processes supporting it, that are considered crucial
to the proper performance of the activities and consequently to the quality of the
output of said processes.
Process control may concern:
a) the accuracy and the systematic performance of certain activities at the
BE (e.g. the accurate preparation of health-care documentation under the
responsibility of the appointed personnel);
b) the accuracy and the systematic performance of certain activities handled
by other parties with which the BE interfaces (e.g. the proper compiling of
requests for services, the proper identification and the conformity of samples of
biological material received, the proper performance of outsourced activities);
c) the conformity of the materials and instruments in use (e.g. the absence of
defects in the blood collection devices before the collection process is started,
the absence of defects in apheresis kits);
26
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
d) the conformity of the outputs from certain stages in the process to the
standards established by the BE (e.g. the adequacy of blood collection in terms
of the quantity of blood drawn and the time taken, the conformity of units of
fractionated blood, the validity of analytical results, the clinical appropriateness
of transfusion requests).
Process control activities shall always be conducted whenever required by the
specific Standards defined by the present Manual.
Se
rv
iz
i
Following an analysis of the processes and the identification of any critical
variables, the BE shall formally define:
a) the tests to perform and the corresponding parameters;
b) the correlated responsibilities;
c) the methods to use to perform the tests;
d) the acceptance criteria;
e) the records to produce.
All required process control activities shall always be documented.
M
TI
A.6.2.2 The BE shall identify the critical characteristics of the products being
processed, and consequently plan the related control measures
to perform, establishing the corresponding responsibilities, test
parameters and acceptance criteria, as well as the records to produce.
The BE shall conduct appropriate tests on the critical qualitative and quantitative
characteristics of its products and of the services it delivers in accordance with the
content of the specific Standards defined in the present Manual.
particular, the BE shall formally define:
the tests to conduct and the corresponding parameters;
the correlated responsibilities;
the methods to use for the tests;
the acceptance criteria;
the records to produce.
SI
In
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
©
Tests conducted on the products and service shall always be documented.
A.6.2.3 The BE shall adopt systems designed to guarantee that the control
status of products and any critical elements identified in the context
of the processes are clearly identifiable.
The BE shall guarantee that the control status and conformity/nonconformity
of products or other critical elements identified in the context of the processes
are identifiable thanks to the use of appropriate markings (labels, signs, etc.) or
their placement in specific locations (the transfer of a product from one site to
another, the segregation of nonconforming products/materials in specific areas/
containers, etc.).
27
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.6.2.4 The BE shall ensure that any nonconformities identified in the
context of the processes, or pertaining to the products or services
are clearly identified, documented and dealt with under the
responsibility of the competent personnel.
For a definition of the term “Nonconformity”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions.
Se
rv
iz
i
The BE management shall identify any nonconformities found in relation to the
products, the services or critical elements of the processes, and plan their proper
management in terms of:
a) recording methods;
b) identification/segregation methods;
c) decision-making responsibilities to deal with nonconformities and the related
records;
d) responsibilities for implementing corrective action needed to prevent any
repetition of the nonconformities encountered.
A.6.3 STORAGE
OF
BLOOD,
BLOOD
HAEMATOPOIETIC STEM CELLS
COMPONENTS
AND
M
TI
A.6.3.1 The
BE
shall
adopt
previously-validated,
specific
procedures for the storage of blood, blood components
and haematopoietic stem cells (HSC) to guarantee
the preservation of their biological and qualitative
characteristics throughout the storage period.
SI
A.6.3.2 The BE shall adopt specific procedures for managing units
beyond their shelf life and units with anomalies identified
during their storage that can negatively influence their
suitability for use.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
©
A.6.3.1 The BE shall adopt previously-validated, specific procedures for
the storage of blood, blood components and haematopoietic stem
cells (HSC) to guarantee the preservation of their biological and
qualitative characteristics throughout the storage period.
The BE shall define and validate specific procedures relating to the methods
for storing blood, blood components and HSC (temperatures, storage times,
instruments used, etc.), in accordance with the requirements of current legislation.
These procedures shall be revalidated at regular intervals and following any
major revisions.
For a definition of the term “Validation”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions.
28
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.6.3.2 The BE shall adopt specific procedures for managing units beyond
their shelf life and units with anomalies identified during their
storage that can negatively influence their suitability for use.
iz
i
The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures for managing units beyond
their shelf life and units with anomalies identified during their storage that can
negatively influence their suitability for use, specifying:
a) the methods for segregating and disposing of the units;
b) the records to produce.
A.6.4 PACKAGING AND TRANSPORTATION OF BLOOD,
COMPONENTS AND HAEMATOPOIETIC STEM CELLS
BLOOD
Se
rv
A.6.4.1 The BE shall define and apply previously-validated, specific
procedures for packaging and transporting blood, blood
components and haematopoietic stem cells (HSC) in
accordance with the requirements of current legislation on
the proper storage of these products and the safeguarding
of operators and the environment.
M
TI
A.6.4.1.1 The BE shall define specific procedures for packaging
and transporting units of blood and blood components
collected at the blood collection units (BCUs) referring
to the BE.
A.6.4.1.2 The BE shall regulate outsourced activities for the
transportation of whole blood, blood components and
HSC on the basis of specific agreements.
SI
A.6.4.2 The BE shall prepare instructions on the proper use of the
systems for the transportation of blood, blood components
and HSC, and circulate these instructions to the healthcare organisations that refer to the BE for their transfusion
needs.
©
A.6.4.3 The BE shall define specific instructions relating to the
methods for transporting and storing blood components
and the disposal of the devices used, applicable in the case
of home blood transfusions.
29
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
A.6.4.1 The BE shall define and apply previously-validated, specific
procedures for packaging and transporting blood, blood components
and haematopoietic stem cells (HSC) in accordance with the
requirements of current legislation on the proper storage of these
products and the safeguarding of operators and the environment.
Se
rv
iz
i
Both for its own organisation and for other health-care organisations that it
serves, the BE shall define and adopt previously-validated procedures and
systems for packaging and transporting blood and blood components, particularly
as concerns the logistics, the transfer times and the methods for storing products
being transported, taking into account the requirements of current legislation for
safeguarding operators and the environment.
These procedures and systems shall be revalidated at regular intervals and
following any major changes.
For a definition of the term “Validation”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions.
M
TI
A.6.4.1.1 The BE shall define specific procedures for packaging and
transporting units of blood and blood components collected at
the blood collection units (BCUs) referring to the BE.
The procedures shall be defined by agreement with the BCUs that refer to the BE,
and the BE shall guarantee the timely notification of any revisions to the BCUs.
SI
A.6.4.1.2 The BE shall regulate outsourced activities for the
transportation of whole blood, blood components and HSC on
the basis of specific agreements.
©
Where the activities for transporting whole blood, blood components and HSC
are wholly or partly entrusted to outside contractors, their appointment shall be
governed by specific agreements and always in compliance with current legislation.
A.6.4.2 The BE shall prepare instructions on the proper use of the systems
for the transportation of blood, blood components and HSC, and
circulate these instructions to the health-care organisations that
refer to the BE for their transfusion needs.
The BE shall define specific instructions for the proper use of all the systems for
transporting blood, blood components and HSC, and circulate these instructions
to the health-care facilities that it serves.
30
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
These instructions shall indicate at least:
a) the types of container to use;
b) the packaging methods;
c) the methods adopted to guarantee the proper storage of blood and blood
components being transported.
iz
i
A.6.4.3 The BE shall prepare specific instructions relating to the methods
for transporting and storing blood components and the disposal of
the devices used, applicable in the case of home blood transfusions.
The BE shall define specific instructions to adopt in the case of home blood
transfusions.
Se
rv
These instructions shall indicate at least:
a) the types of container to use;
b) the packaging methods;
c) the methods adopted to guarantee the proper storage of blood and blood
components in transit;
d) the methods for disposing of the devices used.
A.6.5 IDENTIFICATION AND TRACEABILITY
M
TI
A.6.5.1 The BE shall guarantee the traceability of all the information
needed to reconstruct the transfusion process, from
donation to transfusion and viceversa.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
SI
A.6.5.1 The BE shall guarantee the traceability of all the information
needed to reconstruct the transfusion process, from donation to
transfusion and viceversa.
©
In accordance with the Standards specified in the single sections of the present
Manual and with current legislation, the BE shall guarantee the unequivocal
identification:
a) of patients and donors;
b) of the products and of their status at all stages of the process, from collection
to individual attribution and distribution of blood and blood components;
c) of the samples of biological material;
d) of the systems/equipment/instruments used to deliver the service (see Ch.
A.4.1);
e) of the materials used to deliver the service (see Ch. A.5).
31
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
iz
i
By producing and/or preserving appropriate records for an established period
of time (see Ch. A.2.2), the BE shall also guarantee the traceability of all the
elements needed to reconstruct the activities relating to:
a) donor management;
b) blood and blood component collection;
c) blood component treatment, control and validation;
d) blood component handling and transportation;
e) the management of individual attribution and distribution of blood components;
f) transfused patient management.
The records shall be produced so as to guarantee that it is always possible to
trace the individuals responsible for performing the above-mentioned activities.
Se
rv
The BE shall also guarantee the traceability of all the data and records needed
to provide evidence of the application of the Standards defined in the present
Manual, where applicable.
A.6.6 MANAGEMENT OF ORGANISATIONAL AND TECHNOLOGICAL
EMERGENCIES
M
TI
A.6.6.1 The BE shall identify the main organisational and
technological emergencies that might occur at the
establishment and adopt practices designed to guarantee
the continuity of the service nonetheless.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
SI
A.6.6.1 The BE shall identify the main organisational and technological
emergencies that might occur at the establishment and adopt
practices designed to guarantee the continuity of the service
nonetheless.
©
The term “Emergencies” is used here to mean all “critical” unexpected situations
with which the BE must cope by implementing prompt and effective responses and
solutions in order to guarantee the safety of the users and operators, as well as
the continuity of the service in accordance with the established quality levels, also
in compliance with provisions issued by the Regional Blood Coordinating Centres,
the National Blood Centre, and the Ministry of Health.
Examples of “organisational emergencies” may include: the unprogrammed
absence of personnel; the blood component stock dropping below a defined
threshold; difficulties in meeting programmed blood collection demands due
to particular contingencies (e.g. in the case of pandemics or other particular
epidemiological situations, or earthquakes); depletion of the stocks of therapeutic
apheresis kits; depletion of stocks of reagents and materials for crucial laboratory
tests; inability to contact personnel on call, or the latter’s inability to reach the
establishment.
32
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
“Technological emergencies” include, for instance: sudden breakdowns of “critical”
systems/equipment/instruments that interfere with ordinary activities or that have
a significant impact on the quality of products/services (e.g. a telecommunications
network outage lasting beyond a certain period of time, a computer system crash,
the breakdown of an apparatus used for critical laboratory tests or for therapeutic
apheresis).
iz
i
The BE shall identify the principal organisational and technological emergencies
that might occur at the establishment and plan the procedures to implement in
order to guarantee the continuity of the service.
A.7 QUALITY MONITORING, ANALYSIS AND IMPROVEMENT
Se
rv
The BE management is responsible for constantly controlling the quality level of
the processes, the products and the services being delivered by implementing a
monitoring system designed to identify and correct any nonconformities, as well as
identifying the need for improvements in the quality standards and consequently
implementing adequate organisational and technical changes.
A.7.1 QUALITY MONITORING
M
TI
A.7.1.1 The BE shall implement a systematic monitoring and
data analysis activity on the processes and on the quality
of the products and services in order to identify any
nonconformities that demand the adoption of corrective
actions, or to identify any unfavourable trends that demand
the adoption of preventive actions.
SI
A.7.1.2 The BE shall guarantee the conduction of regular quality
audits on the main processes and on the related support
processes/activities, conducted by independent, qualified
and competent individuals on the basis of specific
procedures, in order to assess their systematic compliance
with the applicable prescriptive documentation.
A.7.1.3 The BE shall adopt specific procedures to manage complaints
arriving from users.
©
A.7.1.4 The BE management shall guarantee the analysis and
overall assessment, at least once a year, of the BE’s
quality-related data in order to measure the level of the
establishment’s adequacy and efficiency and to ensure the
adoption of adequate corrective and preventive actions, as
well as the definition of quality improvement objectives to
pursue.
33
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
A.7.1.1 The BE shall implement a systematic monitoring and data analysis
activity on the processes and on the quality of the products and
services in order to identify any nonconformities that demand the
adoption of corrective actions, or to identify any unfavourable
trends that demand the adoption of preventive actions.
iz
i
The BE shall conduct a systematic monitoring and data analysis activity on the
processes and the quality of the products and services in order to identify any
critical issues.
M
TI
Se
rv
In particular, the monitoring plan implemented shall indicate:
a) the characteristics monitored for the various types of products or services and
for the critical process variables;
b) the control indicators adopted;
c) the reference standards (expected values, where applicable, particularly relating
to the products, with reference to available guidelines or the consolidated
experience of the BE);
d) the data needed for monitoring purposes and the corresponding sources;
e) the responsibility for data collection;
f) the methods and instruments to use for data collection;
g) the responsibility for, and frequency of data-processing;
h) the responsibility for analysing the indexes obtained and for taking any
corrective actions.
The monitoring and analytical activities shall be documented.
SI
A.7.1.2 The BE shall guarantee the conduction of regular quality audits on
the main processes and on the related support processes/activities,
conducted by independent, qualified and competent individuals on
the basis of specific procedures, in order to assess their systematic
compliance with the applicable prescriptive documentation.
©
To ascertain the systematic compliance of all operators with the applicable
prescriptive documentation, the BE shall define and apply specific procedures
envisaging the performance of regular audits, which shall specify:
a) the management of procedures for qualifying the personnel responsible for
conducting the audits;
b) the criteria for programming audits to be conducted at the establishment
(responsibility for the approval of these programmes lies with the BE
management);
c) the criteria and responsibilities for organising, preparing and performing single
audits and for documenting their outcome;
d) the responsibilities and methods for implementing corrective and preventive
actions to deal with any nonconformities emerging during the course of audits.
34
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
The personnel responsible for conducting the audits shall have been previously
qualified to conduct this activity as a result of specific training (provided on courses
conducted by qualified personnel, gained by working alongside expert auditors,
etc.) and they shall not have any responsibility for the areas/activities being
audited in order to guarantee the utmost objectivity in the outcome of the audits.
iz
i
The BE shall systematically document the outcome of audits and implement
appropriate corrective and preventive actions in the event of nonconformities being
identified, or any situations interfering with the quality of the products and services.
A.7.1.3 The BE shall adopt specific procedures to manage complaints from
users.
Se
rv
The BE shall guarantee all users (patients, donors, hospital physicians, general
practitioners/specialists, other services) the proper management of any complaints
it receives.
M
TI
For this purpose, the BE shall define and apply specific procedures designed to
govern:
a) the methods and instruments for recording complaints;
b) the responsibilities for managing/dealing with complaints;
c) the responsibilities and criteria for processing and analysing data relating to
complaints;
in order to identify any critical issues relating to the quality of products/services
and to take adequate corrective actions to deal with them.
SI
A.7.1.4 The BE management shall guarantee the analysis and overall
assessment, at least once a year, of the BE’s quality-related data
in order to measure the level of the establishment’s adequacy and
efficiency and to ensure the adoption of adequate corrective and
preventive actions, as well as the definition of quality improvement
objectives to pursue.
©
The BE management shall conduct an analysis and global assessment of the BE’s
quality-related data, involving all the responsible persons at the establishment, and
paying particular attention to technical/professional issues, in order to measure:
a) the adequacy of the establishment’s strategies, general objectives and policies
(see Ch. A.1.1);
b) the degree to which the planned specific improvement objectives have been
achieved (see Ch. A.1.1);
c) the adequacy and the level of process control, based on previously-defined
indicators (see Standard A.7.1.1);
d) the quality level of the products/services being delivered, based on previouslydefined indicators (see Standard A.7.1.1);
e) the degree to which the prescriptive documentation applicable to the BE is
applied, based on the outcome of the quality auditing activities (see Standard
A.7.1.2);
35
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
iz
i
f) the level of satisfaction of users of the BE’s products/services (see Standard
A.7.1.3);
g) the adequacy of the personnel’s skills and the need to provide training (see
Ch. A.3.1);
h) the adequacy of the human, technological, structural and material resources
available;
i) the adequacy of the BE in relation to advances in the reference setting (changes
in the reference legislation, changes in the demand and the needs of users,
advances in technology and in the offer of resources, etc.).
M
TI
Se
rv
In the light of the results of this assessment, the BE management shall:
a) redefine the strategies, general objectives and policies to pursue at the
establishment, where necessary;
b) redefine the establishment’s specific quality improvement objectives, where
necessary;
c) revise the plan for monitoring the quality of products and processes, where
applicable, in the light of critical issues emerging during the course of the
analysis;
d) revise the methods for managing the establishment’s processes, where
advisable;
e) assess the adequacy of the resources in place; ;
f) plan any necessary personnel training and updating courses;
g) programme the quality auditing activities at the BE;
h) plan any corrective or preventive actions with a view to eliminating or preventing
any critical issues encountered or potentially emerging.
The results of the assessment and the actions planned as a consequence shall be
documented.
In addition, the findings shall be notified to all personnel operating at the BE and
the action taken to circulate the results shall be documented (by means of the
minutes of meetings held for said purpose or equivalent methods).
SI
A.7.2 CORRECTIVE AND PREVENTIVE ACTIONS
©
A.7.2.1 The BE shall plan and implement preventive and corrective
actions designed to prevent the occurrence or repetition of
nonconformities.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
A.7.2.1 The BE shall plan and implement preventive and corrective actions
designed to prevent the occurrence or repetition of nonconformities.
For a definition of the terms “Nonconformity”, “Corrective action”, and “Preventive
action”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion Medicine Standards, Definitions.
36
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
iz
i
To deal with severe or systematic nonconformities, or to deal with situations “at
risk” of generating nonconformities, the BE shall:
a) identify situations necessitating corrective and preventive actions;
b) identify the causes of any shortcomings identified, by means of appropriate
analyses where necessary;
c) identify the corrective or preventive actions to undertake, tailoring them to the
existing risks;
d) plan and implement the required action;
e) assess the efficacy of the action in relation to the established objectives.
Se
rv
Any corrective and preventive actions implemented, together with the related
planning and auditing details, shall be documented.
A.8 INFORMATION REPORTING
A.8.1 The BE shall guarantee the collection of all data and information
required by the National Blood IT System (SISTRA), in
accordance with current legislation and the recommendations
of the Regional Blood Coordinating Centre and the National
Blood Centre.
A.8.1
M
TI
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall guarantee the collection of all data and information
required by the National Blood IT System (SISTRA), in accordance
with current legislation and the recommendations of the Regional
Blood Coordinating Centre and the National Blood Centre.
SI
The BE shall guarantee the collection of the data and information required by
the National Blood IT System (SISTRA) in accordance with current legislation and
with the recommendations of the Regional Blood Coordinating Centres and the
National Blood Centre.
©
The BE management shall appoint a reference person for the SISTRA IT system.
37
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
A.9 PARTICIPATION AS PARTNERS IN RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT
SCHEMES
A.9.1 RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT PARTNERSHIPS
iz
i
SIMTI periodically promotes research and development projects and schemes in
the area of transfusion medicine with a view to providing scientific contributions
on the main aspects of the discipline. In some cases, significant results can
be obtained by undertaking data collection and/or experimentation by means
of multicentre studies, particularly for epidemiological reporting projects and
schemes demanding the qualitative and quantitative evaluation and broad-based
comparison of activities or segments of the activities of organisational, managerial
and technical-scientific interest.
©
SI
M
TI
Se
rv
It is recommended that the BE assures its participation in research and
development schemes and projects promoted by SIMTI, also in cooperation with
other scientific associations, public institutions or other bodies, and particularly
when its involvement is specifically requested by SIMTI.
38
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
ANNEX 1
PROFESSIONAL SKILLS OF HEALTH-CARE PERSONNEL
Foreword
Se
rv
iz
i
The personnel belonging to all the professional categories (physicians, biologists,
nurses, biomedical laboratory technicians, social health operators, administrative
staff, and any others) who work at the BE, and at the related organisations and
blood collection units managed by accredited associations and federations of blood
donors (BCUs) referring to the BE, may:
a) be employed under permanent or temporary employment contracts;
b) operate on the basis of an independent contract (e.g. as freelance professionals
or in other forms of cooperation);
c) work on a voluntary basis, particularly at BCUs.
In addition to the professional requirements pertinent to their qualifications and
established by current legislation, all the health-care personnel must possess
adequate professional skills, intended as the know-how and expertise needed
to ensure the quality of the products and services provided by the BE, each in
relation to his/her job description and responsibilities.
M
TI
1. Physician expert in transfusion medicine (TM)
The physician expert in TM shall guarantee the necessary professional skills at
least in the following areas:
Skills
References
Chapter
Information, education and promotion of awareness of blood
donors
B
B.2.1
Clinical selection and counselling of blood donors
B
B.2.2
B.6
Management of blood donor deferral
B
B.2.3
Retrospective investigations and assessments on the risk of
transfusion-transmissible diseases associated with clinical and
diagnostic elements relating to donors and donations
B
B.2.3
Criteria and procedures for collecting whole blood
B
B.3.1
B.3.3
Criteria and procedures for collecting blood components and HSC
using apheretic methods
B
B.3.2
B.3.3
©
SI
Section
39
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
Skills
2nd Edition
References
Chapter
Clinical care of donors and diagnosis and treatment of adverse
reactions and adverse events potentially associated with whole
blood donations and apheresis procedures
B
B.4
Procedures and methods for producing “1st-level” blood
components
C
C.1.1
Procedures and methods for producing “2nd-level” blood
components
C
C.1.2
C
A.6.5
C.4
Quality requirements for blood components and criteria for
processing and assessing the results of quality control on blood
components
C
C.5
Assessment criteria for the biological qualification of blood
components that contribute to determining their suitability for
transfusion (biological validation)
C
C.6
Criteria for assessing the appropriateness of transfusion requests
D
D.2
D.3
Immunohaematological and clinical criteria for the selection and
individual attribution of blood components
D
D.4
Selection/ definition of guidelines for the appropriate clinical use
of blood components
D
D.4
G.2.1.2
Clinical and diagnostic management of reports of adverse
reactions to transfusion
D
D.5
Epidemiology, clinical management and supervision of
transfusion-transmissible diseases
D
D.5
Management of activities for blood component delivery, intraand inter-regional compensation, and delivery of plasma to
fractionation industries
D
D.5
D.8.1
D.8.2
Criteria and methods for managing stocks of blood components
D
D.7
General elements of clinical pathology and laboratory diagnostics,
with particular reference to the significance of, and methods for
internal quality control and external quality auditing
E
E.2
E.4
Immunohaematological serology: diagnostic applications,
analytical methods and clinical implications
E
E.3
Prevention, diagnosis and treatment of the haemolytic
disease of the newborn, with particular reference to clinical,
immunohaematological and transfusion issues
E
E.3.6
Diagnosis and treatment of autoimmune haemolytic diseases,
with particular reference to clinical, immunohaematological and
transfusion issues
E
E.3.7
©
SI
M
TI
Se
rv
Procedures and reference standards for the identification and
traceability of units of blood and blood components
iz
i
Section
40
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
Skills
2nd Edition
References
Section
Chapter
E
E.5
Clinical and organisational management of autologous transfusion
procedures, with particular reference to the pre-operative
autologous blood donation for elective surgery
F
F.1
F.2
iz
i
Elements of platelet and leucocyte immunohaematology, with
particular reference to the diagnostic and clinical implications of
interest in transfusion medicine
G
Se
rv
Criteria for the selection/definition of diagnostic-therapeutic
guidelines for the most common and/or critical diseases treated
as part of the clinical care for outpatients and hospitalised
patients provided by the BE
G.2
Clinical and organisational management of clinical care for
outpatients and hospitalised patients provided by the BE
G
G.2
Diagnosis and treatment of adverse reactions and adverse
events associated with therapeutic treatments provided at the BE
G
G.2
Criteria for assessing the efficacy of administered therapeutic
treatments
G
G.2
Current applicable legislation on transfusion activities
/
/
In relation to the person’s job description and responsibilities
A
A.1
Management of human resources, technologies, materials,
prescriptive documents and quality data and records, main
processes and support processes
A
A.2
A.3
A.4
A.5
A.6
Regulations relating to the management of health-care
documentation
A
A.2
A
A.7
SI
M
TI
Elements of the BE’s managerial strategy
©
Quality monitoring, analysis and improvement
41
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
2. Physician responsible for selecting donors of whole blood and blood
components
The physician responsible for selecting blood donors shall guarantee the necessary
professional skills at least in the following areas:
Skills
References
Chapter
B
B.2.1
B
B.2.2
B.6
B
B.2.3
Criteria, procedures and technologies for collecting whole blood
B
B.3.1
B.3.3
Criteria, procedures and technologies for collecting blood
components using apheretic methods, where applicable
B
B.3.2
B.3.3
Information, education and promotion of awareness of blood
donors
Management of blood donor deferral
Se
rv
Clinical selection and counselling of blood donors
iz
i
Section
Clinical care of donors and diagnosis and treatment of adverse
reactions and adverse events potentially associated with whole
blood donations and, where applicable, with apheresis procedures
B.4
C
A.6.5
C.4
Essential elements relating to blood component quality
requirements and quality control
C
C.5
Essential elements relating to the assessment criteria for the
biological qualification of blood components that concur to
determining their suitability for transfusion
C
C.6
Elements of epidemiology and prevention of transfusiontransmissible diseases
D
D.5
Current applicable legislation on transfusion activities
/
/
SI
M
TI
Procedures and reference standards for the identification and
traceability of units of blood and blood components
In relation to the person’s job description and responsibilities
A
A.1
Management of technologies, materials used to deliver the
service, prescriptive documents and quality data and records, and
main processes of specific interest
A
A.2
A.3
A.4
A.5
A.6
Regulations relating to the management of health-care
documentation
A
A.2
Quality monitoring, analysis and improvement as applicable to
the job description
A
A.7
©
Elements of the BE’s management strategy
42
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
3. Biologist
The biologist shall guarantee the necessary professional skills at least in the
following areas:
Skills
References
Section
Chapter
B
B.3.1
B.3.3
Procedures and technologies for collecting blood components and
HSC using apheretic methods, excluding the aspects relating to
donor care
B
B.3.2
B.3.3
Procedures and methods for producing “1st-level” blood
components
C
C.1.1
Procedures and methods for producing “2nd-level” blood
components
C
C.1.2
Procedures and reference standards for the identification and
traceability of units of blood and blood components
C
A.6.5
C.4
Quality requirements for blood components and criteria for
processing and assessing the results of quality control on blood
components
C
C.5
Assessment criteria for the biological qualification of blood
components that contribute to determining their suitability for
transfusion (biological validation)
C
C.6
Criteria for assessing transfusion requests
D
D.2
D.3
Immunohaematological criteria and basic elements for the
selection of blood components to be individually attributed to
patients
D
D.4
Immunohaematological diagnostic methods relating to the
reporting of adverse reactions to blood component transfusion
D
D.5
Epidemiology and surveillance of transfusion-transmissible
diseases
D
D.5
Management of activities for blood component delivery, intraand inter-regional compensation, and delivery of plasma to
fractionation industries
D
D.5
D.8.1
D.8.2
Criteria and methods for managing stocks of blood components
D
D.7
General elements of clinical pathology and laboratory diagnostics,
with particular reference to the significance of, and methods for
internal quality control and external quality auditing
E
E.2
E.4
Genetics and systematics of erythrocyte blood groups: diagnostic
and technical applications, and clinical implications in blood
transfusions
E
E.3
©
SI
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
Procedures and technologies for collecting whole blood, excluding
the aspects relating to donor care
43
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
Skills
2nd Edition
References
Chapter
Immunohaematological serology: assessment, application and
auditing of diagnostic methods
E
E.3
Elements of the prevention, diagnosis and treatment of
the haemolytic diseases of the newborn, with reference to
immunohaematological diagnostic methods
E
E.3.6
Elements of the diagnosis and treatment of autoimmune
haemolytic diseases, with reference to immunohaematological
diagnostic methods
E
E.3.7
Elements of platelet and leucocyte immunohaematology, with
reference to the diagnostic and clinical implications of interest in
transfusion medicine
E
E.5
Current applicable legislation on transfusion activities
/
Se
rv
iz
i
Section
/
In relation to the person’s job description and responsibilities
A
A.1
Management of human resources, technologies, materials used to
deliver the service, prescriptive documents and quality data and
records, main processes and support processes
A
A.2
A.3
A.4
A.5
A.6
Regulations relating to the management of health-care
documentation
A
A.2
Quality monitoring, analysis and improvement
A
A.7
©
SI
M
TI
Elements of the BE’s management strategy
44
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
4. Nurse
The nurse shall guarantee the necessary professional skills at least in the following
areas:
Skills
References
Section
Chapter
B
B.2.1
iz
i
Information, education and promotion of awareness of blood
donors
Support to the clinical selection and counselling of blood donors
B
B.2.2
B.6
Support to the management of deferred blood donors
B
B.2.3
B
B.3.1
B.3.3
B
B.3.2
B.3.3
Se
rv
Procedures and technologies for collecting whole blood and for
submitting collected units to subsequent processing stages
Procedures and technologies for collecting blood components and
HSC using apheretic methods and for submitting collected units
to subsequent processing stages
Care of the donor and treatment of any adverse reactions and
adverse events potentially associated with whole blood donations
and apheresis procedures
C
C.1.1
Procedures and reference standards for the identification and
traceability of units of blood and blood components
C
A.6.5
C.4
Basic elements relating to blood component quality requirements
and quality control
C
C.5
Essential elements relating to the assessment criteria for the
biological qualification of blood components that contribute to
determining their suitability for transfusion
C
C.6
Essential elements relating to the appropriate clinical use of blood
components
D
D.4
G.2.1.2
Essential elements of the management of activities for blood
component delivery, intra- and inter-regional compensation, and
delivery of plasma to fractionation industries
D
D.5
D.8.1
D.8.2
Essential elements relating to the criteria and methods for
managing stocks of blood components
D
D.7
Essential elements of systematics of erythrocyte blood groups
and immunohaematological serology, and clinical implications of
immunological compatibility in blood transfusions
E
E.3
Organisation, technologies and patient care needs related to
autologous transfusion procedures, with particular reference to
pre-operative autologous blood donation for elective surgery
F
F.1
F.2
Selection/ definition of patient care protocols for the most
common and/or critical diseases treated as part of the clinical
activities for outpatients and hospitalised patients at the BE
G
G.2
©
SI
M
TI
Basic knowledge of the procedures and methods for producing
blood components
B.4
45
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
Skills
2nd Edition
References
Chapter
Organisation, technologies and patient care needs related to the
clinical activities for outpatients and hospitalised patients at the
BE
G
G.2
Prompt identification and treatment of adverse reactions and
adverse events associated with the therapeutic treatments
provided at the BE
G
G.2
Identification of diagnostic and clinical elements for assessing the
efficacy of administered therapeutic treatments
G
G.2
Current applicable legislation on transfusion activities
/
/
iz
i
Section
Se
rv
In relation to the person’s job description and responsibilities
A
A.1
Management of human resources, technologies, materials used to
deliver the service, prescriptive documents and quality data and
records, and main processes and support processes
A
A.2
A.3
A.4
A.5
A.6
Regulations relating to the management of health-care
documentation
A
A.2
Quality monitoring, analysis and improvement
A
A.7
©
SI
M
TI
Elements of the BE’s management strategy
46
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
2nd Edition
5. Biomedical laboratory technician
The biomedical laboratory technician shall guarantee the necessary professional
skills at least in the following areas:
Skills
References
Chapter
Procedures and technologies for collecting whole blood, excluding
the aspects relating to donor care
B
B.3.1
B.3.3
Procedures and technologies for collecting blood components and
HSC using apheretic methods, excluding the aspects relating to
donor care
B
B.3.2
B.3.3
Procedures and methods for producing “1st-level” blood
components
C
C.1.1
Procedures and methods for producing “2nd-level” blood
components
C
C.1.2
Procedures and methods for freezing and thawing blood
components
C
c.2.1
Procedures and reference standards for the identification and
traceability of units of blood and blood components
C
A.6.5
C.4
Quality requirements for blood components, and processing and
assessing the results of quality control on blood components
C
C.5
Essential elements relating to the assessment criteria for the
biological qualification of blood components that contribute to
determining their suitability for transfusion
C
C.6
Criteria for assessing transfusion requests
D
D.2
D.3
Immunohaematological criteria and essential elements for the
selection of blood components to be individually attributed to
patients
D
D.4
Essential elements relating to the appropriate clinical use of blood
components
D
D.4
G.2.1.2
Immunohaematological diagnostic methods relating to the
reporting of adverse reactions to transfusions
D
D.5
Essential elements of the epidemiology and surveillance of
transfusion-transmissible diseases
D
D.5
Management of activities for blood component delivery, intraand inter-regional compensation, and delivery of plasma to
fractionation industries
D
D.5
D.8.1
D.8.2
Criteria and methods for managing stocks of blood components
D
D.7
General elements of laboratory diagnostics, with particular
reference to the significance of, and methods for internal quality
control and external quality auditing
E
E.2
E.4
©
SI
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
Section
47
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section A - General organisational requirements
Skills
2nd Edition
References
Chapter
Elements of systematics and genetics of erythrocyte blood
groups: diagnostic and technical applications, and clinical
implications in blood transfusions
E
E.3
Immunohaematological serology: assessment, application and
auditing of diagnostic methods
E
E.3
Elements of the prevention, diagnosis and treatment of the
haemolytic diseases of the newborn, with specific reference to
the immunohaematological diagnostic methods
E
E.3.6
E
E.3.7
Se
rv
Elements of the diagnosis and treatment of autoimmune
haemolytic diseases, with specific reference to the
immunohaematological diagnostic methods
iz
i
Section
Elements of platelet and leucocyte immunohaematology, with
particular reference to the technical implications of interest in
transfusion medicine
E
E.5
Elements of the management of autologous units
F
F.2
Current applicable legislation on transfusion activities
/
/
In relation to the person’s job description and responsibilities
A
A.1
Management of human resources, technologies, materials used to
deliver the service, prescriptive documents and quality data and
records, and main processes and support processes
A
A.2
A.3
A.4
A.5
A.6
Regulations relating to the management of health-care
documentation
A
A.2
Quality monitoring, analysis and improvement
A
A.7
©
SI
M
TI
Elements of the BE’s management strategy
48
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
SECTION B
COLLECTION OF BLOOD AND BLOOD COMPONENTS
iz
i
CONTENTS
Se
rv
B.1 PROGRAMMING THE COLLECTION OF BLOOD AND BLOOD
COMPONENTS ................................................................................................................................. 50
B.2 MANAGEMENT OF DONORS OF BLOOD AND BLOOD
COMPONENTS ................................................................................................................................. 52
B.2.1 AWARENESS, INFORMATION AND EDUCATION OF DONORS
OF BLOOD AND BLOOD COMPONENTS ....................................................... 52
B.2.2 SELECTION OF DONORS OF BLOOD
AND BLOOD COMPONENTS ...................................................................................
54
B.2.3 MANAGEMENT OF DEFERRED DONORS
60
.......................................................
M
TI
B.3 WHOLE BLOOD COLLECTION AND APHERESIS
..........................................
B.3.1 PREPARATION AND CONTROL OF MATERIALS
AND INSTRUMENTS FOR COLLECTING WHOLE BLOOD
..............
63
63
B.3.2 PREPARATION AND CONTROL OF MATERIALS
AND INSTRUMENTS USED FOR APHERESIS .......................................... 64
SI
B.3.3 WHOLE BLOOD COLLECTION AND APHERESIS PROCEDURES
.....
66
B.4 DONOR CARE DURING WHOLE BLOOD COLLECTION AND
APHERESIS PROCEDURES ................................................................................................. 70
B.5 DONOR HAEMOVIGILANCE
..............................................................................................
72
©
B.6 DIAGNOSTIC INVESTIGATIONS CONDUCTED FOR EVERY
DONATION, AT REGULAR INTERVALS,
AND IN PARTICULAR SITUATIONS ......................................................................... 73
B.7 MANAGEMENT OF DONORS’ DATA
...........................................................................
75
B.8 REGULATION AND CONTROL OF ACTIVITIES AT BLOOD
COLLECTION SITES ..................................................................................................................
77
B.9 PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
82
............................................................................
49
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
For the Standards on the collection of haematopoietic stem cells, see Section
G - Collection of haematopoietic stem cells and other clinical activities in
transfusion medicine.
B.1 PROGRAMMING THE COLLECTION OF BLOOD AND BLOOD COMPONENTS
iz
i
B.1.1 The BE shall guarantee the planning of its blood component
needs on at least an annual basis, with periodic infra-annual
reviews.
Se
rv
B.1.2 The collection of blood and blood components shall be
programmed on at least an annual basis, with periodic infraannual reviews, in cooperation with the associations and
federations of blood donors.
B.1.2.1 Donors belonging to associations and federations of blood
donors shall be invited to donate on the basis of dedicated
agreements between their associations and federations
and the BE.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall guarantee the planning of its blood component needs
on at least an annual basis, with periodic infra-annual reviews.
M
TI
B.1.1
SI
The definition of the blood component needs shall take into account:
a) the needs of the health care areas served by the BE;
b) any need to obtain blood components from other BEs if the BE is not
self-sufficient;
c) any commitment to supply blood components to other BEs (inside or outside
the region) if the BE has a production capacity that exceeds its own needs.
©
This planning shall also be consistent with regional and national programmes/plans
designed to achieve self-sufficiency for blood components and plasma-derived
medicinal products.
Infra-annual reviews of blood component needs should be conducted on at least
a three-monthly basis.
The BE shall provide documented evidence of the planning of its needs and of its
corresponding infra-annual reviews.
The commitments or agreements for planning supplies to, or acquisitions
from other bodies shall be managed by arrangement with the Regional Blood
Coordinating Centre.
50
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
B.1.2
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
The collection of blood and blood components shall be programmed
on at least an annual basis, with periodic infra-annual reviews, in
cooperation with the associations and federations of blood donors.
The programming of the collection of blood and blood components shall be
consistent with the BE’s planned blood component needs (see Standard B.1.1).
Se
rv
iz
i
The annual programming of the collection of blood and blood components, and
the related periodic infra-annual reviews shall be done in cooperation with the
associations and federations of donors referring to the BE and to the connected
blood collection sites (BCS).
The collection programme shall be periodically reviewed in parallel with the infraannual reviews of the planned needs for blood components and the production of
plasma to submit to pharmaceutical processing (see Standard B.1.1).
The BE shall provide documented evidence of its programming activities and all
related reviews thereof.
Relations between the BE and the associations and federations of donors shall be
governed by specific agreements stipulated by the hospital management to which
the BE responds and by the associations and federations involved1.
M
TI
Up-to-date copies of these agreements governing the activities of the associations
and federations of donors operating within the area served by the BE should be
available at the BE.
SI
Permanent consulting and/or coordinating bodies shall be created with the
associations and federations of donors referring to the BE for the purpose of
identifying and implementing synergies and the levels of cooperation needed
for an effective and efficient programming and periodic review of the collection
activities with a view to tending towards an optimal, flexible alignment of said
activities with the blood component needs for clinical purposes (including the
needs for compensatory supply/acquisition activities) and for plasma to submit to
pharmaceutical processing.
©
The creation of said bodies shall be specified in the agreements signed by the
hospital management to which the BE responds and by the associations and
federations of donors.
These bodies should have tasks and functions in the following areas:
a) guidance on, and control of blood collection activities;
b) management of information flows between the BE and the associations and
federations of donors;
c) monitoring and assessment of specific objectives;
1
Facsimiles of these agreements are generally prepared by the Regional Authorities and
Autonomous Provinces, with specific documents based on models defined at national
level.
51
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
iz
i
d) assessment of the adequacy of the BE’s structural and technological equipment
and human resources vis-à-vis the planned activities, and consequent proposals
for the hospital management to make any necessary adjustments;
e) assessment of the adequacy of the structural and technological equipment and
human resources at the BCS connected to the BE;
f) the promotion of blood donation;
g) action to educate blood donors on health issues and preventive medicine;
h) other areas where synergies with the associations and federations of donors
can generate added value.
Se
rv
B.1.2.1 Donors belonging to associations and federations of blood donors
shall be invited to donate on the basis of dedicated agreements
between their associations and federations and the BE.
In accordance with current legislation, associations and federations of donors are
responsible for inviting their members to give blood on the basis of programmes
defined by agreement with the BE to which they refer.
M
TI
The methods and plans for inviting donors shall be agreed and implemented
on the basis of arrangements made, at the time of programming the collection
activities, between the permanent consultation and/or coordination body and the
associations and federations of donors referring to the BE and the related BCS
(see Standard B.1.2).
Methods shall be arranged for inviting donors in the event of a reduction of
the blood stock, in emergency situations (e.g. epidemiological contingencies,
earthquakes), and for particular clinical requirements (e.g. the need for blood
components with specific cell phenotypes).
SI
B.2 MANAGEMENT OF DONORS OF BLOOD AND BLOOD COMPONENTS
B.2.1 AWARENESS, INFORMATION AND EDUCATION OF DONORS OF
BLOOD AND BLOOD COMPONENTS
©
B.2.1.1 In co-operation with the associations and federations of
blood donors, the BE shall guarantee that donors receive
proper information and education on all aspects relating to
the donation of blood and blood components.
B.2.1.2 The BE shall guarantee its co-operation on health care
education schemes relating to the donation of blood
and blood components promoted by associations and
federations of blood donors and by health care institutions.
52
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
B.2.1.1 In co-operation with the associations and federations of blood
donors, the BE shall guarantee that donors receive proper
information and education on all aspects relating to the donation
of blood and blood components.
iz
i
The activities for promoting blood donations and improving the blood donor’s
awareness, loyalty, information and education are strategic to the achievement
and maintenance of local, regional and national self-sufficiency for blood, blood
components and plasma derivatives, as well as for transfusion safety.
Se
rv
In these activities, the BE shall guarantee the necessary co-operation with the
associations and federations of donors inasmuch as concerns the health care and
technical-scientific aspects.
In particular, the BE shall guarantee its contribution to information and education
activities so as to provide donors with all the necessary details, as established by
current legislation, in a scientifically correct, up-to-date and suitably understandable
form, so that they can make an informed and responsible donation, in terms of
safeguarding the health of recipients and donors.
M
TI
The explanatory material shall also contain essential, understandable details
relating to the characteristics of blood, blood components and plasma derivatives,
and the strategic value of transfusion therapy in health care.
©
SI
Said material shall provide:
a) the reasons why donors complete a medical history questionnaire and undergo
an assessment of their general state of health and physical conditions, and
laboratory tests are conducted for the biological validation of their donations;
b) information on the risk of transmitting infectious diseases via blood and blood
products, as well as the reasons and types of behaviour that make people
ineligible as donors because they could pose a health risk to recipients;
c) the meaning of the terms “informed consent”, “self-deferral”, “temporary
deferral”, “permanent deferral”;
d) the reasons why people must not donate blood because the donation could
have a negative effect on their own health;
e) specific details on the different donation procedures;
f) the opportunity to ask for further information at any time during the procedure;
g) the opportunity to withdraw or postpone a donation at the donor’s discretion at
any time during the procedure;
h) the assurance that donors will be informed if tests performed identify any
diseases and, if necessary, their donations will not be used;
i) the reasons why donors must promptly notify the health care personnel at the
BE of any diseases or symptoms they develop after making a donation, and
especially in the first few days afterwards.
Steps shall be taken to ensure that potential donors who are blind, or whose sight
is severely impaired, can be informed and are able to understand the contents of
the explanatory documents.
53
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
B.2.1.2 The BE shall guarantee its co-operation on health care education
schemes relating to the donation of blood and blood components
promoted by associations and federations of blood donors and by
health care institutions.
Se
rv
iz
i
Health care education schemes and investigations conducted to safeguard the
donor’s health and the safety of recipients are a significant resource in preventive
medicine and epidemiology for achieving some of the main goals of the national
health care programmes, such as promoting healthy behaviour and lifestyles
designed to prevent the most common diseases.
For this purpose, the associations and federations of donors and the health care
institutions may promote disease prevention and health education schemes also
based on analyses and epidemiological assessments of data recorded on donors
and donations.
The BE shall guarantee its cooperation on such schemes, inasmuch as concerns
the health care and technical-scientific aspects, possibly also by conducting
surveys, analyses and assessments on epidemiological data obtained on donors
and donations.
B.2.2 SELECTION OF DONORS OF BLOOD AND BLOOD COMPONENTS
M
TI
B.2.2.1 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures that
define the responsibilities and the working methods to use
for donor selection.
B.2.2.1.1 The donor selection procedures shall implement
the documents/guidelines to which the BE refers as
concerns the medical history and clinical criteria for
allowing donors to donate and the diagnostic tests to
perform prior to the donation.
SI
B.2.2.1.2 The donor selection procedures shall define specific
criteria for selecting candidate donors and returning
donors (i.e. donors who have not donated in the last
24 months).
©
B.2.2.1.3 The donor selection procedures shall define specific
criteria for selecting donors for apheresis donations.
B.2.2.1.4 The decision on a donor’s eligibility to donate shall be
made at every donation and recorded in the donor’s
file.
B.2.2.1.5 To obtain their informed consent to the donation, the
BE shall provide donors with all the information they
need in a clear and comprehensible manner.
54
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
B.2.2.1 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures that define
the responsibilities and the working methods to use for donor
selection.
iz
i
The physician responsible for donor selection and the transfusion medicine
physician are entrusted with donor selection and the resulting decision on a
donor’s eligibility to donate (for a definition of the corresponding job descriptions,
see Section A - General organisational requirements, Annex 1 - Professional skills
of health care personnel).
M
TI
Se
rv
The donor selection procedures shall define the responsibilities and working
methods to adopt in completing the following activities:
a) checking the donor’s identity by means of an ID document that includes a
photograph of the donor;
b) collecting details of the donor’s medical history;
c) assessing the donor’s general state of health;
d) ascertaining the donor’s physical condition;
e) performing the pre-donation diagnostic tests;
f) declaring the donor eligible to donate;
g) obtaining the donor’s informed consent to the donation and to the processing
of his/her personal data.
The BE shall guarantee that the whole donor selection process takes place in a
manner that safeguards the donor’s privacy in accordance with current legislation.
SI
“Dedicated” donations, or those provided by minors, shall be exceptional practices
reserved for very particular cases (e.g. to collect haematopoietic progenitor cells or
lymphocytes for DLI - Donor Lymphocyte Infusions); in such cases, the applicable
acceptance criteria and working methods shall be defined and documented,
particularly as concerns obtaining informed consent.
©
The following steps should also be taken:
a) criteria and methods should be defined and documented for the “customisation”
of the donation depending on the particular physical, biohumoral and clinical
characteristics of the donor;
b) working methods should be designed to facilitate disabled donors judged
eligible to donate.
For donors coming from geographical areas at higher risk of transfusiontransmissible diseases than in the country of the BE, approval of the donation
shall be governed as part of specific programmes/procedures, particularly if the
donors concerned are likely to travel periodically to and from their geographical
areas of origin.
The same shall apply to donors who are likely to travel occasionally or regularly
to and from geographical areas where the epidemiological situation is at higher
risk of transmissible diseases than in the country of the BE.
55
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
iz
i
The same safety levels shall be guaranteed for blood and blood components
collected from such donors as for those collected from donors unaffected by
such situations, in accordance with the requirements of current legislation.
Homogeneous safety levels can be achieved by:
a) adopting adequate explanatory, training and cultural mediation tools, also in
cooperation with the associations and federations of donors, to promote the
acquisition of the necessary awareness and responsibility relating to the act
of donation, where necessary in the light of the donor’s ethnic and cultural
characteristics;
b) any ad hoc extension of the screening tests to perform for transfusiontransmissible diseases.
Se
rv
The application of such programmes/procedures shall be documented.
The BE should assess the feasibility of conducting screening tests for particular
congenital blood diseases in relation to specific epidemiological situations.
For the purposes of decisions on a donor’s eligibility to donate, the physician
responsible for donor selection may, where necessary, prescribe additional
diagnostic tests, or consult specialists (in cardiology, infectious diseases, etc.), or
ask donors to produce any health-related documents in their possession.
M
TI
B.2.2.1.1 The donor selection procedures shall implement the
documents/guidelines to which the BE refers as concerns
the medical history and clinical criteria for allowing donors
to donate and the diagnostic tests to perform prior to the
donation.
The reference documents/guidelines shall be formally approved by the BE
manager and be circulated to all operators involved.
SI
In the context of the documents/guidelines adopted, the BE shall refer to the
Donor selection guidelines developed and periodically reviewed by the SIMTI in
cooperation with the national representatives of the associations and federations
of donors.
©
For the purposes of decisions on their eligibility to donate, donors’ haemoglobin
concentrations or haematocrit shall be measured before each donation.
The BE may substitute haemoglobin or haematocrit screening with a complete
blood count, in which case additional donor acceptance criteria shall be defined.
The BE may decide to conduct other pre-donation tests, in which case, here again,
additional donor acceptance criteria shall be defined.
56
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
B.2.2.1.2 The donor selection procedures shall define specific criteria
for selecting candidate donors and returning donors (i.e.
donors who have not donated in the last two years).
iz
i
Currently-available scientific evidence demonstrates that confirmed positivity of
markers of HBV, HCV and HIV1-2 infections is higher in candidate donors than
in regular donors, and this may influence the residual transfusion-related risk of
transmission of the above-mentioned infections.
SI
M
TI
Se
rv
For the proper interpretation of the present Standard, the following definitions
apply:
a) candidate donor:
a person expressing his/her will to make a donation who has never donated
blood or blood components before, who undergoes a preliminary assessment of
his/her medical history and physical conditions, and diagnostic laboratory tests
to establish his/her eligibility to donate. For the infectious diseases potentially
transmitted by transfusions, the laboratory tests include at least immunometric
screening for HBV, HCV, HIV1-2 infections, and syphilis serology. If declared
eligible, donors are kept waiting for an established period of time before they
can make a donation. Returning donors who wish to donate again but made
their last donation more than 24 months earlier are considered for all intents
and purposes in the same way as candidate donors;
b) donor at his/her first deferred donation:
a candidate donor declared eligible who makes his/her first donation some
time after his/her first visit;
c) donor at his/her first non-deferred donation:
a person wishing to donate who has never donated blood or blood components
before, or who made his/her last donation more than 24 months earlier, and
who - subject to the decision that he/she is eligible in accordance with current
legislation - makes a donation immediately, instead of going through the
preliminary diagnostic procedure and the waiting time established for candidate
donors;
d) regular donor:
a donor who donates regularly and who has made a donation at least once in
the last 24 months.
©
The donor selection procedures shall define specific criteria for selecting candidate
donors and returning donors, and for allowing them to make a donation.
By gradually introducing agreements with the associations and federations of
blood donors, the BE should adopt the following procedure for selecting candidate
donors and allowing them to make a donation:
a) checking the donors’ identity;
b) collecting details of the donors’ medical history;
c) assessing the donors’ general state of health;
d) ascertaining the donors’ physical condition;
e) performing the diagnostic tests needed to assess their eligibility to donate in
relation to the established criteria for protecting the donors’ health;
57
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
f) performing immunometric screening for HBV, HCV and HIV 1-2 infections, and
syphilis serology;
g) performing any further tests prescribed by the physician responsible for donor
selection;
h) declaring the donors’ temporary eligibility to donate;
i) keeping the donors waiting for a defined period of time before they make a
donation.
iz
i
The same behaviour should be adopted when accepting donors returning to
donate more than 24 months after their previous donation.
Se
rv
The temporary deferment of candidate donations mentioned in item (i) should
strike a reasonable balance between the need to keep candidate donors motivated
to donate blood and the need to contain the biological risk associated with the
“window periods” for potentially transmissible infections.
If the BE accepts candidate donors for a donation without following the preliminary
temporary deferment procedure outlined above, then the procedures it adopts
shall emphasize the need for a very strict compliance with the criteria for donor
selection and acceptance for a donation.
M
TI
B.2.2.1.3 The donor selection procedures shall define specific criteria
for selecting donors for apheresis donations.
The selection procedures shall define specific criteria for selecting donors to accept
for apheresis donations, who shall meet the requirements of current legislation.
©
SI
The physician responsible for donor selection shall pay particular attention to the
following conditions:
a) any abnormal bleeding episodes;
b) any coagulation test anomalies;
c) any marked reductions or declining trends in total blood protein levels and/or
serum protein electrophoresis abnormalities, particularly for donors involved in
intensive plasmapheresis programmes; in such cases, donors shall be referred
for assessment by the transfusion medicine physician (for the definition of
the job description for the transfusion medicine physician, see Section A General organisational requirements, Annex 1 - Professional skills of health
care personnel);
d) any medical history suggestive of water retention (particularly if steroids and/
or plasma volume expanders have to be used);
e) any use of medicinal products in relation to product quality and safeguarding
the donor’s health;
f) any gastric disorders, if steroids have to be used;
g) any adverse reactions during previous donations;
h) sickle-cell trait carriers;
i) any other conditions, other than those listed above, of relevance to donor and
recipient safety and product quality.
58
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
In agreement with the associations and federations of donors, the BE may take
part in programmes designed to produce hyperimmune plasma by apheresis to
send for industrial processing and the production of particular plasma-derived
medicinal products, based on contracts stipulated between the pharmaceutical
companies involved in the sector and the regional authorities.
Se
rv
iz
i
In such cases, the BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures designed
to govern the related activities for collecting plasma by apheresis, defining the
clinical and organisational criteria and the working methods for:
a) selecting donors in relation to the goals of the programmes;
b) obtaining the donors’ specific informed consent;
c) including and retaining donors in the programmes;
d) planning and implementing any additional diagnostic tests for quality control
on the collected plasma and any additional clinical and diagnostic measures to
safeguard the donor’s health.
B.2.2.1.4 The decision on a donor’s eligibility to donate shall be made
at every donation and recorded in the donor’s file.
M
TI
Having checked the donors’ identity, obtained and assessed their medical history
in accordance with the permanent and temporary deferral criteria, evaluated the
donors’ general state of health and ascertained that their physical conditions are
acceptable, and taking into account any available laboratory findings relating to
previous donations, the physician responsible for donor selection shall formally
declare the donors’ eligibility to donate in accordance with current legislation.
For the management of donors’ personal data and donor files, see Ch. B.6 in this
Section, Managing the donor’s data.
SI
B.2.2.1.5 To obtain their informed consent to the donation, the BE shall
provide donors with all the information they need in a clear
and comprehensible manner.
©
To obtain the donors’ consent to the donation, donors shall be provided with all
the information they need relating to:
a) the purpose of the donation;
b) the procedure and how long it is likely to take;
c) the chance to withdraw their consent to the donation at any time during the
procedure;
d) common risks and discomfort associated with donations;
e) how to behave after the donation, particularly in the first 12-24 hours
afterwards;
f) the importance of providing truthful details of their medical history and
behaviour by means of the questionnaire and interview to ensure that the
blood or blood components they donate are safe and their own health is
safeguarded;
g) the chance to opt for self-deferral at any time during the procedure, should
donors believe their blood may not be suitable for transfusion;
59
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
h) the importance of donors reporting to the physician responsible for donor
selection at any time (even after making a donation) about any medical issues,
diseases or behaviour that might negatively affect the safety of their donated
blood and blood components;
i) the fact that physicians at the BE can be contacted with any information (even
after making a donation), also by means of ad hoc telephone number(s), and
they guarantee that it will remain fully confidential.
B.2.3 MANAGEMENT OF DEFERRED DONORS
iz
i
The above information shall be contained in the explanatory material given to the
donor before the selection procedure.
Se
rv
B.2.3.1 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for
managing deferred donors.
B.2.3.1.1 The procedures for managing deferred donors shall
implement the documents and/or guidelines to which
the BE refers inasmuch as concerns the medical and
diagnostic criteria for donor deferral.
M
TI
B.2.3.2 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for
conducting retrospective investigations and assessments
on the risk of transfusion-transmissible diseases.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
B.2.3.1 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for managing
deferred donors.
SI
The procedures for managing deferred donors shall explain the criteria to adopt in
relation to the past and present medical conditions, and the outcome of diagnostic
tests performed with a view to donation or for other purposes; they shall also
define the criteria for permanent and temporary donor deferral and the criteria
for reinstating donors, in order to safeguard the health of donors and recipients.
©
The BE shall guarantee:
a) documentation of the essential donor deferral issues, including any reporting
by donors themselves (even after making a donation) on their medical history,
diseases or behaviour that might negatively affect the safety of donated blood
or blood components;
b) notification to donors of any significant clinical issues identified during the
selection process or the performance of diagnostic laboratory tests associated
with the donation and any follow-up diagnostic assessments;
c) adequate donor counselling;
d) definition of the areas of expertise for deferred donor management, attributed
to the physicians responsible for donor selection (particularly those operating
at BCS connected to the BE), and of the methods for assigning particular
60
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
assessment and decision-making functions
physician (e.g. retrospective assessments
diseases - see Standard B.2.3.2).
2nd Edition
to the transfusion medicine
on transfusion-transmissible
iz
i
The BE should also guarantee:
a) a preliminary outline of deferred donors’ clinical situations, also by means of
additional diagnostic tests and/or referral to a specialist for advice;
b) any subsequent referral of donors to their general practitioners for follow-up2 .
Se
rv
B.2.3.1.1 The procedures for managing deferred donors shall implement
the documents and/or guidelines to which the BE refers
inasmuch as concerns the medical and diagnostic criteria for
donor deferral.
The reference documents/guidelines shall be formally approved by the BE
manager and circulated to all operators involved.
In the context of the documents/guidelines adopted, the BE shall refer to the
Guidelines for donor selection developed and periodically reviewed by the SIMTI in
cooperation with the national representatives of the associations and federations
of donors.
M
TI
B.2.3.2 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for conducting
retrospective investigations and assessments on the risk of
transfusion-transmissible diseases.
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for conducting retrospective
(look back) investigations and assessments relating to the risk of transfusiontransmissible diseases.
SI
Look back procedures are designed to define the responsibilities and working
methods for the retrospective assessment of donors in the event of one or more
of their donations being found at risk, or potentially at risk of transmitting disease
as a result of past or present medical conditions and/or diagnostic findings, or if
they are implicated in cases of suspected transfusion- transmissible disease.
©
These procedures are also designed to guarantee the fulfilment of any requirements
associated with the potential implication of one or more donations where there
is a risk of blood components or plasma-derived medicinal products transmitting
disease, in relation to third parties affected (e.g. pharmaceutical companies
contracted to process plasma and bodies governing the regulations for issuing
compensation for personal damages attributable to transfusion).
2
It is worth emphasising the fundamental importance and priority of the general practitioner
(GP) for taking the patient into care as part of the basic health care service, and the
usefulness for the BE of establishing an effective link for co-operation and communications
with donors’ GPs, where necessary and/or advisable.
61
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
The BE shall refer to specific documents/guidelines to identify cases in which
the past and present medical conditions and/or diagnostic findings considered to
decide a person’s eligibility to donate, or other donor-related information, contain
elements to arouse the suspicion that one or more donations provided by a given
donor are at risk, or potentially at risk of transmitting disease.
iz
i
These documents/guidelines shall be made available to the transfusion medicine
physicians and the physicians responsible for donor selection, and particularly to
those operating at BCS connected to the BE.
Se
rv
The retrospective clinical assessment for look-back activities shall be entrusted
exclusively to a transfusion medicine physician, and the methods to use shall
be defined. The look-back procedures shall also specify the responsibilities of
physicians responsible for donor selection inasmuch as concerns reporting to the
BE, particularly for those operating at BCS connected to the BE.
SI
M
TI
The BE shall implement look-back procedures:
a) in cases where donors are found ineligible to donate during the selection
process due to past and/or present medical conditions that have a significant
influence on the safety of previous donations in terms of the risk of transfusiontransmissible diseases;
b) in cases of donor self-deferral if the information provided by the donors and/
or any investigations conducted as a consequence of their self-deferral, have a
significant influence on the safety of previous donations;
c) in cases of donors ineligible to donate because they are found positive to markers
of transfusion-transmitted infectious diseases after testing in accordance with
current legislation, for the purposes of donation or at the time of other medical
assessments;
d) where one or more blood components are potentially implicated in a case of
suspected transfusion- transmissible disease, including cases in which the
competent authorities request the information they can legitimately access to
decide compensation for the personal injury attributable to the transfusion of
blood and blood products.
The BE shall guarantee the systematic documentation of all look-back activities
conducted.
©
If the BE has supplied another hospital’s BE with blood components for which
a potential disease transmission risk has been identified during look back
assessments on the donors involved and their donations, the BE shall send a
formal report to the other BE involved, together with all necessary clinical and/or
laboratory data.
The same report shall also be sent to physicians responsible for the health
care areas served by the BE, where blood components have been transfused
for which look back assessments on the donors involved and their donations
have identified a potential disease transmission risk; the BE management and
the above-mentioned physicians can then jointly assess the need to conduct any
retrospective assessments on the recipients involved.
62
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
B.3 WHOLE BLOOD COLLECTION AND APHERESIS
B.3.1 PREPARATION
AND
CONTROL
OF
MATERIALS
INSTRUMENTS FOR COLLECTING WHOLE BLOOD
AND
B.3.1.1 Before and after collection, the BE shall rely on specific
procedures to guarantee the accurate inspection of the
devices used to collect whole blood in order to ensure the
absence of defects and/or alterations.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
Se
rv
iz
i
B.3.1.2 The BE shall use weighing scales for whole blood collection
with performance characteristics designed to ensure
compliance with the requirements of current legislation
for whole blood collection and the production of blood
components with a view to ensuring end product quality.
M
TI
B.3.1.1 Before and after collection, the BE shall rely on specific procedures
to guarantee the accurate inspection of the devices used to collect
whole blood in order to ensure the absence of defects and/or
alterations.
If a blood collection unit that is about to be used shows abnormal signs of moisture,
or the liquid it contains is cloudy, or the unit is damaged or shows signs of any
alterations that may contraindicate its safe use, then the device shall not be used.
SI
For the activities for inspecting the medical devices and the management of any
nonconformities identified, see Section A - General organisational requirements,
Ch. A.5 Management of materials.
©
B.3.1.2 The BE shall use weighing scales for whole blood collection with
performance characteristics designed to ensure compliance with
the requirements of current legislation for whole blood collection
and the production of blood components with a view to ensuring
end product quality.
The scales for whole blood collection shall comply with the following minimum
requirements:
a) they shall guarantee the necessary mixing of the blood with the anticoagulants;
b) they shall enable the programming of the volume of blood to collect;
c) they shall guarantee the proper measurement of the programmed volume with
a defined and acceptable variability;
d) they shall signal any slowing or interruption of the blood flow;
e) they shall be fitted with clamps that close automatically at the end of the blood
collection;
f) they shall indicate the time taken to complete the collection.
63
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
Se
rv
iz
i
Given the need to guarantee the traceability of data relating to whole blood
collection activities and to increase their global safety, in addition to the abovelisted minimum requirements, the scales for whole blood collection should also
meet the following further requirements:
a) suitability for connecting to a computer-based system for managing traceability,
also after a given time lag;
b) the capacity to save data on a significant number of donations;
c) the means to identify and record the blood units and the operator performing
the collection with an optical reader or other objective means;
d) the capacity to record a significant set of other details relating to the donation
(programmed and actual weights, etc.);
e) suitability for connecting to computer-based fractionation systems, also after a
given time lag.
The BE shall guarantee the regular preventive maintenance and control of the calibration
status of the scales used for whole blood collection (see Section A - General organisational
requirements, Ch. A.4.1 Management of systems, equipment and instruments).
B.3.2 PREPARATION AND CONTROL OF MATERIALS AND INSTRUMENTS
USED FOR APHERESIS
M
TI
B.3.2.1 Before and after collection, the BE shall rely on specific
procedures to guarantee the accurate inspection of the
devices and infusion solutions used to collect blood
components by apheresis in order to ensure the absence of
defects and/or alterations.
SI
B.3.2.2 The BE shall use cell separators with performance
characteristics designed to meet the requirements of
current legislation for the collection of blood components
by apheresis with a view to ensuring end product quality
and the utmost degree of donor safety.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
©
B.3.2.1 Before and after collection, the BE shall rely on specific procedures
to guarantee the accurate inspection of the devices and infusion
solutions used to collect blood components by apheresis in order
to ensure the absence of defects and/or alterations.
When the packaging of a device used for apheresis is opened, or when the device is
assembled on the cell separator, or during the preliminary check normally conducted
automatically by cell separators, if the device does not appear to be intact, or shows
any sign of changes that might interfere with its safe use, it shall not be used.
In such cases, all the devices in the same batch shall be carefully examined to
check for any repetition of the defects identified; all faulty kits shall be segregated
to prevent their use and subsequently disposed of.
64
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
iz
i
Particular attention shall be paid to the visual inspection of the anticoagulants
and infusion solutions used, especially as concerns any clouding of the liquid,
presence of visible precipitated or suspended particles, or any other alterations
that may contraindicate their safe use. Nonconforming solutions shall be treated
in the same way as explained above for the devices.
For the activities for inspecting medical devices and for managing any
nonconformities identified, see Section A - General organisational requirements,
Ch. A.5 Management of materials.
Se
rv
B.3.2.2 The BE shall use cell separators with performance characteristics
designed to meet the requirements of current legislation for the
collection of blood components by apheresis with a view to ensuring
end product quality and the utmost degree of donor safety.
M
TI
The cell separators shall comply with at least the following minimum requirements:
a) they shall guarantee a high degree of donor safety, also as regards the use of
compensatory reinfusion solutions;
b) they shall guarantee anticoagulant flow control and the proper mixing of the
blood with the anticoagulant;
c) they shall enable the programming of the volume(s) of blood component(s) to
collect, also in relation to the donor’s physical conditions and blood count;
d) they shall guarantee the proper measurement of the programmed volume(s),
with a defined and acceptable variability;
e) they shall signal any slowing or interruption of the blood flow;
f) they shall enable a rapid reinfusion in the donor of the blood being processed;
g) they shall provide essential procedural data (timing, volumes, etc.).
©
SI
Given the need to guarantee the traceability of data relating to blood component
collection activities, and to increase their global safety, in addition to the abovelisted minimum requirements, the cell separators should also meet the following
further requirements:
a) suitability for connecting to a computer-based system for managing traceability,
also at a later date;
b) the means to identify and record the operator handling the procedure and the
blood component unit(s) with an optical reader or other objective means;
c) the capacity to record a significant set of other details relating to the donation
(programmed and actual weights, timing, batches, etc.).
The BE shall guarantee the regular preventive maintenance and control of the
calibration status of the cell separators (see Section A - General organisational
requirements, Ch. A.4.1 Management of systems, equipment and instruments).
The cell separators shall be cleaned and decontaminated by referring to specific
working procedures (see Section A - General organisational requirements, Ch.
A.4.4 Reconditioning of medical devices).
The BE shall document the decontamination activities conducted.
65
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
B.3.3 WHOLE BLOOD COLLECTION AND APHERESIS PROCEDURES
B.3.3.1 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures
designed to guarantee the proper performance of whole
blood collection and apheresis procedures in accordance
with current legislation.
iz
i
B.3.3.1.1 The BE shall guarantee that personnel responsible for
performing whole blood collection and apheresis are
given specific training in relation to the skills needed
for each professional category.
Se
rv
B.3.3.1.2 For each donation, the documented and traceable
identification of the personnel performing the collection
procedures shall be guaranteed.
B.3.3.1.3 Immediately before starting the collection procedure,
a check shall be conducted on the donor’s identity and
the correlation between the donor, the data relating to
the donation, the blood units inserted in the collection
device and the test tubes for the laboratory tests
associated with the donation.
M
TI
B.3.3.1.4 The BE shall adopt specific working procedures
for preparing and disinfecting the skin and for
venepuncture.
SI
B.3.3.1.5 The BE shall guarantee that venepunctures for the
purpose of donating blood and blood components
are handled exclusively by adequately-trained health
care operators with the professional skills that entitle
them to perform these procedures in accordance with
current legislation.
B.3.3.1.6 The BE shall guarantee the recording and traceability
of data relating to each whole blood collection and
apheresis procedure in accordance with current
legislation.
©
B.3.3.1.7 If whole blood collection and apheresis procedures
are interrupted, the BE shall decide on the basis of
established criteria whether the whole blood and blood
components may or may not be used.
66
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
B.3.3.1 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures designed to
guarantee the proper performance of whole blood collection and
apheresis procedures in accordance with current legislation.
iz
i
The BE shall prepare and adopt procedures in accordance with current legislation
that define the activities, the responsibilities and the working methods to adopt for
the proper performance of procedures for whole blood collection and apheresis.
Se
rv
B.3.3.1.1 The BE shall guarantee that personnel responsible for
performing whole blood collection and apheresis are given
specific training in relation to the skills needed for each
professional category.
As part of the procedures for training newly-employed personnel, the BE shall plan
and implement specific training on whole blood collection and apheresis in relation
to the skills required of the single professional categories (see Section A - General
organisational requirements, Annex 1 - Professional skills of health care personnel).
M
TI
These training activities shall be documented (see Section A - General
organisational requirements, Ch. A.3.1 Maintenance, development and assessment
of the personnel’s skills).
B.3.3.1.2 For each donation, the documented and traceable identification
of the personnel performing the collection procedures shall be
guaranteed.
SI
The BE shall guarantee the documented and traceable identification of the
operators handling the collection procedures for each donation (see Section A General organisational requirements, Ch. A.6.5 Identification and traceability).
©
B.3.3.1.3 Immediately before starting the collection procedure, a check
shall be conducted on the donor’s identity and the correlation
between the donor, the data relating to the donation, the
blood units inserted in the collection device and the test tubes
for the laboratory tests associated with the donation.
For each donor judged eligible, specific documents shall be generated for use in
the collection procedure, including:
a) the document(s) containing the donor’s personal details and identification
code, a number for identifying the donation, the certification of the donor’s
eligibility for donating, the type of donation and the quantity(ies) to collect;
b) labels to be attached to units included in the blood collection device and to
the test tubes to submit for laboratory tests associated with the donation,
providing the essential information for ensuring consistency with the details
67
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
of the donor and the donation, and also for the purposes of the unequivocal
identification and traceability of the blood units and test tubes.
Further documentation (which may also be produced subsequent to the donation)
may include the following:
a) donation certificates, where requested by the donor;
b) a voucher for obtaining food and drink after the donation, where applicable;
c) others.
iz
i
The units included in the blood collection device and the test tubes to send for laboratory
tests associated with the donation shall be labelled before collection begins.
Se
rv
Immediately before the collection, the following shall be guaranteed:
a) the “positive” identification of the donor by asking donors to state their personal
details (surname, name and date of birth);
b) a check on the consistency of the donor’s details with the labels attached to
the units included in the blood collection device and the test tubes to submit
for laboratory tests associated with the donation.
Each collection station shall be logistically organised so as to facilitate the procedures
for unequivocally associating the donor with the relevant blood units and test tubes.
M
TI
Computer-based systems should be adopted to unequivocally associate
the operator with the unit(s) collected and the cell separator (for apheresis
procedures) by means of optical readers or other objective means, as well as
tracing other essential data relating to the procedure, such as the collection time,
the programmed quantity and the quantity actually collected and the quantity of
anticoagulant used (in apheresis procedures) (see Standards B.3.1.2 and B.3.2.2).
SI
The methods for labelling blood units and test tubes associated with the donation
that are collected at BCS connected to the BE shall guarantee the unequivocal
consistency of the data provided on the labels with the data relating to the donor
and the donation, as well as the unequivocal identification and traceability of the
blood units and the corresponding test tubes to submit for laboratory tests.
©
B.3.3.1.4 The BE shall adopt specific working procedures for preparing
and disinfecting the skin and for venepuncture.
The working procedures for preparing and disinfecting the skin and for performing
the venepuncture are designed to minimise the risk of contamination of the whole
blood or blood components being collected. They shall specify:
a) the cleansing/antiseptic solutions to use;
b) the time it takes for these solutions to achieve an optimal antiseptic action;
c) the need to choose an area of skin free of lesions;
d) the recommendation to give priority to a vein in the antecubital fossa;
e) the importance of keeping the needle covered until it is needed and of checking
in advance that the needle cover is not damaged;
f) the importance of performing the venepuncture only after the antiseptic applied
to the skin has dried completely (the time it takes for the skin to dry depends
68
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
on the product used, but must never be less than 30-40 seconds);
g) the importance of never touching the area treated after applying the antiseptic;
h) the recommendation that the venepuncture be completed at the first attempt,
making any second attempt in a different area from the one originally chosen;
i) the need to use a new needle and blood collection device to perform a second
venepuncture.
iz
i
To further reduce the risk of bacterial contamination, the BE shall adopt systems
that enable to collect blood samples to be obtained for the laboratory tests by
means of a small pouch connected in line with the device, that is filled before
starting the whole blood collection and apheresis procedures.
Se
rv
B.3.3.1.5 The BE shall guarantee that venepunctures for the purpose
of donating blood and blood components are handled
exclusively by adequately-trained health care operators with
the professional skills that entitle them to perform these
procedures in accordance with current legislation.
As part of the training procedures for newly-employed personnel, the BE
shall guarantee the planning and provision of training on the performance of
venepuncture for whole blood collection and apheresis procedures, specifically for
the health care operators who can be qualified to perform this procedure.
M
TI
These training activities shall be documented (see MA - General organisational
requirements, Ch. A.3.1 maintenance, development and assessment of the
personnel’s skills).
SI
B.3.3.1.6 The BE shall guarantee the recording and traceability of
data relating to each whole blood collection and apheresis
procedure in accordance with current legislation.
In accordance with current legislation, the BE shall guarantee the recording
and traceability of the data relating to each whole blood collection and apheresis
procedure (see Section A - General organisational requirements, Ch. A.6.5
Identification and traceability).
©
All donations shall be recorded, including any donations that were not completed.
B.3.3.1.7 If whole blood collection and apheresis procedures are
interrupted, the BE shall decide on the basis of established
criteria whether the whole blood and blood components may
or may not be used.
The criteria for using whole blood and blood components deriving from donation
procedures that are not completed shall comply with current legislation and also,
in the case of plasma for fractionation, with the requirements established in the
agreements stipulated with pharmaceutical companies.
69
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
B.4 DONOR CARE DURING WHOLE BLOOD COLLECTION AND APHERESIS
PROCEDURES
B.4.1 The presence of at least one nurse shall be guaranteed at all
times when whole blood collection and apheresis procedures
are taking place.
iz
i
B.4.2 The presence of at least one physician responsible for donor
selection shall be guaranteed at all times when whole blood
collection and apheresis procedures are taking place in order
to deal with any complications or adverse reactions.
B.4.3 The BE shall guarantee donors adequate post-donation care.
Se
rv
B.4.4 Donors shall be adequately informed about the proper behaviour
to adopt in the post-donation period.
B.4.5 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures to guarantee
the proper and timely management of any adverse reactions
or adverse events occurring in donors during and after whole
blood collection and apheresis procedures also guaranteeing
their timely recording.
B.4.1
M
TI
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The presence of at least one nurse shall be guaranteed at all times
when whole blood collection and apheresis procedures are taking
place.
SI
The nurse is the professional primarily involved in providing donor care relating to
whole blood collection and apheresis procedures.
The presence of at least one physician responsible for donor selection
shall be guaranteed at all times when whole blood collection and
apheresis procedures are taking place in order to deal with any
complications or adverse reactions.
©
B.4.2
The physician responsible for donor selection shall supervise the collection
activities, take prompt action in the event of adverse reactions in the donor
and generally deal with problems that may interfere with the efficient and safe
performance of the activities.
B.4.3
The BE shall guarantee donors adequate post-donation care.
Donors shall be guaranteed a period of rest immediately after the donation and
an adequate post-donation availability of refreshments, giving priority to the
ingestion of a congruent quantity of liquids.
70
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
In the resting and refreshment areas, there shall always be personnel capable of
promptly identifying any signs of malaise and, where necessary, requesting the
intervention of the nursing and/or medical personnel.
B.4.4
Donors shall be adequately informed about the proper behaviour to
adopt in the post-donation period.
B.4.5
Se
rv
iz
i
By means of the explanatory material provided before the donation, donors shall
be given clear and understandable information on how they should behave after
making a donation, particularly as concerns the need to avoid occupational,
sporting or recreational activities that entail a risk in the first 12-24 hours after
the donation.
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures to guarantee the
proper and timely management of any adverse reactions or adverse
events occurring in donors during and after whole blood collection and
apheresis procedures, also guaranteeing their timely recording.
M
TI
Any adverse reactions or adverse events occurring in donors during and after
whole blood collection and apheresis procedures shall be promptly managed
according to specific procedures developed by the BE and they shall be promptly
recorded.
Materials and means for dealing with any clinical emergencies shall be available
and ready for use at the premises used for the blood collection activities.
SI
The health care personnel responsible for collection shall be adequately trained
and periodically brought up to date on how to manage specific clinical emergencies
that can occur in the setting of whole blood collection and apheresis activities
(see Section A - General organisational requirements, Ch. A.3.1 Maintenance,
development and assessment of the personnel’s skills).
©
These operators shall be qualified to provide BLS (Basic Life Support).
71
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
B.5 DONOR HEAMOVIGILANCE
B.5.1 The BE shall adopt specific procedures to manage its donor
haemovigilance activities.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall adopt specific procedures to manage its donor
haemovigilance activities.
iz
i
B.5.1
Se
rv
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures that identify the responsibilities
and the working methods for managing donor haemovigilance activities in the
light of current legislation and local, regional and national programmes for
haemovigilance and clinical risk management.
A reference person for donor haemovigilance shall be formally appointed.
M
TI
The BE shall define working methods designed to guarantee the proper and
complete management of:
a) epidemiological surveys relating to infectious diseases potentially transmitted
by transfusions;
b) reports on severe adverse or unexpected reactions and severe incidents
relating to the donation process, as well as processing errors and near misses.
©
SI
Procedures shall be prepared and made available for notifying the Regional Blood
Coordinating Centres and the National Blood Centre of all serious adverse reactions
and severe incidents relating to blood collection based on the applicable national
and regional directives and using the dedicated Italian transfusion services’ IT
system (SISTRA), see Section A - General organisational requirements, Ch. A.8
Information flows.
72
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
B.6 DIAGNOSTIC INVESTIGATIONS CONDUCTED AT EVERY DONATION,
AT REGULAR INTERVALS, AND IN PARTICULAR SITUATIONS
B.6.1 The BE shall adopt specific protocols that define the diagnostic
investigations to perform at the time of each donation and
other tests to perform to safeguard the donor’s health.
iz
i
B.6.1.1 Where the laboratory tests to perform at every donation or
at regular intervals, or in particular situations, are entirely
or partially conducted by another organisation, these
activities shall be governed by specific agreements and/or
provisions issued in relation to the organisational setting in
which the BE operates.
Se
rv
B.6.2 The BE shall guarantee that donors are notified of the outcome
of diagnostic investigations performed at every donation or at
regular intervals to safeguard the donor’s health, and of the
results of any further diagnostic tests performed.
M
TI
B.6.3 If the BE conducts research or epidemiological studies entailing
[envisaging - people envisage, establishments don’t...] the
performance of diagnostic investigations in addition to those
required by law and/or defined in the routine profiles, then
donors’ informed consent to these investigations and the use
of the related results shall be obtained.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall adopt specific protocols that define the diagnostic
investigations to perform at the time of each donation and other tests
to perform to safeguard the donor’s health.
SI
B.6.1
The BE shall adopt specific protocols that define the diagnostic investigations to
conduct at the time of each donation and the routine tests performed to safeguard
the donor’s health.
©
These protocols shall define:
a) the laboratory tests to perform at the time of each donation for the biological
validation of blood components and to safeguard the donor;
b) the laboratory tests to perform periodically to safeguard the donor’s health,
where these tests differ from those conducted at the time of the donation;
c) any further diagnostic investigations to perform systematically (e.g. ECG for
donors at their first donation) or routinely (e.g. ECG for selected categories of
donors, additional laboratory tests for donors with recurrent lipid metabolism
alterations);
d) the essential working methods for ensuring the performance of these diagnostic
investigations.
73
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
B.6.1.1 Where the laboratory tests to perform at every donation or at
regular intervals, or in particular situations, are wholly or partially
conducted by another organisation, these activities shall be
governed by specific agreements and/or provisions issued in
relation to the organisational setting in which the BE operates.
iz
i
If the laboratory tests to perform for each donation and the other routine or
occasional tests are wholly or partially entrusted to another organisation, these
activities shall be governed by specific agreements and/or provisions issued in
relation to the organisational setting in which the BE operates, and always in
accordance with current legislation.
Se
rv
If such arrangements concern the immunometric and/or molecular tests performed
for the biological qualification of the blood components, the organisation entrusted
to perform these tests shall be an accredited transfusion service; the BE shall
provide documented evidence of the relevant agreements or provisions.
Said agreements/provisions shall guarantee that the diagnostic systems and
analytical procedures adopted comply with current legislation on blood and
blood components.
M
TI
In addition, to guarantee the characteristics required for the diagnostic systems,
analytical procedures and reagents in relation to the particular safety needs of
blood transfusions, specific requirements shall be defined in relation to:
a) the sensitivity and specificity levels of the tests;
b) the validation criteria for the analytical sessions;
c) the definition of grey zones;
d) the internal quality control methods and the external quality assessment
programmes adopted;
e) the adoption of algorithms for managing the results, as established by current
legislation.
SI
B.6.2 The BE shall guarantee that donors are notified of the outcome of
diagnostic investigations performed at every donation or at regular intervals to
safeguard the donor’s health, and of the results of any further diagnostic tests
performed.
©
The methods used to notify donors of the outcome of their diagnostic investigations
shall guarantee absolute compliance with current legislation on privacy.
The BE shall promptly notify donors of any pathological findings of particular
clinical relevance.
Even though this is done at a later date, the routine communication of the outcome
of the diagnostic investigations conducted for every donation should be in the
form of a letter sent to the donor containing a brief and adequately clear summary
of the findings and assessments related to the judgement on his/her eligibility to
donate.
The communication of the outcome of other routine tests or of further investigations
conducted for specific reasons should include a brief but adequately clear summary
74
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
of the meaning of the findings with clear recommendations on the matter and any
further action to take or behaviour to adopt.
If pathological situations of significant clinical relevance are identified or
suspected, donors should be referred to their general practitioners for follow-up
(see Standard B.2.3.1).
If the BE conducts research or epidemiological studies involving the
performance of diagnostic investigations in addition to those required
by law and/or defined in the routine profiles, then donors’ informed
consent to these investigations and the use of the related results shall
be obtained.
iz
i
B.6.3
Se
rv
The BE may conduct research or epidemiological studies, subject to agreements
with the associations and federations of donors involved.
Where such research or studies involve performing tests in addition to those
established by law and/or defined in the routine profiles, donors’ informed consent
shall be required for the performance of the tests and the use of the results.
M
TI
It is not necessary to obtain additional informed consent if the tests are already
specified in the routine profiles (even if they are conducted using different
methods) providing the quantity of blood normally collected for the biological
validation associated with the donation is not exceeded.
B.7 MANAGEMENT OF DONORS’ DATA
SI
B.7.1 For each donor, the BE shall prepare and use a donor’s file,
which shall be managed in compliance with specific procedures.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
For each donor, the BE shall prepare and use a donor’s file, which shall
be managed in compliance with specific procedures.
©
B.7.1
A donor’s file consists of a set of all the records relating to a given donor, obtained
on printed paper and/or in electronic format.
The donor’s file shall be designed to contain the elements specified in the format
indicated by current legislation and include all the information needed for the
proper, complete and unequivocal management of a donor’s personal and medical
details, as well as the donor’s visits to the BE and donations and the results of
diagnostic tests associated with the donation and other routine and particular
diagnostic investigations.
75
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
The minimum elements to record in the donor’s file include:
a) the donor’s personal details and identification code;
b) the place of residence, full address, telephone numbers and other contact
details;
c) the association or federation of donors to which the donor belongs, where
applicable;
d) the ABO phenotype, Rh, Kell and any other red cell, leukocyte and platelet
phenotype details;
e) a summary of the donor’s medical history and clinical findings relevant to the
physical conditions required in order to be eligible to donate and an assessment
of the donor’s general clinical conditions;
f) the outcome of screening tests immediately prior to donation;
g) the outcome of any additional diagnostic tests or consulting of specialists for
the purpose of judging the donor’s eligibility to donate;
h) the judgement of the donor’s eligibility to donate;
i) any temporary deferrals with the related causes and the planning of tests and
reinstatements;
j) any permanent deferrals and the related causes;
k) the donations made (identification numbers, types and quantities collected);
l) any adverse reactions and/or adverse effects identified at the time of donations
and the related treatments;
m) the results of laboratory tests associated with the donation;
n) any other diagnostic tests or investigations conducted independently of the
donations and the corresponding outcomes.
Unless there is a need to produce and preserve printed documentation relating to
the donation signed by the donor and the physician responsible for donor selection,
the remainder of the donors’ files should be managed wholly in electronic format.
©
SI
The BE shall adopt procedures that define the responsibilities and the working
methods to guarantee the systematic and accurate compilation, revision and
assessment of the completeness of the data and the preservation of donors’ files,
as well as the relevant criteria for accessing the data.
76
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
B.8 REGULATION AND CONTROL OF ACTIVITIES AT BLOOD COLLECTION
SITES
In the context of this Chapter, the term “blood collection site” (BCS) refers to
fixed or mobile sites where blood and blood components are collected, managed
by the associations and federations of blood donors that operate, based on the
relevant national and regional legislation, in connection with the BE and under the
technical responsibility of the latter.
iz
i
Any blood collection sites managed directly by the BE as branches of their own
organisation are considered for all intents and purposes as an integral part of
the BE, so the Standards contained in the present Manual also apply to them for
the activities coinciding with those conducted at the BE’s central site.
Se
rv
The purpose of this Chapter is to introduce the elements required so that the BE can
effectively take technical responsibility for the BCS managed by associations
connected to the BE, as established by current legislation.
This role covers relational activities, programming and planning blood collections,
managing information flows, preparing the applicable prescriptive documents and
assessing the skills of the health care personnel, as well as conducting systematic
inspections and monitoring the activities of the BCS and the products it sends to
the BE.
M
TI
B.8.1 The activities for collecting whole blood and blood components
at the BCS connected to the BE shall be under the technical
responsibility of the BE.
B.8.2 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures to guarantee
the necessary information flows between the BE and the BCS
connected thereto.
SI
B.8.3 The collection of whole blood and blood components at the BCS
connected to the BE shall be programmed in accordance with
the requirements of Standard B.1.2 in this Section.
©
B.8.4 The BE shall guarantee that the personnel operating at the BCS
have the skills and professional expertise needed to perform
whole blood and blood component collection activities.
B.8.5 The BE shall guarantee that donors at the BCS are given
adequate information and instructions on all aspects relating
to the donation of blood and blood components.
B.8.6 The BE shall prepare specific procedures governing the donor
management and selection activities and the collection of whole
blood and blood components at the BCS in compliance with the
content of the Standards B.2, B.3 and B.4 in this Section.
77
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
B.8.7 The BE shall prepare specific procedures governing the
activities relating to the storage and transfer to the BE of the
whole blood and blood components collected at the BCS.
B.8.8 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures to guarantee
the systematic control and monitoring of the activities conducted
at the BCS and of the whole blood and blood components that
they collect.
Se
rv
iz
i
B.8.8.1 The BE shall guarantee the systematic recording and
management of nonconformities relating to crucial
activities conducted at the BCS and to the units of whole
blood and blood components that they collect, according to
the applicable requirements.
B.8.8.2 The BE shall guarantee the planning and adoption of
adequate corrective actions in response to reiterated or
single nonconformities, or serious events identified in
relation to the activities conducted at the BCS and/or to the
units of whole blood or blood components that they collect.
M
TI
B.8.9 In the light of the results of its control and monitoring activities,
the BE shall guarantee the planning and conduction of audits
at the BCS to prompt quality improvement activities relating to
the latter’s products/services and professional performance.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The activities for collecting whole blood and blood components at the
BCS connected to the BE shall be under the technical responsibility of
the BE.
SI
B.8.1
In accordance with current legislation, the whole blood collection and apheresis
activities at the BCS connected to the BE shall be conducted under the technical
responsibility of the BE concerned.
©
The agreements/contracts governing the relationship between the BE and the BCS
shall specifically state that technical responsibility for the BCS lies with the BE.
78
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
B.8.2
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures to guarantee the
necessary information flows between the BE and the BCS connected
thereto.
B.8.3
Se
rv
iz
i
The BE shall specify the types of information flow between the BE and the BCS,
as well as the related management methods, particularly as concerns:
a) guaranteeing the systematic availability and traceability of all the information
relating to donor management and the collection of blood and blood components
at the BCS (see Section A - General organisational requirements, Ch. A.6.5
Identification and traceability);
b) the procedures for ensuring the systematic control and monitoring of the
activities at the BCS and the products they send to the BE (see Standard
B.8.8).
The collection of whole blood and blood components at the BCS
connected to the BE shall be programmed in accordance with the
requirements of Standard B.1.2 in this Section.
The collection of blood and blood components at the BCS connected to the BE
shall be programmed in accordance with the contents of the Standard B.1.2 in
this Section.
The BE shall guarantee that the personnel operating at the BCS have
the skills and professional expertise needed to perform whole blood
and blood component collection activities.
M
TI
B.8.4
Only health care personnel whose qualifications and professional skills have been
approved by the BE manager may operate at the BSC.
©
SI
The health care personnel operating at the BCS shall be trained under the
supervision of a transfusion medicine physician.
By agreement with the associations and federations of donors, the BE manager
shall guarantee that the professional skills of the health care personnel operating
at the BCS are constantly kept up-to-date regarding the activities for collecting
blood and blood components (see Section A - General organisational requirements,
Ch. A.3.1 Maintenance, development and assessment of the personnel’s skills).
B.8.5
The BE shall guarantee that donors at the BCS are given adequate
information and instructions on all aspects relating to the donation of
blood and blood components.
For the activities to ensure donor awareness, information and education, the
BE shall guarantee that the BCS can provide donors with explanatory material
containing all the information they need, as established by current legislation, to
make well-informed and responsible donations with a view to safeguarding the
health of recipients and of the donors themselves.
79
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
The explanatory material shall also contain essential, understandable information
on the characteristics of blood, blood components and plasma-derivatives, and
the strategic value of transfusion therapy in patient care.
The elements described in the Application guidelines of Standard B.2.1.1. shall
emerge clearly from this material.
The BE shall prepare specific procedures governing the donor
management and selection activities and the collection of whole blood
and blood components at the BCS in compliance with the content of
the Standards B.2, B.3 and B.4 in this Section.
iz
i
B.8.6
Se
rv
The procedures shall guarantee proper and complete compliance with the
requirements of current legislation and define the activities, responsibilities and
working methods for donor management and selection and the collection of whole
blood and blood components at the BCS, as in the contents of the procedures
applicable at the BE (see Standards B.2, B.3 and B.4 of this Section), in order to
guarantee the necessary homogeneity of the quality levels of their activities and
products.
B.8.7
M
TI
The BE shall guarantee that these procedures are circulated to the personnel
operating at the BCS and ensure the timely availability of any revisions thereof.
The BE shall prepare specific procedures governing the activities
relating to the storage and transfer to the BE of the whole blood and
blood components collected at the BCS.
©
SI
The procedures shall define the responsibilities and the working methods designed
to guarantee that the temporary storage, packaging and transfer to the BE of
the units of blood and blood components collected at the BCS are handled in
accordance with current legislation and with the requirements established by the
BE as regards the need to guarantee the preservation of the biological properties
of whole blood and blood components up until the time of their delivery (see
Section A - General organisational requirements, Ch. A.6.3 Storage of blood,
blood components and haematopoietic stem cells (HSC) and Ch. A.6.4 Packaging
and transportation of blood, blood components and haematopoietic stem cells).
The BE shall guarantee that these procedures are circulated to the personnel
operating at the BCS and ensure the timely availability of any revisions thereof.
B.8.8
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures to guarantee the
systematic control and monitoring of the activities conducted at the
BCS and of the whole blood and blood components that they collect.
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures designed to guarantee the
systematic control and monitoring of the activities conducted at the BCS and of
the units of whole blood and blood components that they collect.
80
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
B.8.8.1 The BE shall guarantee the systematic recording and management
of nonconformities relating to crucial activities conducted at the
BCS and to the units of whole blood and blood components that
they collect, according to the applicable requirements.
iz
i
By agreement with the associations and federations of donors concerned, the BE
shall prepare and adopt specific procedures designed to guarantee the systematic
control and monitoring of the activities conducted at the BCS and of the blood and
blood components that they collect.
M
TI
Se
rv
These procedures shall define:
a) the potentially critical stages of the collection procedures that the BCS have
to control systematically and the nonconformities that they must identify
and record during the course of said processes, as well as the corresponding
responsibilities and methods for their management;
b) the product standards that the BCS are obliged to guarantee for the units of
blood and blood components that they collect;
c) the control procedures that the BE must perform on the products and documents
received from the BCS and the related responsibilities and methods for their
management;
d) the management of any nonconformities identified by said control procedures;
e) the information flows that the BCS must guarantee to the BE regarding the
controls they have performed and the nonconformities identified.
The procedures shall also define the methods for the control and management
of any nonconformities relating to donor selection and control activities at the
BCS, focusing particularly on the appropriateness of their clinical selection and its
compliance with current legislation and the established guidelines.
SI
The procedures shall also concern the systematic reporting to the BE of
nonconformities relating to the collection procedures and the products identified
and recorded by the personnel responsible for the blood and blood component
collection activities at the BCS.
©
In particular, such reports should include:
a) collections that were not completed due to the procedure being interrupted;
b) the duration of whole blood collections taking longer than the limits set by
current legislation;
c) the weight of whole blood or blood components found below or above the
requirements established by current legislation;
d) significantly slow collection flows during apheresis procedures.
The BE shall guarantee that these procedures are circulated to the personnel
operating at the BCS and ensure the timely availability of any revision thereof.
81
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
B.8.8.2 The BE shall guarantee the planning and adoption of adequate
corrective actions in response to reiterated or single nonconformities,
or serious events related to the activities conducted at the BCS
and/or to the units of whole blood or blood components that they
collect.
In the light of the results of its control and monitoring activities, the
BE shall guarantee the planning and conduction of audits at the BCS to
prompt quality improvement activities relating to the latter’s products/
services and professional performance.
Se
rv
B.8.9
iz
i
The BE shall guarantee the systematic analysis and assessment of nonconformities
identified relating to the BCS and take adequate corrective action to deal with
them (see Section A - General organisational requirements, Ch. A.7.2 Corrective
and preventive actions).
M
TI
Audits shall be planned and conducted particularly following the detection
of reiterated or single nonconformities or serious events not solved by any
previously-taken corrective action, in order to evaluate the level of application and
adequacy of the established procedures and, where applicable, to review the level
of professional competence of the personnel operating at the BCS (see Section
A - General organisational requirements, Ch. A.7 Quality monitoring, analysis and
improvement).
Based on the results of such audits, the BE shall implement adequate improvement
plans/actions and/or personnel requalification plans, as necessary.
B.9 PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
SI
To constantly monitor the quality of the products-services provided and the
compliance of the processes implemented with the established standards, the BE
shall guarantee the monitoring of at least the indicators listed in the following
table.
©
The indicators relating to the collection of whole blood and blood components
apply to the activities conducted both at the BE and at other blood collection sites
managed directly by the BE, and at the BCS managed by the associations and
federations of donors connected to the BE.
For the general criteria for planning quality monitoring activities, see
Section A - General organisational requirements, Ch. A.7.1 Quality monitoring.
82
Reference
chapter:
Section B
B.1
B.1
B.2.1
B.2.2
B.2.2
B.2.2
B.2.3
N°
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
©
/
/
/
/
B.2.1.1
/
/
Reference
standard:
Section B
Donor selection
Donor selection at BCS
Donor selection
Donor selection
Donor awareness,
information and
education
Number of revisions of explanatory
material for donors
Discrepancy between number of
donations per infra-annual period
(e.g. per month) vis-à-vis the mean
number of donations (monthly) in the
previous year(s)
Number of donations recorded out
of Number of donations programmed
(data stratified by type of donation)
Process control indicator
Sensitivity and specificity of
judgement on eligibility to
donate
Sensitivity and specificity of
judgement on eligibility to
donate
Sensitivity of judgement on
eligibility to donate
Proportion of deferred donors
iz
i
Number of look back investigations
for transfusion-transmissible diseases
out of Number of donations
Number of cases judged eligible to
donate not subsequently confirmed
on systematic auditing or random
sampling out of Donors selected
Number of donations rejected due
to positive biological validation test
results out of Number of donations
collected
Number of candidate donors Number of deferred donors out of
Total number of candidate donors
Se
rv
Availability of up-to-date
explanatory material
Infra-annual variability of
blood and blood component
collection
Effectiveness of programming
blood and blood component
collection
Characteristic to monitor
M
TI
SI
Programming blood
and blood component
collection
Programming blood
and blood component
collection
Activity
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
2nd Edition
83
84
B.3.1
B.3.2
B.3.1
B.3.2
B.3.3
B.3.3
B.4
B.8
B.8
B.8
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
©
B.8.9
B.8.8.2
B.8.8.1
B.8.6
B.4.3
B.3.3.1.5
B.3.3.1.4
/
B.3.3.1
B.3.2.1
Reference
standard:
Section B
Control and monitoring
of activities conducted
at BCS
Control and monitoring
of activities conducted
at BCS
Control and monitoring
of activities conducted
at BCS
Donor care
Performance of
venepuncture
Preparation and
disinfection for
venepuncture
Se
rv
Number of multiple venepunctures
out of Number of donations
Number of blood units found positive
on sterility check out of Number of
blood units tests (data stratified by
type of blood component)
Number of weighing scale and cell
separator stoppages
Number of devices rejected due to
defects
Process control indicator
iz
i
Number of corrective/preventive
actions implemented by the BE
Number of nonconformities identified
in critical activities and products sent
by the BCS to the BE
Application of the control and Number of audits conducted by the
monitoring system to activities BE at BCS
conducted at the BCS
Correction/prevention
of reiterated or single
nonconformities or serious
events
Conformity to established
standards of activities
conducted at the BCS and of
their products sent to the BE
Adequacy of established donor Number of adverse events affecting
care procedures
donors out of Number of donations
Adequacy of training for
personnel responsible for
venepuncture
Adequacy of established
working procedures
Efficiency of collection
equipment
Conformity of collection
devices to established
standards
Characteristic to monitor
M
TI
SI
Controlled management
of collection equipment
Inspection of devices for
whole blood collection
and apheresis
Activity
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section B - Collection of blood and blood components
BE = blood establishments
BCS = blood collection sites connected to the BE
Reference
chapter:
Section B
N°
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
2nd Edition
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
SECTION C
CONTENTS
iz
i
PRODUCTION, BIOLOGICAL QUALIFICATION AND
VALIDATION OF BLOOD COMPONENTS
Se
rv
C.1 PRODUCTION OF ALLOGENEIC BLOOD COMPONENTS FROM
WHOLE BLOOD AND BY APHERESIS ...................................................................... 86
C.1.1 PRODUCTION OF “1st-LEVEL” BLOOD COMPONENTS
C.1.2 PRODUCTION OF “2nd-LEVEL” BLOOD COMPONENTS
.......................
86
.......................
91
C.2 FREEZING AND THAWING OF RBC AND PLATELETS FOR
TRANSFUSION ...............................................................................................................................
96
M
TI
C.3 PRODUCTION OF BLOOD COMPONENTS FOR USES OTHER
THAN TRANSFUSION .............................................................................................................. 98
C.4 IDENTIFICATION AND TRACEABILITY OF BLOOD
AND BLOOD COMPONENTS .............................................................................................. 99
C.5 QUALITY CONTROL ON BLOOD COMPONENTS
...........................................
100
SI
C.6 BIOLOGICAL QUALIFICATION AND VALIDATION
OF ALLOGENEIC BLOOD COMPONENTS ............................................................. 102
............................................................................
107
©
C.7 PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
85
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
C.1 PRODUCTION OF ALLOGENEIC BLOOD COMPONENTS FROM WHOLE
BLOOD AND BY APHERESIS
C.1.1 PRODUCTION OF “1st-LEVEL” BLOOD COMPONENTS
C.1.1.1 All the allogeneic whole blood (WB) collected shall be
separated into “1st-level” blood components.
iz
i
C.1.1.2 The BE shall define the types of “1st-level” blood components
to produce, specifying the related requirements with
reference to current legislation.
Se
rv
C.1.1.3 The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures governing
the “1st-level” blood component production process, which
shall undergo preliminary validation and be revalidated
periodically, and following any major changes to the
process.
The procedures shall define in particular:
C.1.1.3.1 The reference quality standards and working methods
to adopt in the production of blood components.
M
TI
C.1.1.3.2 The working methods for the processing, production
and treatment of blood components, and the
automated systems used to separate whole blood,
their characteristics and the working methods for
their use.
C.1.1.3.3 The process control criteria for WB and for the
“1st-level” blood components produced, and the
methods for recording, segregating and disposing of
units that do not meet the established requirements.
SI
C.1.1.3.4 The types of collection devices to use for pre-storage
leukocyte depletion, and the working methods for the
relevant in-line filtering process.
©
C.1.1.3.5 The methods for preparing sample segments of red
blood cell components.
C.1.1.3.6 The equipment and working methods to adopt
for freezing and subsequently storing the plasma
produced.
C.1.1.3.7 The methods for storing blood and blood components.
86
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
C.1.1.1
All the allogeneic whole blood (WB) collected shall be separated
into “1st-level” blood components.
Se
rv
iz
i
The “1st-level” blood components obtained by separating whole blood (WB) are as
follows:
a) untreated red blood cell components;
b) plasma;
c) buffy coat;
d) platelets obtained from platelet-rich plasma or single buffy coats;
e) pre-storage leukocyte-depleted blood components obtained by in-line filtering;
f) blood components obtained directly by means of apheretic procedures,
including pre-storage leukocyte-depleted blood components obtained by inline filtering.
Whole blood transfusions may be acceptable only for demonstrated specific
indications in paediatric medicine, e.g. in exchange transfusion. In such cases,
the BE shall adopt specific working procedures for resuspending the red blood
cells in fresh frozen plasma.
M
TI
For the processing, control, and release of haemopoietic stem cells (HSC) - beyond
referring to blood and blood component regulatory provisions - reference shall be
made to current regulatory requirements on human cells and tissues.
C.1.1.2 The BE shall define the types of “1st-level” blood components to
produce, specifying the related requirements with reference to
current legislation.
SI
The BE shall define which types of “1st-level” blood component to produce and
specify the related requirements with reference to current legislation.
©
C.1.1.3 The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures governing
the “1st-level” blood component production process, which shall
undergo preliminary validation and be revalidated periodically ,
and following any major changes to the process.
The BE shall establish rules governing the “1st-level” blood component production
process in the form of specific procedures, which shall undergo preliminary
validation and shall be revalidated periodically and after any major
changes are made to the process.
For a definition of the term “Validation”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions.
87
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
In addition to ensuring compliance with current legislation, the procedures for the
production of blood components should comply with the principles and standards
defined in the latest edition of the Guide to the preparation, use and quality
assurance of blood components (EDQM - European Directorate for the Quality of
Medicines & Healthcare, Council of Europe).
The procedures shall define in particular:
iz
i
C.1.1.3.1 The reference quality standards and working methods to
adopt in the production of blood components.
Se
rv
The BE shall define the centrifugation parameters it adopts and the characteristics
and requirements of the instruments used to separate the WB, as well as the
criteria and parameters for the control of said instruments.
SI
M
TI
In addition to ensuring compliance with current legislation, the product
specifications and the criteria and parameters for the control of the instruments
used to separate the WB should comply with the principles and standards defined
in the latest edition of the Guide to the preparation, use and quality assurance of
blood components (EDQM - European Directorate for the Quality of Medicines &
Healthcare, Council of Europe).
The blood and blood components shall be processed in a closed system in an area
used exclusively for said purpose; this area shall only be accessible to authorised
personnel.
A plan shall be defined for the daily and periodic cleaning of premises, surfaces
and equipment. In addition, the microbial contamination load on equipment and
surfaces, and in the environment shall be monitored periodically with reference
to defined acceptance criteria. The corrective actions to take in the event of
unacceptable departures from the established parameters shall be defined in
advance.
C.1.1.3.2 The working methods for the processing, production and
treatment of blood components, and the automated systems
used to separate whole blood, their characteristics and the
working methods for their use.
©
To guarantee a good level of standardisation of blood components, and the
objective recording and traceability of the essential information relating to their
production, the separation of whole blood without the aid of automated systems
shall not be considered acceptable, with the exception of occasional, isolated
needs related to particular motivated demands.
The WB separation systems shall guarantee the recording of at least the weights/
volumes of the blood components produced, with a defined and acceptable
variability. A periodic check on the calibration status of these systems shall
consequently be guaranteed.
88
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
Said systems should be part of an in-house computer network connecting
them with the WB collection devices and the computer-based BE management
system, in order to ensure the unequivocal objective identification of the blood
units and the monitoring, automatic transfer and total traceability of all the
essential information relating to the production of blood components (blood
component weights/volumes, operators involved, times, etc.).
Se
rv
iz
i
For the processing of whole blood and blood components, the BE shall have
adequate quantities of the following types of equipment available:
a) refrigerated centrifuge for blood units with functions for managing and
monitoring initial acceleration and centrifugation rate;
b) automated system for separating whole blood designed to ensure the recording
of at least the volumes of the single blood components produced;
c) sealing devices designed to prevent the risk of microbial contamination during
blood collection and blood component production;
d) plasma freezing apparatus suitable for ensuring complete freezing to a
temperature of –30°C or lower within 1 hour;
e) refrigerators for storing whole blood and red blood cell components;
f) freezer for storing plasma at temperatures of –25°C or lower;
g) equipment for storing platelets under controlled-temperature conditions;
h) sterile connecting devices for assembling blood components;
i) plasma thawing equipment.
M
TI
Sterile connection procedures shall be validated, and periodically revalidated, as
concerns the system’s capacity to guarantee the proper alignment of the sealed
segments, the tightness of the seals and the sterility of the assembled blood components.
SI
C.1.1.3.3 The process control criteria for WB and for the “1st-level”
blood components produced, and the methods for recording,
segregating and disposing of units that do not meet the
established requirements.
©
Criteria shall be established for the in-production control of WB and “1st-level”
blood components, particularly concerning the simple visual inspections that
can be conducted at this stage and the methods for recording, segregating and
disposing of units that fail to comply with the established requirements.
C.1.1.3.4 The types of collection devices to use for pre-storage leukocyte
depletion, and the working methods for the relevant in-line
filtering process.
For the pre-storage leukocyte depletion with in-line filtering of WB or red blood cell
concentrates, the BE shall define the types of collection device to use in relation
to the clinical needs of the healthcare areas it serves.
Pre-filtering waiting times and temperatures shall be defined with a view to
facilitating the reduction of any bacterial contamination in the collection stage, as
well as optimising the performance of the filters.
89
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
With reference to advances in the technological features and performance of prestorage leukocyte depletion systems, the use of collection devices with in-line
filters capable of ensuring a residual leukocyte content of < 0.5 x 106/unit in at
least 90% of randomly-selected samples should be used and the use of in-line
filters with an even higher leukocyte-depleting capacity should be considered in
relation to specific clinical needs.
iz
i
C.1.1.3.5 The methods for preparing sample segments of red blood cell
components.
Se
rv
The sample segments of the units of red blood cell components shall be prepared
so as to guarantee that the blood they contain is duly anticoagulated and that
every segment is correctly identifiable by means of a corresponding code.
C.1.1.3.6 The equipment and working methods to adopt for freezing
and subsequently storing the plasma produced.
The BE shall define working methods for the freezing and subsequent
cryopreservation of the plasma produced, particularly concerning the related
times and temperatures.
M
TI
The plasma for clinical uses shall be cryopreserved within time limits and at
temperatures designed to adequately preserve labile coagulation factor activity.
On random quality control, in no less than 90% of the samples tested, after
thawing the product shall contain at least 70% of the original Factor VIIIc content
measured on a sample of fresh plasma taking into account the time interval
adopted between collection and freezing (preferably within 6 hours of collection;
in the case of plasma separated from WB, no more than 18 hours after collection).
SI
In addition to guaranteeing compliance with current legislation, the methods and
frequency of tests should comply with the principles and standards defined in
the latest edition of the Guide to the preparation, use and quality assurance of
blood components (EDQM - European Directorate for the Quality of Medicines &
Healthcare, Council of Europe).
©
The plasma to submit for pharmaceutical processing shall be produced in
compliance with the pertinent European pharmacopoeia monographs, as well as the
specifications and quality requirements established in the agreements stipulated
with the industries contracted to process the plasma and supply the corresponding
plasma-derived medicinal products. To optimise the yield of the transformation
processes crucially depending on the proper preservation of the labile plasma
proteins, as much as possible of the plasma produced should start to be frozen
within 6 hours of collection, using rapid cooling systems that guarantee complete
freezing within one hour to a temperature of –30°C or less.
After thawing, the plasma shall not be refrozen.
90
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
C.1.1.3.7 the methods for storing blood and blood components.
The BE shall store the blood and blood components in clearly identified areas,
separated by type (e.g. RBC, platelets, plasma), status (units awaiting validation,
validated units, units in quarantine), and specific collection criteria (e.g. autologous
blood units, dedicated blood units).
C.1.2 PRODUCTION OF 2nd-LEVEL BLOOD COMPONENTS
Se
rv
iz
i
C.1.2.1 According to the healthcare needs of the hospital organisation in
which it operates, the BE shall define the types of 2nd-level blood
component to produce, specifying the related requirements
with reference to current legislation.
C.1.2.2 The BE shall define and apply specific procedures governing
the 2nd-level blood component production processes, which
shall undergo preliminary validation and be revalidated
periodically , and following any major changes being made
to the process.
C.1.2.2.1 For post-storage leukocyte-depleted blood components
produced in the BE or at the bedside, the BE shall define
the types of leukocyte depleting filters to use and the
working methods for the filtering process.
M
TI
C.1.2.2.2 For irradiated blood components, the BE shall define
the related protocol to apply, the methods for certifying
the irradiation treatment and the responsibilities
for the management and control of the equipment
involved.
SI
C.1.2.2.3 For washed blood components, the BE shall define the
type and volumes of the washing fluids, the number of
washing cycles, the characteristics of the equipment
involved and the methods for its use.
©
C.1.2.2.4 For the in-house production of pathogen-inactivated
blood components, the BE shall guarantee systematic
compliance
with
the
documented
procedures
recommended by the relevant systems’ suppliers.
C.1.2.2.5 Any reliance on outside contractors for pathogen
inactivation of blood components shall be governed by
specific agreements.
C.1.2.2.6 The BE shall define methods for the pooling of blood
components.
C.1.2.2.7 The BE shall define methods for the fractionation of
single units of blood components into subunits.
91
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
C.1.2.1 According to the healthcare needs of the hospital organisation in
which it operates, the BE shall define the types of 2nd-level blood
component to produce, specifying the related requirements with
reference to current legislation.
iz
i
Depending on the healthcare needs of the hospital organisation in which it
operates, the BE shall define the types of 2nd-level blood component to produce
and specify their characteristics in accordance with current legislation.
Se
rv
The following are considered 2nd-level blood components:
a) blood components leukocyte depleted after storage in the BE;
b) blood components leukocyte depleted after storage at the bedside;
c) irradiated blood components;
d) washed blood components;
e) pathogen-inactivated blood components;
f) blood components deriving from the pooling of other single blood components;
g) blood components deriving from the fractionation of other single blood
components.
M
TI
C.1.2.2 The BE shall define and apply specific procedures governing the
2nd-level blood component production processes, which shall
undergo preliminary validation and be revalidated periodically, and
following any major changes being made to the process.
The BE shall regulate the 2nd-level blood component production process by means
of specific procedures, that undergo preliminary validation and are revalidated
periodically and following any major changes made to the process.
SI
For a definition of the term “Validation”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions.
©
The procedures shall define the reference quality standards and the working
methods to adopt in the production of 2nd-level blood components, the in-process
control criteria and the methods for recording, segregating and disposing of units
that do not meet the established requirements.
In addition to guaranteeing compliance with current legislation, the procedures for
the production of 2nd-level blood components and the related product specifications
should comply with the principles and standards defined in the latest edition of
the Guide to the preparation, use and quality assurance of blood components
(EDQM - European Directorate for the Quality of Medicines & Healthcare, Council
of Europe).
92
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
C.1.2.2.1 For post-storage leukocyte depleted blood components
produced in the BE or at the bedside, the BE shall define the
types of leukocyte depleting filters to use and the working
methods for the filtering process.
iz
i
For the post-storage leukocyte depletion of blood components performed at the
BE or the patient’s bedside, the BE shall define the type of the leukocyte depleting
system to use, in relation to the clinical needs of the healthcare areas it serves,
and the working methods to adopt in the filtering process.
To facilitate a standardised application of the procedure, filtering at the BE should
be considered preferable to filtering at the bedside.
Se
rv
Where applicable, the filtering temperatures shall be defined in order to optimise
the performance of the leukocyte depleting filters.
With reference to advances in the technological features and performance of prestorage leukocyte depletion systems, the use of collection devices with in-line
filters capable of ensuring a residual leukocyte content of < 0.5 x 106/unit in at
least 90% of randomly-selected samples should be used and the use of in-line
filters with an even higher leukocyte-depleting capacity should be considered in
relation to specific clinical needs.
M
TI
The post-storage leukocyte depletion of blood components shall be completed as
rapidly as possible.
SI
C.1.2.2.2 For irradiated blood components, the BE shall define the related
protocol to apply, the methods for certifying the irradiation
treatment and the responsibilities for the management and
control of the equipment involved.
The fundamental purpose of irradiating blood components is to prevent GVHD
associated with transfusion.
©
The blood component irradiation activity may be handled directly by the BE, or it may
be entrusted to specialist structures coming under the same hospital management
as the BE (Health physics or Radiotherapy departments) or outside organisations.
The BE shall provide evidence that each irradiated batch has received the
established irradiation dose, which shall be in the range of 25 Gy (2,500 cGy) to
50 Gy (5,000 cGy) released at the centre of the container.
The proper functioning of the irradiation system and the irradiation dose
administered shall be tested periodically using a sample with a volume
representative of the mean volumes of blood components routinely irradiated.
The BE shall adopt methods designed to verify the systematic performance of the
tests required on the radiation source by qualified personnel.
93
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
C.1.2.2.3 For washed blood components, the BE shall define the type
and volumes of the washing fluids, the number of washing
cycles, the characteristics of the equipment involved and the
methods for its use.
iz
i
For the preparation of washed RBC concentrates, the BE shall adopt a method
designed to ensure that the products are treated with a quantity of isotonic solution
at 4°C sufficient to remove the plasma so that the residual protein content is
below 0.3 g/unit.
For this purpose, specific random quality control methods shall be planned,
adopted and documented.
Se
rv
Also in the case of methods being used to wash platelet concentrates, the BE shall
guarantee that the products are treated with a quantity of isotonic solution at 2024°C sufficient to remove the plasma so that the residual protein content is below
0.3 g/unit, and the platelets are resuspended in an appropriate additive solution.
M
TI
A sterile connecting device should be used systematically for the transfer of blood
components and washing fluids.
The transfusion shall take place within 24 hours of the treatment.
If the product is not intended to be transfused within 24 hours, the treatment
shall be conducted in a closed system (sterile connections) and an appropriate
preserving solution shall be added.
C.1.2.2.4 For the in-house production of pathogen-inactivated blood
components, the BE shall guarantee systematic compliance
with the documented procedures recommended by the
relevant systems’ suppliers.
©
SI
For the in-house production of pathogen-inactivated blood components, the BE
shall systematically apply the documented procedures recommended by the
suppliers of the inactivation systems. In particular:
a) a sterile connecting device shall be used systematically and at all stages in
which the circuits are to be discontinued;
b) where applicable, it shall be guaranteed that the weight of the blood
component being treated comes within the range indicated by the supplier of
the inactivation system;
c) in the case of inactivating treatments on fresh-frozen plasma, the Factor VIIIc
content of the inactivated plasma after thawing should be at least 70% of
the Factor VIIIc content of the plasma prior to the treatment in at least 90%
of random test samples; specific quality control methods shall be planned,
adopted and documented to meet this requirement.
94
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
C.1.2.2.5 Any reliance on outside contractors for pathogen inactivation of
blood components shall be governed by specific agreements.
Any outsourcing of pathogen inactivation activities on single or pooled blood
components to companies authorised to provide said services shall be governed
by specific agreements.
iz
i
C.1.2.2.6 The BE shall define methods for the pooling of blood
components.
Se
rv
A sterile connecting device, or equivalent method (e.g. working in an environment
with a stringent control of particle contamination) shall be used systematically for
the pooling of blood components.
Only blood components of the same ABO group shall be pooled. This requirement
also applies to the pooling of buffy coats for the production of platelet concentrates,
and to the pooling of platelet concentrates from single donors.
The pooling of blood components for exchange transfusions may be an exception.
Platelet concentrates consisting of RhD-negative and RhD-positive units shall be
labelled as RhD-positive.
M
TI
In pooling activities, traceability from the pool to the single units comprising the
pool and to the corresponding donors shall be guaranteed.
Red blood cells without any additive solutions should be used in the case of
pooling activities for replacement transfusions.
SI
C.1.2.2.7 The BE shall define methods for the fractionation of single
units of blood components into subunits.
A sterile connector, or equivalent method, shall be used systematically for the
fractionation of single units of blood components into subunits.
©
In the fractionation of single blood components into subunits, the identification and
traceability of the single subunits shall be guaranteed, systematically enabling
the original blood component to be retraced.
95
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
C.2 FREEZING AND THAWING OF RBC AND PLATELETS FOR TRANSFUSION
C.2.1 The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures governing
the freezing, thawing and washing of RBC, which shall undergo
preliminary validation and be revalidated periodically, and
following any major changes to the process.
iz
i
C.2.1.1 For each unit of frozen RBC, the BE shall guarantee
the simultaneous preservation of samples of RBC and
serum/plasma.
Se
rv
C.2.2 The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures governing
the freezing, thawing and washing of platelets, which shall
undergo preliminary validation and be revalidated periodically,
and following any major changes to the process.
C.2.2.1 For each unit of frozen platelets, the BE shall guarantee the
simultaneous preservation of samples of serum/plasma.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures governing the
freezing, thawing and washing of RBC, which shall undergo preliminary
validation and be revalidated periodically, and following any major
changes to the process.
M
TI
C.2.1
The BE shall regulate the freezing, thawing and washing of RBC by means of
specific procedures, which undergo preliminary validation and are revalidated
periodically and following any major changes made to the process.
SI
For the definition of the term “Validation”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions.
©
The procedures shall specify that freezing and thawing operations be systematically
documented, particularly concerning the devices and solutions used, the storage
temperatures and shelf life, the biological qualification tests, and the haemoglobin
content after thawing and glycerol removal.
Frozen RBC shall be prepared within 7 days of collection using a method capable
of minimising haemolysis after thawing.
The BE shall guarantee that frozen RBC are stored at a temperature in the range
of –60°C to –80°C and for no longer than 10 years.
After thawing, removal of the cryoprotective agent and washing, the RBC shall
be resuspended in isotonic solution or additive solution, and shall be used as soon
as possible.
96
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
After thawing, the unit of RBC shall meet the following requirements:
a) volume > 185 mL;
b) haemoglobin content > 36 g/unit.
After thawing, the RBC shall be stored at 4°C ± 2°C for no more than 24 hours.
iz
i
Where methods are used to guarantee the integrity of the closed circuit, the BE
may consider longer storage times, depending on the features of the thawing and
washing system it uses.
C.2.1.1 For each unit of frozen RBC, the BE shall guarantee the simultaneous
preservation of samples of RBC and serum/plasma.
Se
rv
For each unit of frozen RBC, the BE shall guarantee the simultaneous preservation
of samples of RBC and serum or plasma for compatibility tests and for any biological
qualification tests introduced after the units were frozen.
Subject to physicians using the units being informed and giving their approval, the
BE may, on the basis of established criteria, decide to waiver said requirements if
a given unit is particularly rare and/or the clinical situation demanding its use is
particularly critical.
The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures governing the
freezing, thawing and washing of platelets, which shall undergo
preliminary validation and be revalidated periodically, and following
any major changes to the process.
M
TI
C.2.2
SI
The BE shall regulate the platelet freezing, thawing and washing activities by
means of specific procedures, which undergo preliminary validation and are
revalidated periodically and following any major changes made to the process.
For a definition of the term “Validation”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions.
©
The procedures shall require that freezing and thawing operations be documented
systematically, particularly concerning the devices and solutions used, the storage
temperatures and shelf life, the biological validation tests and the platelet counts
conducted before freezing and after thawing.
Cryopreserved platelets shall be prepared by freezing platelet concentrates
(preferably obtained by apheresis and collected no more than 24 hours earlier)
to –80°C or lower temperatures, using an appropriate cryoprotective agent.
The BE shall define the storage temperature and shelf life for cryopreserved
platelets.
97
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
After thawing, removing the cryoprotective agent and washing, the platelets shall
be resuspended in an appropriate additive solution and used immediately; if a
brief period of storage is foreseen, which shall in any case be less than 6 hours,
the platelets shall be kept adequately agitated at 22°C ± 2°C.
iz
i
After thawing, the unit of platelets shall meet the following requirements:
a) volume in the range of 50 to 200 mL;
b) platelet content exceeding 40% of the content determined before freezing;
c) residual leukocyte content below 1 x 106.
C.2.2.1 For each unit of frozen platelets, the BE shall guarantee the
simultaneous preservation of samples of serum/plasma.
Se
rv
For each unit of frozen platelets, the BE shall guarantee the simultaneous
preservation of samples of serum or plasma for any biological validation tests
introduced after the unit was frozen.
C.3 PRODUCTION OF BLOOD COMPONENTS FOR USES OTHER THAN
TRANSFUSION
M
TI
C.3.1 The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures governing the
production of blood components not intended for transfusion,
which shall undergo preliminary validation and be revalidated
periodically, and following any major changes to the process.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures governing the
production of blood components not intended for transfusion, which
shall undergo preliminary validation and be revalidated periodically,
and following any major changes to the process.
SI
C.3.1
©
The production of blood components for uses other than transfusion, i.e. for topical
use, has yet to be adequately standardised in the light of the available technicalscientific evidence.
The BE shall consequently define and adopt specific procedures, which shall
undergo preliminary validation and be revalidated periodically and following any
major changes made to the process, in order to testify to the consistency of
the products with the established quality and safety requirements relating to the
clinical use of the products.
For a definition of the term “Validation”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions.
98
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
C.4 IDENTIFICATION AND TRACEABILITY OF BLOOD AND BLOOD COMPONENTS
C.4.1 The BE shall guarantee the unequivocal identification and
traceability of all units of blood and blood components at every
stage of the production process in compliance with current
legislation.
The BE shall guarantee the unequivocal identification and traceability
of all units of blood and blood components at every stage of the
production process in compliance with current legislation.
Se
rv
C.4.1
iz
i
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
©
SI
M
TI
The identification and traceability of blood components shall be guaranteed by
complying with the following requirements:
a) an unequivocal code for identifying each donation shall correlate the donation
with the donor and with the blood components produced, also in the case of
the blood components being fractionated into subunits;
b) the units included in the collection devices used for the production of blood
components as well as the documents relating to the donation shall be
identified by the donation code;
c) the blood components shall be identified by printed adhesive labels indicating
the identification code, both in plain text and in the form of a barcode;
d) the layout and content of the labels used to identify the blood components shall
comply with current legislation and the relevant UNI (National Italian Association
for Standardization) standards specifically defined for the transfusion setting;
e) the labelling used during the in-house production stage at the BE may not
necessarily comply with the UNI standards, but shall in any case guarantee
the unequivocal identification and traceability of the units;
f) the quality of the paper, adhesiveness and printing of the labels used to identify
the blood components shall be suitable to guarantee that they are non-toxic
and remain legible, intact and adhesive even in a damp environment and at
low and very low temperatures for the maximum foreseeable storage times;
g) for allogeneic blood components, it shall be guaranteed that none of the
donor’s personal details that might enable the donor to be identified shall be
indicated, except for specific needs relating to particular dedicated donations
(e.g. apheresis of haemopoietic progenitor cells, lymphocyte apheresis);
h) where blood components are transferred from their original containers, labelled
at the time of collection, to another unlabelled container, the continuity of their
identification and traceability shall be ensured by generating and attaching a
new label;
i) in the case of pooled blood components, methods shall be adopted to ensure
that the label on the unit containing the pool indicates a single code for
identifying the pool, both as a barcode and in plain text, starting from which
the single pooled components can be retraced.
For the general criteria relating to identification and traceability, see Section A - General
organisational requirements, Ch. A.6.5 Identification and traceability.
99
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
C.5 QUALITY CONTROL ON BLOOD COMPONENTS
C.5.1 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for defining,
planning and performing quality control measures on the blood
components it produces.
iz
i
C.5.2 The BE shall conduct a systematic monitoring and data analysis
activity on the quality of the blood components in order to
identify any critical issues and undertake adequate corrective
or preventive actions.
C.5.1
Se
rv
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for defining,
planning and performing quality control measures on the blood
components it produces.
M
TI
The BE shall guarantee that the blood components it produces comply with the
quality requirements established by current legislation, as well as any additional
specifications adopted by the BE. For this purpose, the BE shall prepare and adopt
specific procedures designed to govern the definition, planning and performance
of quality control measures on the blood components it produces.
Any additional product standards adopted, in addition to the requirements of
current legislation, should comply with the principles and standards established
in the latest edition of the Guide to the preparation, use and quality assurance of
blood components (EDQM - European Directorate for the Quality of Medicines &
Healthcare, Council of Europe), (see Standard C.1.1.3.1).
SI
The BE shall prepare written procedures on the performance of visual inspections
on the blood components throughout the production process with a view to
examining their integrity, labelling and appearance.
©
The BE shall define and plan quality control measures on the blood components
in relation to:
a) the volumes of blood components produced;
b) the levels of criticality of the products and production processes;
c) the results of periodic monitoring activities (e.g. following the repeated
identification of deviations from the established standards that exceed the
acceptability limits).
The quality control measures on the blood components shall be planned in order
to guarantee statistically significant results in relation to the volumes of blood
components produced.
For each type of blood component produced, the BE shall define:
a) the quality control parameters;
b) the reference quality standards;
100
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
c)
d)
e)
f)
g)
the
the
the
the
the
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
frequency of the quality control measures;
sampling methods;
quality control methods;
criteria for analysing the results;
records to produce.
iz
i
In addition to guaranteeing compliance with current legislation, the BE should
define the parameters to control, the reference quality standards and the
frequency of the quality control measures in accordance with the requirements
of the latest edition of the Guide to the preparation, use and quality assurance of
blood components (EDQM - European Directorate for the Quality of Medicines &
Healthcare, Council of Europe).
Se
rv
The sampling methods used for the purpose of conducting quality control measures
on blood components shall:
a) include the adoption of randomisation criteria that are significantly representative
of the products being tested, also in relation to different operating or logistic
conditions pertaining to the collection and production processes;
b) take into account the production variables related to the various products;
c) guarantee that every single sample is actually representative of the content of
the unit being tested.
M
TI
In the case of blood components obtained using procedures that have not
undergone preliminary validation (e.g. blood components with a low production
rate), the BE shall systematically test each blood component produced.
If samples for quality control measures are collected from blood components that
are subsequently used for transfusion, the sampling method shall guarantee that
the sterility of the blood components and their biological properties are preserved.
The BE shall conduct a systematic monitoring and data analysis activity
on the quality of the blood components in order to identify any critical
issues and undertake adequate corrective or preventive actions.
SI
C.5.2
©
The BE shall prepare specific report forms for monitoring the data relating to
quality control measures on blood components and shall plan and document the
regular analysis of said data, frequently enough to ensure the early identification
of any significant deviations, or tendencies to deviate from the established
standards, as well as any critical issues that may negatively affect the efficacy
and safety of the products.
In the light of said monitoring activities, the BE shall take appropriate corrective
or preventive actions (see Section A - General organisational requirements, Ch.
A.7.2 Corrective and preventive actions); in the event of one-off or reiterated
nonconformities, or major shortcomings that are not solved by any previously
undertaken corrective/preventive action, the BE shall guarantee an in-depth
assessment of the adequacy of the procedures for the production of blood
components, revalidating said procedures where necessary.
101
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
C.6 BIOLOGICAL QUALIFICATION AND VALIDATION OF ALLOGENEIC
BLOOD COMPONENTS
For the purposes of the present Manual, the term “biological validation” is used
to mean the final assessment of the set of elements needed for the “biological
qualification” of donations and related products so that they can be declared
suitable for transfusion (subject to verification of their immunological compatibility)
and definitively labelled.
Se
rv
iz
i
The elements for the biological qualification of donations and related products include:
a) the results of microbiological and immunohaematological tests required by
current legislation;
b) the treatment of the available information on the donation and the donor,
particularly concerning any specific medical history and clinical issues emerging
during donor selection, and any findings/information recorded after the donation;
c) any biological qualification tests not required by current legislation, performed
to satisfy particular blood component safety requirements and/or specific
clinical needs.
C.6.1 The BE shall prepare specific procedures defining the diagnostic
tests to perform at the time of each donation for the biological
qualification of allogeneic blood components.
M
TI
C.6.2 The BE shall prepare specific procedures defining the related
responsibilities and working methods to adopt for the biological
validation of allogeneic blood components.
These procedures shall guarantee in particular:
C.6.2.1 The definition of the methods used in the final assessment
of the set of elements necessary for the biological
qualification of donations and related products so that they
can be declared suitable for transfusion.
SI
C.6.2.2 The unequivocal association of the biological qualification
details with the units of blood components being validated
and their traceability, as well as the traceability of every
single operator involved in the process in any way.
©
C.6.2.3 That responsibility for biological validation is entrusted
exclusively to personnel in specific managerial positions
C.6.2.4 Where biological validation is handled by automated
computer procedures, that the related configurations and
the automatic validation criteria are managed exclusively
by individuals authorised by the BE manager to access said
specific functions in the BE’s computer-based system.
C.6.2.5
The definition of methods for treating blood components that fail
the biological validation stage, or that are awaiting validation.
C.6.2.6 The definition of methods for labelling validated blood
components.
102
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
C.6.1
The BE shall prepare specific procedures defining the diagnostic tests
to perform at the time of each donation for the biological qualification
of allogeneic blood components.
iz
i
The BE shall prepare specific procedures defining the diagnostic tests to perform
for the biological qualification of allogeneic blood components at the time of each
donation in accordance with current legislation.
The BE shall guarantee that every donation undergoes the immunohaematological
and microbiological qualification tests defined by current national regulations.
Se
rv
For the specific methods relating to the immunohaematological tests on RBC,
see Section E - Laboratory testing activities, Ch. E.3 Specific standards for RBC
immunohaematological tests.
For the specific methods relating to the microbiological qualification tests,
see Section E - Laboratory testing activities, Ch. E.4 Specific standards for
microbiological tests for qualifying allogeneic blood components.
©
SI
M
TI
For the immunohaematological tests for biological qualification, the BE shall
prepare written procedures in order to guarantee:
a) RBC ABO and RhD typing at every donation for donors who are already ABO,
Rh and Kell typed at the BE; the BE shall also guarantee the definition and
application of appropriate methods for comparing the findings for ABO and
RhD typing with those of previous tests, and the prompt clarification of any
inconsistencies between them, prior to biological validation; this test should
be managed entirely by means of computer-based procedures;
b) for donors who have not already been ABO, Rh and Kell typed:
- determination of their ABO blood group;
- RhD typing, including weak D testing in cases found RhD-negative;
- determination of the C, c, E, e antigens;
- determination of the Kell antigen, and of the Cellano antigen in individuals
found Kell-positive;
c) donors at their first typing/donation and all those exposed to potentially
immunising events are also tested for clinically significant irregular red cell
antibodies; the BE shall also define methods for managing blood components
deriving from donors with irregular red cell antibodies, particularly concerning
blood components containing plasma.
In the case of donors who have not already been typed, the BE shall:
a) conduct two RBC tests to establish their ABO blood group, one on a sample
collected at the time of the donation and one on a segment of the unit sampling
tube (for donations containing no RBC, the second test shall be conducted
by repeating the test on the natural isoagglutinins); ABO blood group typing
in duplicate may be omitted if a first test was conducted when the donor
first attended the BE, prior to making a donation, and said first test can be
unequivocally associated with the same donor;
103
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
b) conduct two RBC tests to establish the RhD type with two different anti-D
reagents, one on a sample collected at the time of the donation and one on
a segment of the unit sampling tube (for donations containing no RBC, the
second test shall be conducted by repeating the test on the sample collected
at the time of the donation); RhD typing in duplicate may be omitted if a first
test was conducted when the donor first attended the BE, prior to making a
donation, and said first test can be unequivocally associated with the same
donor.
iz
i
The complete Rh and Kell phenotype should be confirmed at the time of a second
donation/attendance.
Se
rv
If typing is occasionally done for other RBC blood group systems, and/or leukocyte
and platelet systems, the corresponding results shall be systematically recorded
and managed in the computer system.
M
TI
The BE shall guarantee that ALT assay and a complete blood count are obtained
at the time of each donation, defining the methods for managing the results
in relation to the biological qualification of the blood components deriving from
the donation, as well as to safeguarding the donor’s health. It should be noted
that, although ALT assays and complete blood counts are not mandatory for the
purposes of the biological validation of blood components, some alterations in the
results of these tests may be indicative of clinically silent pathological conditions
that are irrelevant to the donor’s health but may pose a potential risk to the
recipient (e.g. a neutrophil leukocytosis can underlie a bacteraemia). A complete
blood count can also identify any shortcomings (e.g. a significantly lower than
normal platelet count) needed to meet the quality requirements of the blood
components obtained from the donation.
©
SI
Where the BE has to extend the microbiological qualification test profile for blood
components due to
a) particular (even transient) obligations imposed by the competent authorities;
b) particular local epidemiological situations;
c) programs/procedures for donors from geographical areas at higher risk of
transfusion-transmissible diseases than in the country where the BE operates;
d) additional screening programs for particular categories of blood components;
e) other reasons;
the BE shall prepare written procedures to define the criteria for managing these
profiles and the acceptability of the results, as well as the related working methods,
taking action as soon as possible to adapt and revalidate the computer system to
manage said test(s) suitably for the biological qualification and validation of the
blood components.
104
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
C.6.2
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
The BE shall prepare specific procedures defining the related
responsibilities and working methods to adopt for the biological
validation of allogeneic blood components.
The BE shall prepare specific procedures for defining the related responsibilities and
the working methods for the biological validation of allogeneic blood components.
These procedures shall guarantee in particular:
iz
i
Up until their validation, units of blood and blood components shall be operatively
withheld and they shall be stored in separate spaces from validated units.
Se
rv
C.6.2.1 the definition of the methods used in the final assessment of the set
of elements necessary for the biological qualification of donations
and related products so that they can be declared suitable for
transfusion.
The BE shall define the methods used in the final assessment of the set of elements
necessary for the biological qualification of donations and related products.
This assessment enables the blood components to be biologically validated, i.e.
declared suitable for transfusion (subject to verification of their immunological
compatibility) and definitively labelled.
SI
M
TI
For the purposes of biological validation, the BE shall guarantee the preliminary
assessment of:
a) the results of microbiological and immunohaematological tests required by
current legislation;
b) the available information on the donation and the donor, particularly concerning
any specific medical history and clinical issues emerging during donor selection,
and any findings/information recorded after the donation;
c) any biological qualification tests not required by current legislation, performed
to satisfy particular blood component safety requirements and/or specific
clinical needs.
©
The analytical data relating to the above-mentioned tests shall be transferred
from the diagnostic systems to the computer-based management systems using
procedures that rule out any manual transcription steps.
When it is temporarily impossible to transfer these data via computer, the
subsequent transfer and validation of the data in the computer system shall be
handled by two different operators, and their traceability shall be guaranteed.
For blood component validation purposes, the results of the microbiological tests
shall be unequivocal and shall consequently be restricted to the expressions:
reactive/non-reactive or positive/negative.
105
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
C.6.2.2 the unequivocal association of the biological qualification details
with the units of blood components being validated and their
traceability, as well as the traceability of every single operator
involved in the process in any way.
iz
i
The BE shall guarantee the unequivocal association of the biological qualification
details with the units of blood component being validated and their traceability, as
well as the traceability of every single operator involved in the process in any way,
particularly concerning the person ultimately responsible for biological validation.
Se
rv
C.6.2.3 that responsibility for biological validation is entrusted exclusively
to personnel in specific managerial positions
It shall be guaranteed that only personnel in managerial positions are responsible
for biological validation.
C.6.2.4 Where biological validation is handled by automated computer
procedures, that the related configurations and the automatic
validation criteria are managed exclusively by individuals authorised
by the BE manager to access said specific functions in the BE’s
computer-based system.
M
TI
If the biological validation process is handled using automated computer-based
procedures, the related configurations and the automatic validation criteria shall
be managed exclusively by individuals authorised by the BE manager to access
said specific functions in the BE’s computer-based system.
SI
C.6.2.5 The definition of methods for treating blood components that fail
the biological validation stage, or that are awaiting validation.
©
The BE shall define the methods for treating blood components that fail the
validation process, as concerns their identification, segregation, registration,
dispatch from stores and disposal in order to prevent any clinical use or transfer to
pharmaceutical contracting companies of segregated products awaiting validation
or destined for disposal.
The BE should systematically monitor and analyse the information relating to
blood components that fail the validation process in order to identify any critical
issues and consequently undertake any necessary corrective/preventive actions.
C.6.2.6 The definition of methods for labelling validated blood components.
Labels shall be generated by the computer-based management systems to
guarantee the unequivocal connection between the donor, the blood unit and the
analytical results.
106
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
iz
i
The BE shall define methods for the definitive labelling of validated allogeneic
blood components, including control measures to guarantee:
a) compliance of the information provided on the validation label with the
UNI standards for the transfusion sector, as well as with current legislation
(data relating to the collection device, i.e. the batch number, the type and
composition of the anticoagulant, the additive solutions, may also be provided
on the manufacturing labels alone, and not repeated on the validation labels);
b) the unequivocal consistency between the information provided on the blood
collection label and the corresponding information on the validation label.
Se
rv
Objective, computer-based methods shall be adopted systematically to guarantee
the unequivocal consistency between the information provided on the blood
collection label and the corresponding information on the validation label to
prevent any erroneous definitive labelling of the units.
These computer-based procedures shall be designed so that any omission of said
objective control shall prevent any allocation and distribution of the corresponding
units.
M
TI
Where blood components undergo further treatment after their biological
validation, and need to be labelled accordingly, it shall be guaranteed that any
label replacing or integrating the original label shall retain all the information
required for the validation label as well as providing details of the further treatment
and the type and characteristics of the end-product (s) obtained, as applicable.
Any labelling added after the definitive biological validation label shall comply
with UNI standards for the transfusion sector, whenever applicable.
C.7 PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
SI
To constantly monitor the quality of the products-services provided and the
compliance of the processes implemented with the established standards, the BE
shall guarantee the monitoring of at least the indicators listed in the following
table.
©
For the general criteria for planning quality monitoring activities, see
Section A - General organisational requirements, Ch. A.7.1 Quality monitoring.
107
Reference
chapter:
Section C
C.1
C.1
C.5
C.5
C.6
N°
1
2
3
4
5
©
108
C.6.2.6
C.5.2
/
C.1.2.2.4
C.1.1.3
Reference
standard:
Section C
Biological validation of
blood components
Blood component
production monitoring
and control
iz
i
No. of validation labels inconsistent
with collection labels out of No. of
units validated
No. of corrective/preventive actions
undertaken
No. of nonconforming products out of
No. of products tested
[data stratified by type of blood
component and by established
product specifications]
No. of units of fresh-frozen plasma
with residual FVIIIc activity < 70% of
the activity prior to treatment out of
No. of units randomly tested
No. of units disposed of for
processing-related reasons out of No.
of units processed
[data stratified by type of cause,
whole blood, blood components]
Process control indicator
Se
rv
Accuracy of labelling on
units of blood and blood
components
Correction of one-off or
reiterated nonconformities,
or major shortcomings
Blood component quality Conformity of blood
control
components to established
standards
M
TI
Conformity to established
standards of in-house
pathogen-inactivated
fresh-frozen plasma
Production of “2nd-level”
blood components
SI
Adequacy and application
of defined procedures for
processing whole blood
and blood components
Characteristic to monitor
Basic blood component
production
Activity
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section C - Production, biological qualification
and validation of blood components
2nd Edition
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
SECTION D
ALLOCATION AND DISTRIBUTION
OF ALLOGENEIC BLOOD COMPONENTS
..............................................................................................
Se
rv
D.1 INFORMATION FOR USERS
iz
i
CONTENTS
D.2 ACCEPTING TRANSFUSION REQUESTS
..............................................................
110
116
D.3 ASSESSING THE APPROPRIATENESS OF TRANSFUSION
REQUESTS AND PROVIDING SPECIALIST ADVICE .............................. 117
..............
120
.................................................................................
129
D.4 SELECTION AND ALLOCATION OF BLOOD COMPONENTS
D.5 ISSUING BLOOD COMPONENTS
M
TI
D.6 HAEMOVIGILANCE ON RECIPIENTS
......................................................................
.....................................
132
......................................................
134
......................................................................
134
D.7 MANAGEMENT OF BLOOD COMPONENT STOCKS
D.8 DISTRIBUTION OF BLOOD COMPONENTS
D.8.1 BLOOD COMPONENT EXCHANGE
........
137
...........................................................................
138
SI
D.8.2 DELIVERY OF PLASMA TO PHARMACEUTICAL COMPANIES
©
D.9 PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
131
109
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.1 INFORMATION FOR USERS
D.1.1 The BE shall adopt specific procedures designed to provide the
information needed to ensure the proper and safe management
of the transfusion process to the structures/parties referring to
the BE for the care of patients needing transfusion treatments.
The procedures shall define the methods and the operational
flows for the following activities:
iz
i
D.1.1.1 Unequivocal identification of patients and biological
samples for pre-transfusion compatibility testing, and
matching of requests with patients and samples.
D.1.1.3 Collection
and
components.
Se
rv
D.1.1.2 Submission of transfusion requests and of the related
biological samples for pre-transfusion compatibility tests.
transportation
of
units
of
blood
D.1.1.4 Access to remote blood bank services, where applicable.
D.1.1.5 Management of blood components
procedures at the patient’s bedside.
and
transfusion
M
TI
D.1.1.6 Management of untransfused blood components returned
to the BE.
D.1.1.7 Management of certificates of the final destination of units
of blood components not returned to the BE.
D.1.1.8 Reporting of adverse events, errors and near misses
relating to the transfusion process.
SI
D.1.2 The BE shall prepare the forms to use when requesting
transfusions.
The forms to use for requesting transfusions shall contain at
least the following details:
©
D.1.2.1 Identification of the health care structure formulating the
request.
D.1.2.2 Identification of the patient.
D.1.2.3 Degree of urgency.
D.1.2.4 Clinical and biological information needed to assess the
appropriateness of the request.
D.1.2.5 Type and quantity of blood components requested.
D.1.2.6 Date of the request.
D.1.2.7 Name and signature of the physician formulating the request.
110
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
D.1.1
The BE shall adopt specific procedures designed to provide the
information needed to ensure the proper and safe management of the
transfusion process to the structures/parties referring to the BE for the
care of patients needing transfusion treatments.
Se
rv
iz
i
In accordance with current legislation, hospital transfusion committees shall be
created and fully operational at healthcare organisations with one or more BE(s).
These committees should be constantly committed to promoting the ongoing
professional development and training of all individuals involved in the transfusion
process and to systematically auditing the effective application of the procedures
adopted to ensure the safety of the process and the appropriateness of transfusion.
These procedures should be shared and adopted by the one or more committees
on which the BE is institutionally required to serve.
The procedures should be circulated by means of specific provisions issued by the
hospital managements.
M
TI
Depending on the qualitative and quantitative dimensions of the organisation to
which the BE belongs and the areas it serves, the BE should provide its technicalscientific expertise in the context of the committee(s), playing a strategic part in
its principal design and planning activities.
“Practical guidelines” should be produced and made available to users; they
should be easy to consult and concise, illustrating the procedures particularly
relevant to transfusion safety, also with the aid of flowcharts or other graphic
methods.
SI
The procedures shall define the methods and operational flows for the following
activities:
©
D.1.1.1 Unequivocal identification of patients and biological samples for
pre-transfusion compatibility testing, and matching of requests
with patients and samples.
Specific methods shall be defined for unequivocally identifying patients and
biological samples for pretransfusion compatibility tests, and for matching requests
with patients and samples, paying particular attention to urgent and emergency
situations.
Specific methods shall also be defined for identifying patients for whom it is
impossible to acquire the routinely required identification details.
If the basic immunohaematological tests (blood group and irregular antibody
screening) are conducted prior to admission (in the outpatient setting or before
hospitalisation) and the need for transfusions is predicted, adequate and reliable
111
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
methods should be in place to identify the patient and the related biological
samples, and to verify the correlation between the request for tests and the
patient.
Computer-based methods should be progressively introduced for the unequivocal
identification of patients and the related biological samples, relying on the use of
objective identification methods.
iz
i
D.1.1.2 Submission of transfusion requests and of the related biological
samples for pre-transfusion compatibility tests.
Se
rv
The BE shall define:
a) the methods for compiling requests for scheduled, urgent and emergency
transfusions, and for submitting these requests to the BE along with the
corresponding biological samples for the pre-transfusion compatibility tests;
b) the qualitative and quantitative type of the biological samples to accompany
the requests;
c) the rules and requirements of interest to users relating to the fulfilment of
their requests, particularly concerning the timing and methods for meeting
requests, the management of urgent and emergency transfusions, and the
organisational and logistic aspects relating to the issuing and collection of
blood units.
M
TI
A transfusion is defined as “urgent” in cases where the patient’s clinical conditions
demand a prompt transfusion treatment, within a time span that allows for the
blood component to be selected and for pre-transfusion compatibility tests to be
performed.
An “emergency” transfusion is needed for patients in life-threatening conditions
so there is no time to complete the selection and compatibility testing procedures
as adopted for urgent or scheduled transfusions.
SI
The defined working methods shall be consistent with the needs of the hospital(s)
to which the BE refers and the areas it serves, as well as with any other needs
correlating with specific organisational and logistic conditions (e.g. accredited
private hospitals, separate branches of the hospital, patients treated at home).
©
D.1.1.3 Collection and transportation of units of blood components.
The BE shall define the methods for managing and handling the collection
and transportation of units of blood components, particularly concerning any
requirements relating to the logistic issues of the areas it serves.
For the general criteria relating to the transportation of units of blood components,
see Section A -General organisational requirements, Ch. A.6.4 Packaging and
transportation of blood, blood components and haemopoietic stem cells (HSC).
112
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.1.1.4 Access to remote blood bank services, where applicable.
Access to remote blood bank services provided by the BE within structures not
belonging to the hospital management to which the BE refers (e.g. accredited
private hospitals) shall be governed by specific contracts/agreements.
iz
i
In particular, these contracts/agreements shall define the methods for accessing the
remote blood bank services as concerns urgent and emergency transfusions, including
the methods for restoring the established stock levels (see Standard D.7.1.1).
Se
rv
D.1.1.5 Management of blood components, and transfusion procedures at
the patient’s bedside.
The working methods for managing blood components at the hospital ward (or
anywhere else the patient is treated), and for administering transfusions at the
patient’s bedside shall be defined with a view to ensuring the preservation of the
biological properties of the blood components, the patient’s safety and the efficacy
of the treatment.
M
TI
For the general criteria relating to the storage of blood components, see Section
A - General organisational requirements, Ch. A.6.3 Storage of blood, blood
components and haemopoietic stem cells (HSC).
D.1.1.6 Management of untransfused blood components returned to
the BE.
The BE shall define working methods to guarantee the timely return to the BE of
untransfused blood component units, as well as the transmission of the certificates
testifying to their proper preservation.
SI
For the general criteria relating to the storage of blood components, see Section
A - General organisational requirements, Ch. A.6.3 Storage of blood, blood
components and haemopoietic stem cells (HSC).
©
D.1.1.7 Management of certificates of the final destination of units of blood
components not returned to the BE.
Working methods shall be defined to guarantee the transmission to the BE of
certificates testifying to the final destination of units of blood components not
returned to the BE.
D.1.1.8 Reporting of adverse events, errors and near misses relating to the
transfusion process.
Working methods shall be defined to ensure the reporting of any adverse events,
errors and near misses relating to the transfusion process (see also Standard D.6.1).
113
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
D.1.2
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
The BE shall prepare the forms to use for transfusion requests.
iz
i
The BE should:
a) share the content of the forms to use for transfusion requests within the
hospital transfusion committees on which the BE is institutionally required to
serve, and/or with the hospital management, prior to their adoption;
b) apply the forms only after their documented approval by the hospital
management and after their formal distribution by said management to the
interested parties.
Se
rv
The forms to use for transfusion requests shall contain at least the following
items:
D.1.2.1 Identification of the health care structure formulating the
request.
The forms shall provide a space for the identification of the health care structure
issuing the request (e.g. hospital ward, outpatient service, private clinic).
D.1.2.2 Identification of the patient.
M
TI
Patients shall be identified by means of their surname, name and date of birth,
or using other, specifically-stated methods in the case of patients for whom it is
impossible to collect the usual personal identification details.
Space may be provided for the physician requesting the transfusion to indicate the
ABO blood group and RhD type, if they are already known.
SI
Where applicable, the patient’s identification code should be used, preferably
acquired from barcode labels or the hospital’s intranet, or by equivalent objective
means.
D.1.2.3 Degree of urgency.
©
The forms shall contain a specific space for indicating the degree of urgency of
the transfusion request.
D.1.2.4 Clinical and biological information
appropriateness of the request.
needed
to
assess
the
The clinical and biological information shall include at least: the main diagnosis,
the indication(s) for transfusion, the essential blood count and coagulation data
related to the blood components requested and the indication(s) (haemoglobin
concentration, platelet count, PT/INR, aPTT), and the patient’s body weight.
114
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
The type of surgery should be indicated for requests relating to elective surgical
procedures.
Space may be provided for indicating other biological parameters or clinical
details, depending on the BE’s organisation and functions (e.g. if the BE manages
the allocation of plasma-derived medicinal products).
Se
rv
iz
i
It is advisable to reserve a space for physicians at the BE to briefly provide evidence
of their assessment of the appropriateness of the request for transfusion, and of
any arrangements to waiver the usual requirements in the light of an exchange
with the physician making the request; alternatively, requests may be recorded in
the computer system so as to unequivocally associate the patient concerned with
the physician formulating the request.
Abbreviations may be used for the clinical and biological information, providing
the request refers to an indication listed in specifically prepared protocols (e.g.
preoperative request forms for elective surgery).
D.1.2.5 Type and quantity of blood components requested.
The forms shall provide a space for explaining the type and quantity of blood
components requested.
M
TI
The BE may use separate forms for different types of blood component, as well as
forms for requesting plasma derivatives, if the BE is also responsible for allocating
the latter.
D.1.2.6 Date of the request.
SI
The forms shall provide a space for indicating the date on which the request is
submitted.
It is advisable to reserve a space for recording the date and time when the BE
receives the request.
©
D.1.2.7 Name and signature of the physician formulating the request.
The forms shall provide a space for identifying the physician making the request,
and for the physician’s signature.
It is advisable to reserve a space for identifying the health care professional
responsible for collecting the biological samples for pre-transfusion compatibility
tests, and for said professionals to sign to the effect that they have unequivocally
identified the patient and correlated the patient with the request and the samples.
115
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.2 ACCEPTING TRANSFUSION REQUESTS
D.2.1 The BE shall systematically check transfusion requests and the
corresponding biological samples
Before satisfying transfusion requests, the BE shall check
patients’ historical details in its traceability management
system.
iz
i
D2.2
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
Se
rv
D.2.1 The BE shall systematically check transfusion requests and the
corresponding biological samples.
The BE shall systematically record the time of arrival of transfusion requests.
The BE shall systematically check transfusion requests and the corresponding
biological samples to ensure:
a) that requests have been completed properly;
b) that the biological samples conform to the established requirements;
c) that requests and samples correspond, particularly as regards patients’
demographic details.
M
TI
It shall be guaranteed that any missing information is obtained if it is relevant to
the safe, proper and complete satisfaction of the request.
SI
Without prejudice to the priority of assuring patients the transfusion treatments
they need, particularly in cases of urgency or emergency, the BE shall:
a) systematically check the identity of the physician making the request and have
them sign the request if they have not already done so;
b) check that operators responsible for blood sampling for pre-transfusion
compatibility tests have added their signatures, or ensure that they do so.
A prompt solution shall be guaranteed for any inconsistencies identified, and shall
in any case be found before satisfying the request.
Before satisfying transfusion requests, the BE shall check patients’
historical details in its traceability management system
©
D.2.2
Before satisfying any transfusion requests, the BE shall check the patient’s
historical details available in its traceability management system to ascertain the
essential elements needed to guarantee a safe and appropriate handling of the
transfusion request.
116
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
iz
i
The essential elements that shall be checked, if available in the traceability
management system, are as follows:
a) previous blood group typing;
b) difficulties previously encountered in blood group typing;
c) previous searches for irregular antibodies, with particular reference to the
detection/identification of clinically significant irregular antibodies;
d) previous adverse reactions to transfusions or adverse events;
e) specific transfusion requirements (e.g. leuko-depleted or irradiated blood
components).
D.3 ASSESSING THE APPROPRIATENESS OF TRANSFUSION REQUESTS
AND PROVIDING SPECIALIST ADVICE
Se
rv
D.3.1 The BE shall adopt guidelines on the appropriate use of
blood components, which are shared with the major users of
transfusion treatments.
D.3.1.1 The guidelines shall be formally circulated to all interested
parties.
D.3.1.2 The guidelines shall be periodically reviewed.
M
TI
D.3.2 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for assessing
the appropriateness of transfusion requests.
D.3.2.1 The BE shall guarantee the systematic assessment of the
appropriateness of transfusion requests by a transfusion
medicine physician.
SI
D.3.2.2 The BE shall guarantee the periodic statistical processing of
data on the outcome of the assessment of appropriateness,
to be conducted at least once a year.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall adopt guidelines on the appropriate use of blood
components, which are shared with the major users of transfusion
treatments.
©
D.3.1
Guidelines on the appropriate use of blood components should be shared and
adopted within the context of the one or more hospital transfusion committees on
which the BE is institutionally required to serve.
The adoption of guidelines is a prerequisite, given the need to have shared,
formally approved and properly circulated references on which to base the BE’s
assessment of the appropriateness of transfusion requests, as required by current
legislation.
117
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
On this issue, it should be emphasised that the authority with which the BE operates
in this role depends largely on the level of technical-scientific competence that it
succeeds in expressing, as well as its capacity to establish and maintain effective
and efficient interfunctional relationships.
Se
rv
iz
i
The guidelines on the appropriate use of blood components shall:
a) provide recommendations on the appropriate clinical use of blood components,
at least inasmuch as concerns the transfusion of RBC, fresh frozen plasma and
platelets;
b) provide recommendations on the main treatments for 2nd-level blood
components, such as leukocyte depletion, washing and irradiation, in relation
to the needs of the health care services served by the BE;
c) be formulated on the strength of evidence-based criteria and with reference to
authoritative bibliographical sources;
d) be formulated with an adequate multidisciplinary contribution;
e) indicate the year of their adoption;
f) be easy to consult and genuinely applicable.
The guidelines should also contain recommendations on the appropriate clinical
use of the main plasma-derived medicinal products (albumin, intravenous
immunoglobulin, antithrombin).
M
TI
D.3.1.1 The guidelines shall be formally circulated to all interested
parties.
The guidelines should be circulated to all interested stakeholders under the
responsibility of the hospital management.
D.3.1.2 The guidelines shall be periodically reviewed.
SI
The BE shall take an active part in the periodic review of the guidelines, also in
the light of any introduction of new types of blood components and important
needs for technical-scientific update.
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for assessing the
appropriateness of transfusion requests.
©
D.3.2
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for assessing the
appropriateness of transfusion requests.
The procedures shall refer to the guidelines contained in the Standard D.3.1.
D.3.2.1 The BE shall guarantee the systematic assessment of the appropriateness
of transfusion requests by a transfusion medicine physician.
The BE shall guarantee the systematic assessment of the appropriateness of
transfusion requests by a transfusion medicine physician.
118
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
The assessment of transfusion requests shall apply to all scheduled and urgent
requests, where the patient’s clinical conditions permit.
Urgent and emergency requests that it may be impossible to assess immediately
shall nonetheless undergo systematic retrospective assessment.
Activities for assessing the appropriateness of transfusion requests shall be
documented.
Se
rv
iz
i
Transfusion requests are considered inappropriate in cases where the proposed
treatment needs to be qualitatively and/or quantitatively integrated or modified
in the light of clinical and biological information given in the request, and/or any
additional information acquired. In such cases, the transfusion medicine physician
shall tend to make the request appropriate by contacting the physician issuing
the request providing the latter with specialist advice.
The appropriateness of a request shall be assessed giving priority to the content
of the guidelines contained in the Standard D.3.1.
The BE shall also provide specialist advice when specifically asked to do so,
preliminary to or irrespective of any submission of transfusion requests, in relation
to clinical cases demanding particular, complex or critical transfusion treatments.
M
TI
The BE should document any requests for advice it receives and any arrangements
made, as well as any advice it provides.
SI
Where it proves impossible to come to an agreement with the physician making
the request, irrespective of whether the requested blood components are actually
attributed to the patient or not, the outcome of the assessment by the physician
at the BE should be formally notified to the structure requesting the transfusion
and to the hospital transfusion committee, and a copy of said notification should
be preserved at the BE.
D.3.2.2 The BE shall guarantee the periodic statistical processing of data
on the outcome of the assessment of appropriateness, to be
conducted at least once a year.
©
The BE shall adopt data processing criteria with a view to obtaining a representative
picture of the global level of appropriateness of transfusion requests it receives in
relation to the type and volume of the transfusion activities performed in the areas
it serves, and to any criteria and objectives established by the hospital transfusion
committee.
These data-processing criteria should include stratifying the data at least by:
a) type of blood component;
b) areas served that have the highest consumption;
c) medical and surgical treatments entailing the highest consumption.
The results of such statistical data analyses should be periodically presented and
discussed at meetings of the hospital transfusion committee, to enable the latter
to use them as a tool for monitoring, auditing and improvement activities.
119
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.4 SELECTION AND ALLOCATION OF BLOOD COMPONENTS
D.4.1 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for selecting
the units of blood components to allocate, which undergo
preliminary validation and are revalidated periodically, and
following any major changes to the process.
The procedures for selecting the units of blood components to
allocate shall guarantee:
iz
i
D.4.1.1 For RBC transfusions: ABO and RhD immunological compatibility.
D.4.1.2 For platelet transfusions: ABO immunological compatibility.
Se
rv
D.4.1.3 For plasma and cryoprecipitate transfusions: ABO
immunological compatibility and the absence of clinically
significant irregular erythrocyte antibodies in the donor.
D.4.1.4 For leukocyte transfusions: ABO and RhD immunological
compatibility, and the preparation and adoption of specific
selection criteria.
D.4.1.5 For neonatal and paediatric transfusions: the preparation
and adoption of specific blood component selection
criteria.
M
TI
D.4.1.6 For transfusions of leuko-depleted blood components: the
systematic assessment of cases in which their selection is
indicated, based on the applicable guidelines.
SI
D.4.1.7 For the transfusion of all blood components: the systematic
application of defined criteria and methods for the
selection and clinical use of irradiated blood components
and of blood components that are serologically tested
and/or leuko-depleted to reduce the risk of transmission
of CMV.
©
D.4.2 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for
conducting pretransfusion diagnostic investigations to
guarantee that the immunological compatibility between the
donor and recipient is ascertained.
D.4.2.1 For the allocation of blood components containing RBC, the
BE shall guarantee the recipient’s ABO blood group testing
and RhD typing in duplicate, on two different samples
collected at different times.
D.4.2.2 For the allocation of blood components containing RBC,
the BE shall guarantee screening for clinically significant
irregular erythrocyte antibodies in the recipient.
120
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.4.2.3 For the allocation of blood components containing RBC, the
BE shall define the cases in which compatibility testing is
required.
D.4.2.4 For the allocation of blood components containing RBC for
which crossmatch compatibility tests are omitted, the BE
shall adopt measures designed to guarantee the safety of
the allocation.
Se
rv
iz
i
D.4.2.5 Where the BE provides blood components for newborn and
paediatric patients, the procedures shall define the criteria
and working methods to perform the pretransfusion
investigations and allocate blood components to these
categories of patients.
D.4.3 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for selecting
and allocating blood components in urgent and emergency
situations.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for selecting the
units of blood components to allocate, which undergo preliminary
validation and are revalidated periodically , and following any major
changes to the process.
M
TI
D.4.1
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for selecting the units of blood
components to allocate.
SI
These procedures shall undergo preliminary validation and be revalidated
periodically, and following any major changes made to the process.
The procedures for selecting blood components to allocate shall guarantee:
©
D.4.1.1 For RBC transfusions: ABO and RhD immunological compatibility.
The procedures shall define the criteria for guiding the selection of units of RBC,
particularly concerning any highly specific clinical situations being treated where
applicable (e.g. post-transplant chimerism).
They shall also include a definition of the criteria for allocating RhD-positive RBC
to RhD-negative patients, should the need arise (see also Standard D.4.3).
For women of child-bearing age, paediatric and newborn patients, multi-transfused
patients and other particular patient categories, transfusions should be as
compatible as possible for the Rh phenotype and the Kell antigen, depending on the
urgency and/or deferability of the request.
121
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.4.1.2 For platelet transfusions: ABO immunological compatibility.
Se
rv
iz
i
The BE shall guarantee the selection of platelets from donors with the same ABO
phenotype as the patient whenever possible.
The need for compatibility with the RhD type may be waived providing there
is no “visible” erythrocyte contamination inside the units of platelets. If they
are properly implemented, current methods for preparing platelet concentrates
enable erythrocyte contamination to be restricted to approximately 0.03 mL/pool
of platelets from whole blood, and approximately 0.005-0.007 mL/unit obtained
by apheresis; these levels make the risk of anti-D allo-immunisation virtually
negligible. In particular categories of patients (e.g. women of child-bearing
age and patients receiving haematopoietic progenitor cell transplants), it may
nonetheless be necessary to consider the need for compatibility with the RhD type
as well as with the ABO blood group.
If units of group O platelets are selected for non-O patients, only products with a
minimal plasma residue should be used, such as “dry” platelets from apheresis
or from pooled buffy coat resuspended in additive solution, or platelets obtained
by pooling or apheresis which have undergone plasma removal and resuspension
in additive solution.
M
TI
Where units of group O platelets obtained from pools or apheresis resuspended
in plasma are selected for non-O patients, a low titre of anti-A and/or anti-B
iso-haemoagglutinins shall be guaranteed (≤ 1:64). Even if the titre of isohaemoagglutinins is low, the selection of platelet units from group O donors
resuspended in plasma for non-O patients is generally not to be recommended for
newborn and paediatric patients.
SI
The use of platelets with a major donor-recipient ABO incompatibility is
discouraged, except in specific clinical cases, such as the need to transfuse HLA/
HPA-compatible platelets. In making such a choice, operators should bear in
mind the potential association of the ABO-incompatible platelet transfusion with a
higher frequency of refractory responses.
Units of platelets of different ABO blood groups shall not be mixed.
©
For platelet products containing significant quantities of plasma, a negative
result of screening for clinically significant irregular erythrocyte antibodies in the
donor(s) shall be guaranteed. This requirement may be waived in relation to
specific clinical conditions, such as the need to transfuse HLA/HPA-compatible
platelets, providing the patient does not have the antigen(s) corresponding to
the antibody(ies) potentially contained in the donor’s plasma, and/or providing
the plasma has been removed from the platelet product and the latter has been
resuspended in additive solution.
122
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.4.1.3 For plasma and cryoprecipitate transfusions: ABO immunological
compatibility and the absence of clinically significant irregular
erythrocyte antibodies in the donor.
The ABO phenotype of the donor’s plasma should be compatible with that of the
recipient.
iz
i
Compatibility with the RhD type may be waived providing there is no visible
haemoglobin contamination inside the unit of plasma/cryoprecipitate.
Se
rv
A negative response to screening for clinically significant irregular erythrocyte
antibodies in the donor shall be guaranteed.
D.4.1.4 For leukocyte transfusions: ABO and RhD immunological
compatibility, and the preparation and adoption of specific selection
criteria.
If the BE produces leukocyte-based blood components for the purposes of particular
activities underway in the areas it serves, specific criteria shall be defined and
adopted for their selection.
M
TI
D.4.1.5 For neonatal and paediatric transfusions: the preparation and
adoption of specific blood component selection criteria.
If the BE provides blood components for newborn and paediatric patients, specific
criteria shall be defined and adopted for the selection of blood components to
allocate to such patients.
SI
The BE should refer to the “Raccomandazioni per la trasfusione in neonatologia”
[Recommendations on transfusion in neonatology] issued by the SIMTI in
co-operation with the Italian Neonatology Society (SIN) and the Study Group on
neonatal haematology.
©
D.4.1.6 For transfusions of leuko-depleted blood components: the
systematic assessment of cases in which their use is indicated,
based on the applicable guidelines.
This Standard does not apply to a BE that systematically conducts the leukocyte
depletion of blood components in relation to specific policies.
123
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.4.1.7 For the transfusion of all blood components: the systematic
application of defined criteria and methods for the selection and
clinical use of irradiated blood components and of blood components
that are serologically tested and/or leuko-depleted to reduce the
risk of transmission of CMV.
iz
i
As concerns blood components that have been irradiated and blood components
that are serologically tested and/or leuko-depleted to reduce the risk of transmitting
CMV, the present Standard is applicable to BEs that handle said specific treatments.
Se
rv
For the purposes of preventing transfusion-associated GVHD, irradiated blood
components should be selected mainly in the following cases:
a) selected cases of immunocompromised adult recipients;
b) transfusions from closely related donors;
c) patients undergoing haemopoietic progenitor cell transplants;
d) recipients of units of HLA-compatible platelets;
e) selected newborn and paediatric recipients;
f) intrauterine transfusion.
M
TI
If clinical and/or organisational reasons prevent irradiated blood components from
being transfused into the patients for whom they were specifically selected, said
blood components may not be used for other patients for whom said treatment is
not indicated.
SI
To reduce the risk of transfusion-associated CMV infection, serologically tested
and/or leuko-depleted blood components should be used mainly in the following
cases:
a) selected cases of immunocompromised adult recipients;
b) selected newborn and paediatric recipients;
c) selected cases of patients receiving solid organ or haemopoietic progenitor cell
transplants;
d) CMV-negative pregnant women.
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for conducting
pretransfusion diagnostic investigations to guarantee that the
immunological compatibility between the donor and recipient is
ascertained.
©
D.4.2
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for the pretransfusion
diagnostic tests needed to ascertain immunological compatibility between donors
and recipients.
124
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.4.2.1 For the allocation of blood components containing RBC, the BE
shall guarantee the recipient’s ABO blood group testing and RhD
typing in duplicate, on two different samples collected at different
times.
iz
i
For the allocation of blood components containing RBC, the BE shall guarantee the
availability of the results of tests to establish the recipient’s ABO blood group and
RhD type, conducted in duplicate on two different samples obtained at different
times, for all scheduled requests and for urgent requests whenever the patient’s
clinical conditions allow for the performance of said duplicate test.
Se
rv
In addition to the contents of the Standard D.2.2, a check shall be guaranteed on
the consistency of any available prior typing test results with the outcome of tests
conducted on the samples received together with the request for transfusion.
When consistent prior typing results are available, the second test becomes
unnecessary, providing the patient’s identification is guaranteed by means of the
exact consistency of the patient’s personal details (surname, name and date of
birth).
Duplicate blood group tests should also be used for all scheduled and urgent
requests for fresh frozen plasma and platelets.
SI
M
TI
Where it is impossible to obtain a second blood group test result (a situation
allowable exclusively for reasons relating to the patient’s clinical conditions, and
therefore only in the case of urgent or emergency requests), the following should
be allocated:
a) O blood group RBC of the same RhD type as the patient’s, , in the case of
allocating blood components containing RBC;
b) AB blood group fresh frozen plasma in the case of allocating plasma;
c) ABO compatible platelets with a low plasma residue resuspended in additive
solution or, as a second choice, O blood group platelets resuspended in the
donor’s own plasma, in which a low titre of anti-A and Anti-B isohaemoagglutinins
has been ascertained (see Standard D.4.1.2).
©
Urgent requests relating to patients whose clinical conditions were too severe to
allow for duplicate blood group tests should be systematically documented.
D.4.2.2 For the allocation of blood components containing RBC, the BE shall
guarantee screening for clinically significant irregular erythrocyte
antibodies in the recipient.
For the allocation of blood components containing RBC, the BE shall guarantee
screening for clinically significant irregular erythrocyte antibodies in the recipient,
for both scheduled and urgent transfusion requests.
125
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
A negative outcome of screening for irregular erythrocyte antibodies may be used
as a pretransfusion compatibility test for up to 7 days after its performance in the
following cases:
a) if the patient has never received a transfusion before;
b) if the patient has received a transfusion no less than 4 weeks previously;
c) if the patient is not pregnant and has not delivered/miscarried in the last 4 weeks;
d) if the patient’s clinical history of transfusions is not dubious or impossible to
ascertain.
Se
rv
iz
i
Apart from the above-mentioned cases, a negative result of screening for irregular
erythrocyte antibodies may be used as a pretransfusion compatibility test for no more
than 72 hours after its performance, particularly in cases involving the allocation of
blood component containing RBC without any prior major crossmatch compatibility
testing (the so-called Type & Screen procedure), as established in Standard D.4.2.4.
In patients receiving transfusions routinely for chronic diseases, screening for
irregular erythrocyte antibodies should be guaranteed for every new transfusion
cycle, or at least according to an established schedule depending on the likelihood
of the patient developing a transfusion-related immunisation, even if these
patients systematically undergo crossmatch compatibility testing.
In patients repeatedly receiving RBC transfusions with a short interval between them,
screening for irregular erythrocyte antibodies should be guaranteed every 72 hours.
M
TI
For the specific methods to use in screening for irregular erythrocyte antibodies,
see Section E - Diagnostic laboratory activities, Standard E.3.4.
Screening for irregular erythrocyte antibodies should be conducted as rapidly as
possible after receiving the blood sample concerned.
SI
If the efficacy of the RBC transfusion is reportedly or found to be inadequate despite
negative results emerging from screening for irregular erythrocyte antibodies
and/or crossmatch compatibility testing, the tests should be repeated using nonanticoagulated blood samples, which should be tested as soon as possible after
their collection, and never more than 2 hours later, particularly to identify any
presence of complement-dependent anti-erythrocyte antibodies.
©
In such situations, the BE should prepare and adopt specific investigation
algorithms/protocols to include obtaining detailed clinical information and the
further tests required to deal with the reported/identified cases.
D.4.2.3 For the allocation of blood components containing RBC, the BE shall
define the cases in which crossmatch compatibility tests are required.
For the allocation of blood components containing RBC, the BE shall define the
cases in which crossmatch compatibility tests have to be conducted and the cases in
which other procedures can be adopted in lieu of said tests (see standard D.4.2.4).
For the allocation of blood components containing RBC, the BE shall guarantee
the performance of crossmatching tests in all cases where screening for irregular
126
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
iz
i
erythrocyte antibodies in the recipient proves positive or the patient has a clinical
history of positivity.
Negative crossmatching results may be acceptable as a pretransfusion compatibility
test for up to 7 days after the test’s performance in the following cases:
a) if the patient has never received a transfusion before;
b) if the patient has received a transfusion no less than 4 weeks previously;
c) if the patient is not pregnant and has not delivered/miscarried in the last 4 weeks;
d) if the patient’s clinical history of transfusions is not dubious or impossible to
ascertain.
Apart from the above-mentioned cases, a negative crossmatching result may be
acceptable as a pretransfusion compatibility test for up to 72 hours after the test’s
performance.
Se
rv
For the specific methods to use in crossmatching tests, see Section E - Diagnostic
laboratory activities, Standard E.3.4.
D.4.2.4 For the allocation of blood components containing RBC for which
crossmatch compatibility tests are omitted, the BE shall adopt
measures designed to guarantee the safety of the allocation.
M
TI
When implementing the so-called Type & Screen procedure, which involves
allocating blood components containing RBC without any crossmatching tests, the
BE shall adopt measures designed to guarantee the safety of such allocations.
©
SI
When adopting the Type & Screen procedure, the following safety criteria shall
therefore be met:
a) acceptance checks shall be conducted systematically on the request and on the
associated biological samples in accordance with Standards D.2.1 and D.2.2.;
b) the duplicate determination of the patient’s ABO blood group and RhD type
shall be systematically guaranteed, in accordance with Standard D.4.2.1;
c) screening for irregular erythrocyte antibodies in the recipient shall comply
with the requirements established in Standard D.4.2.2, particularly concerning
the period during which its use as a pretransfusion test is acceptable, and the
technical requirements for the analytical procedure;
d) the outcome of screening for irregular erythrocyte antibodies in the recipient shall
be negative and the patient’s immunohaematological history shall be negative
for any prior, clinically significant irregular erythrocyte antibody positivity;
e) unless this has already been done, the ABO blood group and RhD type of the blood
units shall be verified (and said verification shall be documented), always using a
segment of the blood unit sampling tube to prepare the erythrocytes to test;
f) alternatively, an abbreviated crossmatch in saline solution may be done at
room temperature (the so-called immediate spinning procedure), here again
always using a segment of the blood unit sampling tube to prepare the RBC
suspensions to test;
g) a validated computer-based management system shall be used to guarantee
the systematic reporting of any discrepancies between the donor’s and the
recipient’s blood groups, relating to the ABO system at least; the system shall
provide the suspension of the procedure for allocating and releasing blood
component units that prove to be ABO-incompatible.
127
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.4.2.5 Where the BE provides blood components for newborn and
paediatric patients, the procedures shall define the criteria and
working methods to perform the pretransfusion investigations and
allocate blood components to these categories of patients.
iz
i
If a BE also provides blood components for newborn and paediatric patients,
specific criteria shall be defined and adopted for the pretransfusion investigations
and for allocating blood components to this category of patients.
D.4.3
Se
rv
These criteria shall refer to the Raccomandazioni per la trasfusione in neonatologia
[Recommendations on transfusion in neonatology] developed by the SIMTI in cooperation with the Italian Neonatology Society (SIN) and to the Raccomandazioni
per la gestione della Malattia Emolitica del Neonato [Recommendations for the
management of Haemolytic Diseases of the Newborn] developed by the SIMTI in
co-operation with the Italian Society of Gynaecology & Obstetrics (SIGO).
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for selecting and
allocating blood components in urgent and emergency situations.
For the definitions of “urgency” and “emergency” relating to transfusions, see
Standard D.1.1.2.
M
TI
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for selecting and allocating
blood components in urgent and emergency situations.
©
SI
These procedures shall define:
a) the criteria for selecting and allocating blood components in urgent and
emergency conditions particularly as concerns:
- any allocation of RhD-positive red blood cells to RhD-negative patients;
- urgent requests in which it is impossible to obtain the results of a duplicate
determination of the ABO blood group and RhD type (see Standard D.4.2.1);
- the criteria for allocating fresh frozen plasma and platelets;
b) the pretransfusion compatibility test methods;
c) the time taken to fulfil requests, which shall be consistent with the time defined
in the procedures contained in Standard D.1.1.2;
d) the working methods to adopt to guarantee an adequate interaction with
any connected structures/organisations (e.g. remote blood bank services,
accredited private hospitals, etc.), also in relation to the contracts/agreements
mentioned in Standard D.1.1.4.
The time technically needed in-house to fulfil requests for urgent transfusions
should be kept to no more than a mean 60 minutes, except in cases of:
a) particular immunohaematological problems relating to the patient’s typing and
compatibility testing;
b) any nonconformities emerging from the correlation between the request, the patient
and the samples that might negatively influence the safety of the transfusion;
c) any unusually high number of simultaneous urgent requests imposing the need
to establish an order of clinical priority for fulfilling the requests.
128
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
Blood components containing RBC allocated in emergency conditions shall be
systematically submitted to an additional assessment of the ABO blood group
and RhD type always using a segment of the blood unit sampling tube; this test
may also be conducted prior to the allocation; in any case, its performance shall
always be documented.
D.5 ISSUING BLOOD COMPONENTS
iz
i
The basic immunohaematological study of patients receiving emergency
transfusions (ABO blood group and RhD type, and screening for irregular
erythrocyte antibodies) should preferably be conducted on a sample drawn before
the patient is transfused in view of the possible need for further transfusions.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for the issuing
of allocated units of blood components, and of any related returns;
these procedures shall be preliminarily validated, and revalidated
periodically and following any major changes to the process.
M
TI
D.5.1
Se
rv
D.5.1 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for issuing
allocated units of blood components, and of any related returns;
these procedures shall be preliminarily validated, revalidated
periodically and following any major changes to the process.
The procedures concerning the issue of allocated units of blood components, and
any related returns, shall be preliminarily validated, then revalidated periodically
and following any major changes to the process.
SI
These procedures shall define the methods and working means for conducting
the activities described below.
©
a) Assessment of the correlation between the request, the patient and the
blood unit.
Prior to the issue of blood units, a check on the unequivocal correlation between
the request, the patient and the allocated blood units shall be guaranteed.
Computer-based objective functions should be in place and systematically used
with a view to preventing the release of blood units for which the unequivocal
correlation between the request, the patient and the allocated blood units has
not been confirmed.
b) Visual inspection of blood units.
Prior to the issue of blood units, a check on the integrity of the blood units and
their labelling shall be guaranteed, including an inspection to ensure there are
no visually detectable anomalies (clotting, haemolysis, flocculation, platelet
aggregates, etc.).
Blood units that are not intact and/or that reveal other irreparable anomalies
shall not be issued.
129
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
©
SI
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
c) Issuing the blood units and related records.
The records for issuing blood units shall include at least:
- the type, identification code, ABO blood group and RhD type of the blood
component;
- any treatments;
- the surname, name, date of birth, ABO blood group and RhD type of the
intended recipient;
- the unit/place where the patient is in care;
- the date and time of delivery;
- identification of the operators issuing and receiving the blood component (by
means of a computer-based identification method or signature on paper).
d) Management of the issue of documents accompanying blood units.
The documentation accompanying the blood units generally comprises:
- allocation labels attached to the blood units, bearing witness to donorrecipient compatibility;
- forms containing the patient’s personal and immunohaematological details,
the unit/place where the patient is treated, certification of donor-recipient
compatibility, the date and time of issue of the blood unit(s), spaces for the
signatures of the operators involved in issue and receipt;
- forms (or spaces/cells provided in the compatibility certificate) for certifying
the completion of the transfusion, the proper preservation of untransfused
blood units returned to the BE, and for reporting any adverse events,
processing errors, or near misses.
e) Packaging and transportation of blood units.
For the packaging and transportation of blood units, see Section A - General
organisational requirements, Ch. A.6.4 Packaging and transportation of blood,
blood components and haemopoietic stem cells.
Management of untransfused blood units returned to the BE and of the
certificates testifying to their proper preservation while away from the BE, and
management of the certificates testifying to the final destination of blood units
not returned to the BE.
g) Management of reports on transfusion-related adverse reactions and adverse
events, processing errors and near misses.
Said reports shall comply with local/national haemovigilance and clinical risk
management programmes. (see Standard D.6.1).
h) Management of the issue in the event of a computer system outage or
malfunction.
The BE shall prepare appropriate alternative procedures to adopt in the event
of computer system failures or malfunctions in order to ensure the continuing
issue of allocated blood component units, guaranteeing their safety and
traceability.
i) Management of the issue of plasma derivatives, in cases where the BE handles
this activity.
The records, documentation and control measures relating to the issue of
allocated blood components and any related returns should be managed entirely
by computer.
130
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.6 HAEMOVIGILANCE ON RECIPIENTS
D.6.1 The BE shall adopt specific
haemovigilance on recipients.
procedures
for
managing
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall adopt specific procedures for managing haemovigilance
on recipients.
iz
i
D.6.1
Se
rv
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures defining the responsibilities
and working methods for managing the haemovigilance measures for which they
are responsible, in the light of current legislation and the local, regional and
national haemovigilance and clinical risk management programmes.
A reference person for recipient haemovigilance shall be formally appointed.
M
TI
The BE shall define working methods designed to guarantee the proper and
thorough management of:
a) epidemiological records relating to potentially transfusion-transmitted
infectious diseases;
b) reports of severe unexpected reactions and severe incidents relating to the
transfusion process, as well as processing errors and near misses.
SI
Procedures shall be prepared and made available for notifying the Regional Blood
Coordinating Centre and the National Blood Centre about all undesirable reactions
and all severe transfusion-related incidents with reference to the applicable national
and regional directives, using the national information system for transfusion
services (SISTRA, see Section A - General organisational requirements, Ch. A.8
Reporting).
©
By arrangement with the one or more hospital transfusion committees on which it
is institutionally required to serve, the BE should promote the use of the abovementioned reports as a means for monitoring and auditing transfusion practices in
the areas it serves and the BE’s ability to guarantee adequate transfusion quality
and safety, in order to enable the identification of any specific critical issues and
areas needing improvement.
131
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.7 MANAGEMENT OF BLOOD COMPONENT STOCKS
D.7.1 The BE shall establish the necessary qualitative and quantitative
levels of its blood component stocks in the light of its predicted
needs.
iz
i
D.7.1.1 The BE shall define the blood component stocks relating to
other structures/organisations referring to the BE.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall establish the necessary qualitative and quantitative levels
of its blood component stocks in the light of its predicted needs.
Se
rv
D.7.1
The stocks of blood components are defined with a view to efficiently and
effectively ensuring that the qualitative and quantitative transfusion needs in the
areas served by the BE are met, as well as any commitment to supply blood
components to other BEs, or any plan to obtain supplies from other BEs.
M
TI
Proper planning of the blood component stocks also enables an efficient turnover
of the blood components to be guaranteed, which is essential to ensuring the
systematic availability of blood units that have been stored for the shortest possible
time, and to preventing the excessive ageing and expiry of the blood units.
The BE shall guarantee qualitatively and quantitatively defined stocks of red blood
cells, fresh frozen plasma and platelets in relation to its predicted average needs.
SI
In order to plan the qualitative and quantitative characteristics of its stocks of
blood components, the BE shall establish threshold values, for each ABO and RhD
type, based on the global average needs relating to one or more defined periods of
time (e.g. daily, weekly) consisting of the sum of the predicted needs for routine
purposes and for urgent and emergency requests and, where applicable, to meet
any previously arranged commitment to supply other BEs.
©
It should be noted that the definition of the thresholds for the stocks of blood
components shall be objectively consistent with the average predicted needs,
particularly concerning red blood cells with the O RhD negative phenotype and
fresh frozen plasma with the AB phenotype.
If the BE is not self-sufficient, it shall systematically make agreements and
establish plans for acquiring blood components from other BEs so as to guarantee
the necessary qualitative and quantitative levels of its stocks.
For example, threshold values may be identified for the following situations:
a) equilibrium;
b) excess;
c) shortage;
d) emergency.
132
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
Based on the established threshold values, the BE shall constantly monitor the
qualitative and quantitative levels of its stocks so as to take timely action to deal
with any reductions in its stocks attributable to extraordinary demands or rising
trend in consumption, as well as any stocks exceeding
the predicted levels
(due to contingencies or changing trends) and, wherever possible, take action to
realign the stocks with the equilibrium threshold values.
Se
rv
iz
i
To adequately manage potential critical reductions in stocks of labile blood
components for transfusions after extraordinary events (e.g. pandemics or other
epidemiological crises, earthquakes), the BE shall be proactive in ensuring that
the hospital transfusion committees define the specific clinical situations in which
transfusion treatments shall nonetheless be guaranteed and those in which they
may be postponed. For this purpose, the BE should refer to the guidelines issued
by the SIMTI and possibly also by the pertinent Regional Blood Coordinating
Centre.
The BE should take specific organisational steps to avoid stocking blood
components that have been allocated but not issued.
D.7.1.1 The BE shall define the blood component stocks relating to other
structures/organisations referring to the BE.
M
TI
The BE shall define the stocks of blood components relating to the structures/
organisations (peripheral organisations, remote blood bank services, accredited
private hospitals, etc.) referring to the BE.
©
SI
For the needs of these associated structures/organisations, the BE shall guarantee:
a) the qualitative and quantitative stocks required to meet routine needs and for
urgent and emergency transfusions, based on the predicted average needs at
each location;
b) an efficient turnover and timely topping up of stocks, particularly concerning
the stocks for urgent and emergency transfusions.
133
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.8 DISTRIBUTION OF BLOOD COMPONENTS
D.8.1 BLOOD COMPONENT EXCHANGE
D.8.1.1 The BE shall participate in blood component exchange
activities for the supply/acquisition of blood components
according to the instructions of the Regional Blood
Coordinating Centre.
iz
i
D.8.1.2 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for
managing blood component exchange activities.
Se
rv
D.8.1.2.1 The BE shall define specific working methods to adopt
in the case of acquiring blood components from other
structures.
D.8.1.2.2 The BE shall define specific working methods to adopt
in the case of supplying blood components to other
structures; said methods shall undergo preliminary
validation and be revalidated periodically and following
any major changes to the process.
M
TI
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
D.8.1.1 The BE shall participate in blood component exchange activities
for the supply/acquisition of blood components according to the
instructions of the Regional Blood Coordinating Centre.
SI
The efficient and effective functioning of blood component exchange flows is one
of the fundamental prerequisites for self-sufficiency at local, regional and national
level.
The BE shall take part in blood component exchange activities to meet regional
needs in accordance with the indications of the Regional Blood Coordinating
Centre.
©
D.8.1.2 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for managing
blood component exchange activities.
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures that define the responsibilities
and working methods for managing blood component exchange activities.
The procedures shall particularly define the methods and tools to use in performing
the activities described below.
a) Identification of the availability/shortage of blood components.
The availability/shortage of blood components shall be identified consistently
with the planning and management of stocks as specified in Standard D.7.1.
134
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
iz
i
b) Management of relations and communications.
Methods and tools shall be defined for managing relations and communications
with the Regional Blood Coordinating Centre, the client/supplier BE(s), the
persons responsible for transportation, and any other parties involved.
c) Management of blood component packaging and transportation.
For the general criteria relating to the packaging and transportation of blood
units, see Section A - General organisational requirements, Ch. A.6.4 Packaging
and transportation of blood, blood components and haemopoietic stem cells.
d) Management of administrative aspects at the BE.
The management of administrative aspects consequent to the blood component
exchange activities shall be established in relation to the organisational setting
in which the BE operates, and to the relevant regional and national provisions.
Se
rv
D.8.1.2.1 The BE shall define specific working methods to adopt in the
case of acquiring blood components from other structures.
©
SI
M
TI
If blood components are acquired from other structures, the BE shall define
appropriate working methods to ensure the proper and thorough performance
of all the activities relating to the acceptance, control and stocking of the blood
components received.
In particular, the BE shall guarantee:
a) an inspection on the integrity of the containers for transporting blood units;
b) an assessment of the state of preservation of the blood units:
- by checking any temperature monitoring devices associated with the
container;
- by recording the temperature with its own instruments;
- by obtaining the relevant transport system validation certificates;
c) a check on the physical state and integrity of the blood units, including the
availability of a sufficient number of sampling tube segments for each blood
unit;
d) a check on the consistency of the information on the labels on the blood units
(sender BE, identification code, blood group, date of collection, date of expiry,
any treatments) with the information recorded on the delivery documents;
e) a check on the biological validation certificate for the blood units;
f) a check on the conformity of the blood units to the quantitative and quantitative
specifications as agreed with the sender BE;
g) the complete traceability of single blood units in the same way as for blood
units produced in-house at the BE;
h) the definition of administrative methods for managing any blood units that are
unusable due to irreparable nonconformities;
i) the systematic documentation of all control activities;
j) the systematic recording and management of any nonconformities in blood
units received and the related documentation.
The BE should guarantee that the process for managing blood units acquired
from other BE is supported entirely by adequate computer-based means.
135
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.8.1.2.2 The BE shall define specific working methods to adopt in the
case of supplying blood components to other structures;
said methods shall undergo preliminary validation and be
revalidated periodically and following any major changes to
the process.
iz
i
If blood units are supplied to other structures, the BE shall define working
methods to guarantee the proper and thorough performance of the activities
involved in the selection, control, packaging and delivery/dispatching of the
blood components supplied.
Se
rv
These methods shall undergo preliminary validation and shall be revalidated
periodically and following any major changes made to the process.
SI
M
TI
In particular, the BE shall guarantee:
a) the qualitative and quantitative selection of the blood components according
to the agreements made with the BE due to receive them, and/or with the
specifications established in any previous agreements stipulated with the
latter;
b) an inspection of the physical state and integrity of the blood units, including
the availability of a sufficient number of segments of sampling tube for each
blood unit;
c) an assessment of the accuracy and integrity of the labels on the blood units;
d) the production of the necessary accompanying documents, including biological
validation certificates for the blood units, and details of the tests performed for
said purpose;
e) the operations for releasing the blood units;
f) any packaging of the blood units according to the arrangements made with
the BE due to receive them, and in any case designed to ensure conditions in
transit that preserve the biological properties of the products;
g) the delivery or dispatch of the blood units according to the arrangements made
with the BE due to receive them;
h) notification to the BE due to receive the blood units of any changes to the
arrangements concerning the qualitative or quantitative consistency of the
blood components supplied, the methods for their packaging and/or dispatch,
which must in any case be done before the blood components are distributed.
©
The BE should guarantee that the process for managing blood units supplied to
other BEs is supported entirely by adequate computer-based means.
136
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
D.8.2 DELIVERY OF PLASMA TO PHARMACEUTICAL COMPANIES
iz
i
D.8.2.1 The BE shall adopt specific procedures, which undergo
preliminary validation and are periodically revalidated and
following any major changes to the process, to guarantee
the proper management of deliveries of frozen plasma to
pharmaceutical companies under contract for processing
plasma and supplying the corresponding plasma-derived
medicinal products.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
Se
rv
D.8.2.1 The BE shall adopt specific procedures, which undergo preliminary
validation and are periodically revalidated and following any major
changes to the process, to guarantee the proper management of
deliveries of frozen plasma to pharmaceutical companies under
contract for processing plasma and supplying the corresponding
plasma-derived medicinal products.
M
TI
Contracts/agreements governing relations with pharmaceutical companies
specialising in processing human plasma in accordance with national and European
legislation are stipulated between such contracting companies and the regional
authorities, which may take action individually or in association with others.
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures defining the responsibilities
and working methods for managing activities relating to the delivery of frozen
plasma to pharmaceutical companies under contract to process the plasma.
SI
These procedures shall undergo preliminary validation and shall periodically be
revalidated and following any major changes being made to the process.
They shall be formulated in accordance with the relevant regional provisions and
with the rules and requirements established in the agreements stipulated between
the regional authorities and the pharmaceutical companies under contract, and/or
in documents forming an integral and substantial part of said agreements.
©
They shall also be formulated so as to guarantee:
a) that the process for the production, selection, storage and distribution of
the plasma destined for pharmaceutical processing is handled so that the
products delivered comply with the established qualitative and quantitative
requirements, particularly concerning the need to guarantee that no blood
units failing biological validation according to current legislation can be passed
on to the industry for any reason whatsoever;
b) that the selection, storage and distribution stages are supported by computerbased means sufficient to ensure high product safety levels and the traceability
of all the essential operations;
137
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
c) the management of any feedback from pharmaceutical companies under
contract relating to nonconformities identified in the units of plasma and/or the
documentation associated with each delivery, as established in the reference
agreements.
iz
i
The BE may take part in programmes for the production of hyperimmune plasma
to submit for industrial processing for the production of particular plasma-derived
medicinal products (e.g. anti-hepatitis B immunoglobulin) based on specific
agreements stipulated between pharmaceutical companies and the regional
authorities, or supplementary documents integrating agreements already in place.
Se
rv
In such cases, the BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures to govern
not only the related activities for collecting plasma, but also the activities for
the production, control, storage, packaging and distribution to the industry of
the hyperimmune plasma in compliance with the qualitative and quantitative
requirements established in the above-mentioned agreements and/or
supplementary documents forming an integral part thereof.
D.9 PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
M
TI
To constantly monitor the quality of the products-services provided and the
compliance of the processes implemented with the established standards, the BE
shall guarantee the monitoring of at least the indicators listed in the following
table.
©
SI
For the general criteria for planning quality monitoring activities, see Section AGeneral organisational requirements, Ch. A.7.1 Quality monitoring.
138
Reference
chapter:
Section D
D.2
D.3
D.3
D.3
D.4
N°
1
2
3
4
5
©
D.4.2.1
D.3.2.2
D.3.2.2
D.3.2.2
D.2.1
Reference
standard:
Section D
Selection and allocation
of blood components
Assessment of the
appropriateness of
requests
Assessment of the
appropriateness of
transfusion requests
Assessment of the
appropriateness of
transfusion requests
No. of requests for biological samples
Nonconforming out of No. of requests
received
Process control indicator
Check of patient’s blood
group: consistency with
previous test results
iz
i
No. of patient blood group
assessments inconsistent with
previous test results out of No. of
assessments performed
No. of inappropriate transfusion
requests out of No. of transfusion
requests received [data stratifiable
by type of blood component,
areas served, reasons for
inappropriateness, etc]
Se
rv
Clinical appropriateness of
transfusion requests
Appropriateness of transfusion No. of transfused blood components
requests (general)
out of No. of blood units allocated
[data stratifiable by type of blood
component, areas served, medical
and surgical treatment with the
greatest consumption, etc]
Appropriateness of transfusion No. of transfused blood components
requests (general)
out of No. of units requested
[data stratifiable by type of blood
component, areas served, medical
and surgical treatments with the
greatest consumption, etc)
Conformity of transfusion
requests (correctness and
completeness of data) and
associated biological samples
to established requirements
Characteristic to monitor
M
TI
SI
Acceptance of
transfusion requests
Activity
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
139
Reference
chapter:
Section D
D.4
D.5
D.6
D.6
D.6
N°
6
7
8
9
10
©
140
D.6.1
D.6.1
D.6.1
D.5.1
D.4.3
Reference
standard:
Section D
Haemovigilance
Haemovigilance
Haemovigilance
Issuing blood
components
Errors and near misses
relating to the selection and
allocation of blood components
(by the BE)
No. of errors and near misses reported
by requesting structures/parties +
those identified by the BE out of
No. of transfusion requests [data
stratifiable by type of error/near
miss]
No. of errors and near misses
identified by the BE out of No. of
blood components transfused [data
stratifiable by type of error/near
miss]
iz
i
No. of reports of adverse
events/near misses received out of
No. of blood components transfused
[data stratifiable by type of event/
near miss]
No. of feedback documents received
out of No. of blood component units
delivered
No. of requests for urgent or
emergency transfusions out of
Total No. of transfusion requests
[data stratifiable by type of blood
component, urgency/emergency,
areas served, etc]
Process control indicator
Se
rv
Transfusion-related errors
and near misses (involving
requesting structures/
subjects)
Transfusion-related adverse
events and near misses
(involving requesting
structures/parties)
Feedback on blood
components (usage of unit,
return of untransfused units,
reports of adverse reactions
and near misses)
Requests for urgent and
emergency transfusions
Characteristic to monitor
M
TI
SI
Selection and allocation
of blood components
Activity
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
Reference
chapter:
Section D
D.7
D.7
D.9
N°
11
12
13
©
D.9.1
D.7.1.1
D.7.1.1
Reference
standard:
Section D
SI
Stock management efficiency
Characteristic to monitor
Delivery of plasma
to pharmaceutical
companies
Management of blood
component stocks
iz
i
No. of nonconformities identified by
pharmaceutical companies out of No.
of units of plasma delivered
Conformity to agreed product
specifications and procedures
in deliveries of plasma to
pharmaceutical companies
under contract
Se
rv
No. of transfusions postponed due to
shortage of blood components out of
No. of transfusions requested
No. of RBC units disposed of due
to expiry out of No. of RBC units
produced and validated
Process control indicator
Stock management efficiency
M
TI
Management of blood
component stocks
Activity
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section D - Allocation and distribution
of allogeneic blood components
2nd Edition
141
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
©
SI
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
142
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
SECTION E
LABORATORY DIAGNOSTIC ACTIVITIES
iz
i
CONTENTS
Se
rv
E.1 LIST OF LABORATORY DIAGNOSTIC SERVICES
AND INFORMATION FOR USERS ............................................................................... 145
E.2 GENERAL CRITERIA FOR THE MANAGEMENT
OF LABORATORY DIAGNOSTIC ACTIVITIES ............................................... 146
E.2.1 VALIDATION OF ANALYTICAL PROCESSES
.............................................
146
E.2.2 MANAGEMENT OF ACTIVITIES
IN THE PRE-ANALYTICAL STAGE....................................................................... 147
E.2.3 MANAGEMENT OF ACTIVITIES IN THE ANALYTICAL PHASE
....
149
E.2.4 MANAGEMENT OF ACTIVITIES
M
TI
IN THE POST-ANALYTICAL PHASE................................................................... 152
E.2.5 EXTERNAL QUALITY ASSESSMENT
................................................................
E.2.6 OUTSOURCING LABORATORY DIAGNOSTIC ACTIVITIES
...........
153
154
E.3 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR ERYTHROCYTE
IMMUNOHAEMATOLOGY TESTS ................................................................................. 155
E.3.1 MANAGEMENT OF ERYTHROCYTE
SI
IMMUNOHAEMATOLOGY TESTS
........................................................................
E.3.2 ABO AND RhD TYPING: DONORS
....................................................................
E.3.3 ABO AND RhD TYPING: PATIENTS
.................................................................
155
156
158
E.3.4 SCREENING FOR IRREGULAR ERYTHROCYTE ANTIBODIES
©
AND CROSSMATCHING
............................................................................................
E.3.5 IDENTIFICATION OF
IRREGULAR ERYTHROCYTE ANTIBODIES
.................................................
159
160
E.3.6 IMMUNOHAEMATOLOGICAL INVESTIGATIONS ON THE
HAEMOLYTIC DISEASE OF THE NEWBORN ............................................. 161
E.3.7 STUDY OF AUTOIMMUNE HAEMOLYTIC DISORDERS
.....................
162
E.4 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR MICROBIOLOGICAL TESTS
PERFORMED FOR THE QUALIFICATION
OF ALLOGENEIC BLOOD COMPONENTS ............................................................ 163
143
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
E.5 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR LEUKOCYTE AND PLATELET
IMMUNOHAEMATOLOGY TESTS .................................................................................. 164
E.6 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR EXTEMPORANEOUS
PREDONATION DIAGNOSTIC TESTS ...................................................................... 165
............................................................................
165
©
SI
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
E.7 PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
144
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
E.1 LIST OF LABORATORY DIAGNOSTIC SERVICES AND INFORMATION
FOR USERS
E.1.1 The BE shall define and formalise a list of the laboratory
diagnostic services it offers and provide all interested parties
with adequate information on how to access its services and
the related reporting times.
The BE shall define and formalise a list of the laboratory diagnostic
services it offers and provide all interested parties with adequate
information on how to access its services and the related reporting
times.
Se
rv
E.1.1
iz
i
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall define and formalise a comprehensive list of all the laboratory tests
it performs.
M
TI
This list of tests shall indicate:
a) tests performed for hospital inpatients and outpatients;
b) tests performed for donors, based on the established protocols for the biological
qualification of blood components and the routine and non-routine testing of
donors.
©
SI
The BE shall provide the healthcare structures requiring its laboratory diagnostic
services, and any NHS blood collection services for outpatients with a list of the
services it provides, indicating the following for each test:
a) the forms to use when requesting tests and the methods for managing the
forms;
b) the methods for collecting biological samples, including:
- the types and quantities of test-tubes/other containers to use;
- any particular sample collection methods;
- methods for identifying patients and sample and for unequivocally correlating
patients with their samples;
- any particular methods for handling, storing and transporting samples from
collection centres to the place where the BE receives them;
c) tests that can be requested urgently and methods for submitting urgent
requests;
d) normal reference values or ranges for the test results;
e) reporting times;
f) how to collect/send test reports;
g) how to ask the medical personnel at the BE to provide counselling on the test
results.
The diagnostic methods used to perform the tests shall be stated.
145
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
The BE shall provide outpatients and general practitioners with a list of the
laboratory diagnostic services it offers, indicating the following for each test:
a) methods for accessing the service and the single services provided;
b) normal reference values and ranges for the test results;
c) reporting times;
d) how to collect test reports;
e) how to ask the medical personnel at the BE to provide counselling on the test
results
iz
i
The documents containing the above-described information may be part of general
informative material for users (Service Charters, etc.) issued by the organisation
to which the BE refers.
Se
rv
The essential information on the laboratory tests performed for the biological
qualification of blood components, and for donor routine and non-routine tests
should be made available to donors as part of the informative and educational
material placed at their disposal when they make a donation.
E.2 GENERAL CRITERIA FOR THE MANAGEMENT OF LABORATORY
DIAGNOSTIC ACTIVITIES
E.2.1 VALIDATION OF ANALYTICAL PROCESSES
M
TI
E.2.1.1 The BE shall guarantee that the analytical processes it
manages are validated and revalidated both periodically
and after any major changes have been introduced.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
SI
E.2.1.1 The BE shall guarantee that the analytical processes it manages
are validated and revalidated both periodically and after any major
changes have been introduced.
©
The analytical processes managed by the BE shall be validated to guarantee their
efficacy in relation to the established purposes, following planned activities that
comprise the clear definition of the results to pursue and the related acceptance
criteria, the identification of critical process variables, the performance of tests and
the production of documented evidence in accordance with current legislation and
with the principles and standards contained in the latest edition of the Guide to the
preparation, use and quality assurance of blood components (EDQM - European
Directorate for the Quality of Medicines & Healthcare, Council of Europe).
Validation of analytical processes shall be conducted prospectively, but may also
be performed retrospectively in the case of processes defined and implemented
before the present Standards were enforced.
146
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
The analytical processes shall be periodically revalidated according to an
established schedule and shall undergo a new validation after any introduction
of changes to significant process parameters (e.g. replacement of equipment or
reagents, software updates).
For a definition of the term “Validation, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions.
iz
i
E.2.2 MANAGEMENT OF ACTIVITIES IN THE PRE-ANALYTICAL STAGE
E.2.2.1 The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures for
managing the pre-analytical stage for all the laboratory
tests that it conducts.
The BE shall guarantee the systematic assessment of
requests for laboratory tests and the related biological
samples, and the management of any nonconformities
identified.
Se
rv
E.2.2.1.1
E.2.2.2 The BE shall define and adopt procedures to guarantee the
systematic assessment of the analytical systems it uses.
The BE shall define, plan and implement the calibration
of the analytical systems it uses, as applicable.
E.2.2.2.2
The BE shall define, plan and implement specific
internal quality control activities.
M
TI
E.2.2.2.1
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
SI
E.2.2.1 The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures for managing
the pre-analytical stage for all the laboratory tests that it
conducts.
©
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for managing the preanalytical stage for all the laboratory tests that it conducts in-house, defining the
related stages, responsibilities, working methods and control points.
E.2.2.1.1
The BE shall guarantee the systematic assessment of requests
for laboratory tests and the related biological samples, and
the management of any nonconformities identified.
The BE shall adopt specific procedures for assessing the requests for tests that
it receives to ascertain:
a) the completeness of the details provided and the correctness of the stated
indications in the light of the established standards;
b) the consistency between the request and the biological samples;
147
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
c) where applicable, the appropriateness of the request in relation to:
- other tests requested at the same time;
- diagnostic profiles defined in shared protocols;
- clinical information on the patient, where available.
The BE shall plan the action to take in the event of nonconformities being found
in the requests.
Se
rv
iz
i
The BE shall adopt adequate procedures for checking the biological samples it
receives. These control measures shall concern at least:
a) the type of test-tube and anticoagulant used for the collection;
b) the identification of the sample;
c) the quantity of biological material collected;
d) any detectable alterations (e.g. clots in the case of blood collected with an
anticoagulant, haemolysis);
e) the signature of the person responsible for the collection, where applicable.
The BE shall plan the action to take if sample nonconformities are identified, such
as:
a) the use of alternative samples;
b) the request for a repeat sample collection;
c) sample segregation until they can be made suitable for use.
M
TI
E.2.2.2 The BE shall define and adopt procedures to guarantee the
systematic assessment of the analytical systems it uses.
SI
Before undertaking the analytical activities, the BE shall define and adopt
procedures defining the responsibilities and methods for assessing the analytical
systems used to perform tests in terms of:
a) the proper operation of the analytical systems;
b) the checking and preparation of reagents;
c) the calibration activities (see Standard E.2.2.2.1);
d) internal quality control activities.
The BE shall define, plan and implement the calibration of the
analytical systems it uses, as applicable.
©
E.2.2.2.1
For each test requiring calibration, the BE shall define the methods for calibrating
the analytical systems and their frequency, and the materials to use in their
calibration, so as to guarantee the metrological referability of test results.
Calibration activities shall be documented.
148
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
E.2.2.2.2
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
The BE shall define, plan and implement specific internal
quality control activities.
The BE shall guarantee the systematic performance and auditing of internal quality
control (IQC) activities for all tests conducted so as to assess and document the
precision and accuracy of the analytical processes.
Se
rv
iz
i
The IQC shall be formally planned in terms of:
a) the frequency of their performance and auditing;
b) the control materials to use;
c) the concentrations of control samples, where applicable;
d) the rules adopted and acceptance criteria;
e) the records to produce and related preservation times;
f) the processing of control charts, where applicable;
g) further data processing using appropriate statistical methods;
h) responsibilities and methods for implementing corrective and preventive
actions in the light of assessments of the ICQ outcomes.
The IQC performance and auditing activities shall be documented; the related
documents shall be preserved for at least a year.
E.2.3 MANAGEMENT OF ACTIVITIES IN THE ANALYTICAL PHASE
M
TI
E.2.3.1 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for
managing the analytical phase of all laboratory tests
performed.
The BE shall adopt specific methods for performing
laboratory tests and establishes the characteristics of
each test it performs.
E.2.3.1.2
For tests performed using different methods and/or
instruments, and/or at different locations, the BE shall
adopt specific methods for ensuring their correlation
and any necessary alignment.
SI
E.2.3.1.1
©
E.2.3.1.3
The BE shall ensure the traceability of the reagents
used in laboratory tests.
E.2.3.1.4
The BE shall guarantee that test results are validated
according to established procedures and by personnel
appointed by the management.
E.2.3.1.5
The BE shall preserve test results for established periods
of time in accordance with current legislation.
149
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
E.2.3.1 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for managing
the analytical phase of all laboratory tests performed.
The BE shall adopt specific methods for performing laboratory
tests and establish the characteristics of each test it
performs.
Se
rv
E.2.3.1.1
iz
i
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for managing the analytical
phase of all laboratory tests performed in-house, defining the phases,
responsibilities, working methods and control points.
The BE shall define and formalise the methods to adopt for performing the
laboratory test it conducts. In particular, the characteristics of the methods and
the requirements they must meet in relation to the specific demands of transfusion
safety shall be defined in terms of sensitivity and specificity.
M
TI
The methods shall guarantee systematic compliance with the manufacturer’s
recommendations accompanying the diagnostic systems and kits. Any substantial
deviations from said recommendations shall undergo preliminary validation
(for a definition of the term “Validation”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions).
©
SI
The BE shall formalise the requirements and specifications relating to each test,
defining at least:
a) for all tests:
- the characteristics of the biological sample to test (type of test-tube,
quantity of sample, any anticoagulant, etc.);
- the test schedule;
- the method used;
- the type, mode and frequency of IQCs and their auditing;
- acceptance criteria for the results of IQCs;
- response times (in routine and urgent situations).
b) depending on applicability:
- the type, mode and frequency of calibration of the analytical systems;
- the types of run control to use in addition to the controls provided by the
commercial kits;
- the types of control charts to produce after IQC activities;
- reference ranges for the results;
- grey zones;
- “clinical panic” findings/values imposing the need to promptly inform users;
- sensitivity/specificity levels.
150
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
E.2.3.1.2
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
For tests performed using different methods and/or
instruments, and/or at different locations, the BE shall adopt
specific methods for ensuring their correlation and any
necessary alignment.
iz
i
For tests conducted using different methods and/or instruments, and/or at
different sites, the BE shall adopt specific methods to ensure the correlations
between the results, identifying any discrepancies and providing any necessary
alignments.
Se
rv
E.2.3.1.3 The BE shall ensure the traceability of the reagents used in
laboratory tests.
The BE shall guarantee the traceability of the batches of reagents used to
perform tests, particularly for microbiological tests for blood component biological
qualification and RBC immunohaematology.
E.2.3.1.4
The BE shall guarantee that test results are validated according
to established procedures and by personnel appointed by the
management.
M
TI
The BE shall guarantee that test results are validated according to established
procedures and by personnel appointed by the management in the light of their
specific professional expertise/responsibilities.
For a definition of the term “Test validation”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions
©
SI
The activities for validating test results should always include:
a) preliminary validation, normally conducted under the responsibility of a medical
technician, involving the following steps:
- assessment of any calibrations;
- auditing of IQCs;
- repetition of any inconsistent tests with results in the grey zone or that
prompt a lab instrument alarm;
b) secondary validation by a biologist/physician, which may involve (as necessary):
- evaluating the consistency of the results, also by consulting online archives
(if any), ensuring that any inconsistencies are solved before the results are
released (e.g. by comparing a patient’s or donor’s immunohaematological
and biological qualification test results with their previous results);
- ordering a repeat test on the same sample;
- ordering a repeat test using another method;
- requesting a new sample on which to repeat the test;
- ordering and assessing further tests;
- consulting the physician requesting the test.
151
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
The BE shall provide evidence of all the primary and secondary validation
procedures that it implements.
The BE shall formalise and apply specific procedures for validating the results of
urgently performed tests.
E.2.3.1.5
The BE shall preserve test results for established periods of
time in accordance with current legislation.
iz
i
The BE shall preserve test results for established periods of time in accordance
with the requirements of current legislation.
Se
rv
E.2.4 MANAGEMENT OF ACTIVITIES IN THE POST-ANALYTICAL PHASE
E.2.4.1 The BE shall adopt specific procedures for preparing,
checking and releasing of test reports.
E.2.4.2 The BE shall adopt specific methods for managing biological
samples after completing the analytical phase.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
M
TI
E.2.4.1 The BE shall adopt specific procedures for preparing, checking and
issuing test reports.
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for the preparation, checking
and issue of test reports, defining the related responsibilities, working methods
and control points.
SI
Test reports shall be prepared so that they are clearly understandable.
©
They shall contain all the information needed for their proper interpretation, i.e.:
a) the name of the structure issuing the report;
b) patient/donor identification details;
c) the date of sample collection and the date of the report;
d) the name of the test;
e) the test result(s);
f) reference values/ranges, and corresponding units of measure, as applicable;
g) evidence of any pathological findings;
h) details of significant events potentially affecting the test result(s) and/or the
reference indices;
i) any explanatory notes.
The report shall not contain corrections or non-standard signs. Any corrections
shall be accompanied by the legible signature of the person making the change
and the original version shall nonetheless remain visible.
152
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
Wherever feasible, the BE shall handle the transfer of test results from the
laboratory equipment to the computer system by electronic means, at least for
blood unit validation tests. Where this is unfeasible, the transfer of data shall be
validated by two different operators and said validation procedure shall remain
traceable.
iz
i
E.2.4.2 The BE shall adopt specific methods for managing biological
samples after completing the analytical phase.
Se
rv
The BE shall define and formalise methods for managing biological samples after
the analytical phase has been completed, which may involve:
a) preserving samples for a given period of time to enable any repeat or further
tests, or their use if other samples prove inadequate;
b) preserving samples for the period of time established by current legislation
for any tests needed in the event of adverse reactions associated with the
transfusion process.
E.2.5 EXTERNAL QUALITY ASSESSMENT
M
TI
E.2.5.1 The BE shall guarantee its participation in external quality
assessment programmes on its laboratory diagnostic
activities.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
E.2.5.1 The BE shall guarantee its participation in external quality
assessment programmes on its laboratory diagnostic activities.
SI
The BE shall guarantee its systematic participation in external quality assessment
(EQA) programmes for assessing the performance of its analytical systems and
processes by means of comparisons of its results with a significant number of other
structures conducting the same tests and using the same or similar diagnostic
systems.
©
The samples submitted by the EQA programme managers shall be tested in the
conditions in which everyday samples are routinely tested.
The BE shall guarantee its participation in all EQA programmes managed by
regional and national competent authorities.
It shall anyway guarantee its participation in EQA/proficiency programmes at
least for the tests mainly characterising its laboratory diagnostic activities, i.e.
a) basic immunohaematological tests (for RBC phenotyping, irregular antibody
screening and identification, crossmatching, direct antiglobulin test);
b) immunometric serological assays for the biological qualification of blood
components (HBsAg, anti-HIV1-2, anti-HCV, Lue serology);
c) molecular tests for the biological qualification of blood components (HBV DNA,
HIV RNA, HCV RNA);
153
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
d) serological and molecular tissue typing tests;
e) cytofluorometric tests.
iz
i
Participation in EQA programmes shall be formally planned in terms of:
a) the diagnostic tests and systems involved;
b) the types of programmes and the frequency of their performance;
c) responsibilities;
d) criteria and methods for assessing results;
e) records to produce;
f) responsibilities and methods for implementing corrective and preventive
actions for significant deviations from the expected results.
Se
rv
The outcome of EQA activities shall be preserved for at least three years.
E.2.6 OUTSOURCING LABORATORY DIAGNOSTIC ACTIVITIES
E.2.6.1 The outsourcing of one or more test(s) shall be governed
by specific agreements and/or provisions established
according to the organisational context in which the BE
operates.
M
TI
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
E.2.6.1 The outsourcing of one or more test(s) shall be governed by
specific agreements and/or provisions established according to the
organisational context in which the BE operates.
©
SI
Specific formalised agreements and/or provisions shall govern the outsourcing of
laboratory diagnostic tests, according to the organisational setting in which the
BE operates.
Said agreements/provisions shall define:
a) the list of tests to perform and the methods for providing said service;
b) the methods for collecting, storing/handling and transporting the biological
samples;
c) the times and methods for delivering test reports or transmitting test results;
d) the methods for communicating any changes to the agreements/provisions.
Serological and molecular tests for the biological qualification of blood components
shall be outsourced exclusively to another BE.
For biological qualification tests, the agreements established to perform the tests
shall also define the technical specifications for the tests being performed and the
guarantee of the quality of the test results in relation to the specific needs relating
to transfusion safety and the relevant current legislation, i.e.:
a) test sensitivity and specificity levels;
b) grey zones;
c) internal quality control measures;
d) EQA programmes adopted;
154
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
e) criteria for validating test sessions;
f) algorithms adopted to manage results as established by current legislation;
g) methods for documenting and reporting the results of IQC and EQA activities.
The BE shall define its own methods for ensuring the traceability of the essential
reporting relating to outsourced tests.
iz
i
E.3 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR ERYTHROCYTE IMMUNOHAEMATOLOGY
TESTS
E.3.1 MANAGEMENT OF ERYTHROCYTE IMMUNOHAEMATOLOGY TESTS
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
Se
rv
E.3.1.1 The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods,
control procedures and decision algorithms for managing
erythrocyte immunohaematology tests.
E.3.1.1 The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods, control
procedures and decision algorithms for managing erythrocyte
immunohaematology tests.
M
TI
The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods, control procedures and
decision algorithms for managing erythrocyte immunohaematology tests.
SI
The methods for handling the biological samples to test, performing the test
sessions and related control measures, and managing the results of erythrocyte
immunohaematology tests - including the management of anomalies and
discrepancies in the test results vis-à-vis the expected values - shall be defined
with reference to the particular need to ensure immunological transfusion safety
and prevention of the haemolytic disease of the newborn (HDN). Reagents
and diagnostic systems bearing the CE-mark for specific diagnostic purposes
- whenever available - shall be used and the tests shall have a documented
sensitivity and specificity.
©
In addition to ensuring compliance with current legislation, the procedures,
control measures and decision algorithms should conform to the principles and
standards defined in the latest edition of the Guide to the preparation, use and
quality assurance of blood components (EDQM - European Directorate for the
Quality of Medicines & Healthcare, Council of Europe).
The essential requirements and recommendations applicable to the main
erythrocyte immunohaematology tests are defined below.
155
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
E.3.2 ABO AND RhD TYPING: DONORS
E.3.2.1 For unequivocally identified donors who have already been
typed for the ABO and RhD blood group systems at the
BE, RBCs shall be tested to ascertain ABO blood group and
RhD type at the time of donations using at least the anti-A,
anti-B and anti-D reagents.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
Se
rv
iz
i
E.3.2.2 For donors who have not already been typed for the ABO,
RhD and Kell blood groups systems:
- the ABO blood group shall be determined on RBCs using
the anti-A, anti-B and anti-A,B reagents;
- the ABO blood group shall be determined in serum/
plasma using at least A1 and B erythrocytes;
- RhD typing shall be performed using two different
anti-D reagents of documented sensitivity, deriving from
different clones in the case of both being monoclonal;
- RhD-negative erythrocytes shall be tested for weak D
(Du).
M
TI
E.3.2.1 For unequivocally identified donors who have already been typed
for the ABO and RhD blood group systems at the BE, RBCs
shall be tested to ascertain ABO blood group and RhD type at
the time of donations using at least the anti-A, anti-B and anti-D
reagents.
SI
RhD typing shall be conducted using an anti-D reagent of documented sensitivity,
preferably capable of identifying partial DVI (see also Section C - Production,
qualification and biological validation of blood components, Standard C.6.1).
©
E.3.2.2 For donors who have not already been typed for the ABO, RhD and
Kell blood groups systems:
- the ABO blood group shall be determined on RBCs using the
anti-A, anti-B and anti-A,B reagents;
- the ABO blood group shall be determined in serum/plasma
using at least A1 and B erythrocytes;
- RhD typing shall be performed using two different anti-D
reagents of documented sensitivity, deriving from different
clones in the case of both being monoclonal;
- RhD-negative erythrocytes shall be tested for weak D (Du).
For ABO blood group determination in serum/plasma, it may also be advisable
to use A2 and/or O erythrocytes, in order to identify weak phenotypes or
antibodies against ABH specificities.
156
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
RhD typing shall be done using two different anti-D reagents of documented
sensitivity (deriving from different clones in the case of both being monoclonal),
at least one of which should identify partial DVI in order to avoid erroneously
attributing the RhD-negative type to donors carrying the partial DVI variant.
The search for weak D (Du) shall be conducted using the indirect antiglobulin test,
with an anti-D reagent capable of identifying the partial DVI variant.
iz
i
If the search for weak D conducted using the indirect antiglobulin test is positive,
the negativity of the direct antiglobulin test shall be systematically tested in
parallel.
M
TI
Se
rv
The following criteria should also be adopted for RhD typing:
a) positivity to both the two anti-D reagents: RhD-positive;
b) negativity to both the two anti-D reagents and negativity in the search for
weak D: RhD-negative;
c) negativity to both the two anti-D reagents and positivity in the search for weak
D: RhD-positive;
d) positivity to only one anti-D reagent and negativity/positivity in the search for
weak D: the RhD-positive type is assumed as a “precautionary” measure; such
cases of inconsistency should be further analysed, preferably also by searching
for the RhD partial variants and/or by determining the RhD type using genome
amplification methods, relying on a reference immunohaematology laboratory
if necessary;
e) identification of partial D: RhD-positive (in which case the donor should be
clearly notified of this phenotypic particularity).
SI
For the search for partial D and weak D, it may be useful to use specific kits
containing mixtures of IgG and IgM monoclonal antibodies directed against the
different epitopes of the D antigen, which enable most known partial D to be
identified and weak D to be confirmed.
©
Any partial D phenotype established using serological methods should be
confirmed by molecular tests.
157
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
E.3.3 ABO AND RhD TYPING: PATIENTS
E.3.3.1 For unequivocally identified patients who have already
been typed for the ABO and RhD blood group systems at the
BE, RBCs shall be tested to ascertain their ABO blood group
using at least the anti-A, anti-B and anti-D reagents.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
Se
rv
iz
i
E.3.3.2 For patients who have not already been typed at the BE:
- the ABO blood group shall be determined on RBCs using
the anti-A, anti-B and anti-A,B reagents;
- the ABO blood group shall be determined in serum/
plasma using at least A1 and B erythrocytes
- RhD typing shall be performed using two different
anti-D reagents of documented sensitivity, deriving from
different clones in the case of both being monoclonal.
E.3.3.1 For unequivocally identified patients who have already been typed
for the ABO and RhD blood group systems at the BE, RBCs shall be
tested to ascertain their ABO blood group using at least the anti-A,
anti-B and anti-D reagents.
M
TI
RhD typing shall be conducted using an anti-D reagent of documented sensitivity,
that preferably does not identify partial DVI.
©
SI
E.3.3.2 For patients who have not already been typed at the BE:
- the ABO blood group shall be determined on RBCs using the
anti-A, anti-B and anti-A,B reagents;
- the ABO blood group shall be determined in serum/plasma
using at least A1 and B erythrocytes;
- RhD typing shall be performed using two different anti-D
reagents of documented sensitivity, deriving from different
clones in the case of both being monoclonal.
For ABO blood group determination in serum/plasma, it may also be advisable to
use A2 and/or O erythrocytes, in order to identify weak phenotypes or antibodies
against ABH specificities.
RhD typing shall be done using two different anti-D reagents of documented
sensitivity (deriving from different clones in the case of both being monoclonal),
at least one of which should not identify partial DVI, in order to avoid erroneously
attributing the RhD-positive type to patients carrying the DVI partial variant, who
risk developing anti-D immunisation if they are transfused with RhD-positive red
blood cells.
158
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
For the purposes related to HDN prophylaxis, the search for weak D shall be
conducted in RhD-negative newborn with the indirect antiglobulin test, using an
anti-D reagent capable of identifying the partial DVI variant.
If the search for weak D conducted using the indirect antiglobulin test is positive,
the negativity of the direct antiglobulin test shall be systematically tested in
parallel.
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
The following criteria should also be adopted for RHD typing:
a) positivity to both the two anti-D reagents: RhD-positive;
b) negativity to both the two anti-D reagents: RhD-negative;
c) negativity to both the two anti-D reagents and negativity in the search for
weak D: RhD-negative;
d) negativity to both the two anti-D reagents and positivity in any search for
weak D: weak D (in which case the patient should be clearly notified of this
phenotypic particularity);
e) positivity to only one anti-D reagent and negativity/positivity in any search for
weak D: the RhD-positive type is assumed as a “precautionary” measure; such
cases of inconsistency should be further analysed, preferably also by searching
for the RhD partial variants and/or by determining the RhD type using genome
amplification methods, relying on a reference immunohaematology laboratory
if necessary;
f) identification of partial D: RhD-negative (in which case the patient should be
clearly notified of this phenotypic particularity).
For the search for partial D and weak D, it may be useful to use specific kits
containing mixtures of IgG and IgM monoclonal antibodies directed against the
different epitopes of the D antigen, which enable most known partial D to be
identified and weak D to be confirmed.
SI
Any partial D phenotype established using serological methods should be
confirmed by molecular tests.
E.3.4 SCREENING FOR IRREGULAR ERYTHROCYTE ANTIBODIES AND
CROSSMATCHING
©
E.3.4.1 Irregular antibody screening (IAS) shall be done using an
analytical procedure validated in terms of its capacity to
identify an anti-D control serum with a low antibody titre
as unequivocally positive.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
E.3.4.1 Irregular antibody screening (IAS) shall be done using an analytical
procedure validated in terms of its capacity to identify an anti-D
control serum with a low antibody titre as unequivocally positive.
159
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
The concentration of the anti-D control serum used to validate the analytical procedure
should be ≤ 0.5 IU/ml for the tests to conduct on donors and ≤ 0.1 IU/ml for the
tests to conduct on patients. The concentrations of anti-D control serums should be
checked against D-heterozygotic RBCs (R1r, R2r).
Se
rv
iz
i
For IQC purposes, an anti-D control serum with a concentration of ≤ 0.1 IU/ml
should be used systematically to verify the sensitivity of the test conducted on
patients, and an anti-D control serum with a concentration of ≤ 0.5 IU/ml should
be used to verify the sensitivity of the test performed on donors.
In addition, to further confirm tests’ sensitivity and the integrity of test
erythrocytes’ antigen expression during storage, it may be useful to periodically
check erythrocyte panels by means of control sera containing a low titres of
clinically significant antibodies against different D antigen specificities.
As a basic test, irregular antibody screening (IAS) shall be conducted using the
indirect antiglobulin method, using panels of test erythrocytes consisting of RBCs
from at least two individuals representing at least the following antigens: C, c, D,
E, e, K, k, Fya, Fyb, Jka, Jkb, S, s, M, N, P1, Lea, Leb, preferably with “double dose”
expression of antigens Fya, Fyb, Jka, Jkb, S, s, M.
For investigations on all types of patients, panels of erythrocytes composed of
at least three cells should be used, including a broader array of antigens and as
many antigens expressed in “double dose” as possible.
M
TI
Similarly, crossmatching tests shall be conducted using an analytical procedure
validated in terms of its capacity to identify an anti-D control serum with an
antibody titre ≤ 0.1 IU/ml as unequivocally positive.
SI
As a basic test, crossmatching shall be performed by the indirect antiglobulin
test method, using suitable dilutions for the donor’s RBCs, obtained exclusively
from a segment of the sampling tube on the blood unit concerned, and preferably
conducted using low ionic strength solutions.
E.3.5 IDENTIFICATION OF IRREGULAR ERYTHROCYTE ANTIBODIES
©
E.3.5.1 Irregular erythrocyte antibodies shall be identified using a
validated analytical procedure.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
E.3.5.1 Irregular erythrocyte antibodies shall be identified using a validated
analytical procedure.
Irregular erythrocyte antibodies shall be identified by means of a validated
analytical procedure.
For a definition of the term “Validation”, see the Introduction to the Transfusion
Medicine Standards, Definitions.
160
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
iz
i
The panels of test erythrocytes should consist of RBCs from at least eight
individuals and guarantee the following characteristics:
a) they represent at least the following antigens: C, Cw, c, D, E, e, K, k, Kpa, Fya,
Fyb, Jka, Jkb, S, s, Lea, Leb, M, N, P1, Lua;
b) they contain at least one R1R1 cell and one R1WR1 cell that, in combination,
express the following antigens: K, k, Fya, Fyb, Jka, Jkb, S, s;
c) they contain at least one R2R2, one r3r and one r2r cell;
d) they contain at least three cells with no C, E, or D antigens, one of which is
K-positive and, taken together, they express a “double dose” of the antigens:
k, Fya, Fyb, Jka, Jkb, S, s, M.
Se
rv
As a baseline test, the irregular erythrocyte antibodies should be identified by
means of the same method as was used to screen for their presence.
M
TI
The following recommendations should also be adopted:
a) the use of panels of RBCs treated with enzymes if antibodies are found weakly
expressed, or there are mixtures of antibodies;
b) serum/plasma tests against autologous RBCs;
c) typing the patient’s RBCs to ensure that they do not contain any of the antigens
against which antibody specificities have been identified;
d) tests in saline solution at room temperature, where useful/advisable;
e) an anti-D control serum with a concentration of ≤ 0.1 IU/ml should be used
systematically to verify the tests’ sensitivity. In addition, to further confirm the
tests’ sensitivity and the integrity of the test erythrocytes’ antigen expression
during storage, it may be useful to periodically check erythrocyte panels by
means of control sera containing low titres of clinically significant antibodies
against different D antigen specificities.
E.3.6 IMMUNOHAEMATOLOGICAL
INVESTIGATIONS
HAEMOLYTIC DISEASE OF THE NEWBORN
ON
THE
©
SI
E.3.6.1 The BE shall adopt specific procedures for the
immunohaematological investigations aimed at the
diagnosis and prevention of the haemolytic disease of the
newborn (HDN), according to the case series observed
and the specialisation of the mother and infant services
referring to the BE.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
E.3.6.1 The BE shall adopt specific procedures for the immunohaematological
investigations aimed at the diagnosis and prevention of the
haemolytic disease of the newborn (HDN), according to the case
series observed and the specialisation of the mother and infant
services referring to the BE.
161
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
Se
rv
iz
i
For immunohaematological investigations designed to diagnose and prevent HDN,
depending on the case series observed and the specialisation of the referring
mother and infant services, the BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures
designed to define and govern:
a) screening investigations and further diagnostic tests required;
b) the diagnostic methods to use;
c) the behaviour to adopt if patients suffering from HDN need transfusions;
d) methods for interacting with physicians caring for patients involved, particularly
in an advisory role;
e) any reliance on other immunohaematology laboratories for investigations not
conducted at the BE, and/or for cases difficult to solve;
f) the recording of anti-D immunoprophylaxis in accordance with current
legislation.
The Raccomandazioni per la gestione della Malattia Emolitica del Neonato
[Recommendations for the management of the haemolytic disease of the newborn]
prepared by the SIMTI in co-operation with the Italian society of gynaecology and
obstetrics (SIGO) should be adopted.
E.3.7 STUDY OF AUTOIMMUNE HAEMOLYTIC DISORDERS
M
TI
E.3.7.1 The
BE
shall
adopt
specific
procedures
for
immunohaematological investigations aimed at the study
of autoimmune haemolytic disorders (AHD), according to
the frequency and complexity of the cases observed.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
SI
E.3.7.1 The BE shall adopt specific procedures for immunohaematological
investigations aimed at the studying of autoimmune haemolytic
disorders (AHD), according to the frequency and complexity of the
cases observed.
©
Immunohaematological investigations in patients with autoimmune haemolytic
disorders (AHD) shall focus on correctly determining their ABO and Rh phenotype,
and ascertaining any concomitant presence of erythrocyte allo-antibodies and
autoantibodies.
According to the frequency and complexity of the cases observed, for
immunohaematological investigations aimed at the study of AHD, the BE shall
prepare and adopt specific procedures designed to govern:
a) the necessary screening investigations and further diagnostic tests (particularly
relating to the absorption-elution techniques for identifying the concomitant
presence of erythrocyte allo-antibodies and autoantibodies);
b) the diagnostic methods used;
c) the behaviour to adopt for patients suffering from AHD who need transfusions,
particularly concerning emergency situations;
d) the methods for interacting with physicians taking care of AHD patients,
162
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
particularly in an advisory role;
e) any reliance on other immunohaematology laboratories for investigations not
conducted at the BE, and/or for cases difficult to solve.
E.4 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR MICROBIOLOGICAL TESTS PERFORMED
FOR THE QUALIFICATION OF ALLOGENEIC BLOOD COMPONENTS
iz
i
E.4.1 The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods, control
measures and decision algorithms for managing microbiological
tests performed for the qualification of allogeneic blood
components.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods, control
measures and decision algorithms for managing microbiological tests
performed for the qualification of allogeneic blood components.
M
TI
E.4.1
Se
rv
E.4.1.1 The BE shall define methods for the analytical sessions and
for managing the results of microbiological tests performed
for the qualification of allogeneic blood components
designed to guarantee blood component safety.
The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods, control measures
and decision algorithms for managing microbiological tests performed for the
qualification of allogeneic blood components.
SI
In addition to ensuring compliance with current legislation, these working methods,
control measures and decision algorithms should comply with the standards for
the biological qualification of blood components defined in the latest edition of
the Guide to the preparation, use and quality assurance of blood components
(EDQM - European Directorate for the Quality of Medicines & Healthcare, Council
of Europe).
©
E.4.1.1 The BE shall define methods for the analytical sessions and for
managing the results of microbiological tests performed for the
qualification of allogeneic blood components designed to guarantee
blood component safety.
The methods used in the analytical sessions and for managing the results of
microbiological tests for the qualification of allogeneic blood components shall
be defined so as to guarantee the safety of blood components. For this purpose,
highly sensitive CE-marked tests shall be adopted that are specifically intended for
the diagnostic objectives envisaged.
163
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
For immunometric/serological HBV, HCV and HIV1-2 screening tests, grey zones
below the cut-off should be defined so as to intercept signals of reactivity
potentially associated with very low concentrations of the analyte. The results
coming within these grey zones shall be considered reactive for the purposes of
biological qualification.
iz
i
For immunometric and molecular HBV, HCV and HIV1-2 screening tests, in
addition to the control measures established for the methods, at least one positive
control sample (run control) not included in the kit and not coming from the
same manufacturer, provided by authorised bodies/regulators or validated against
their certified standards, should be used for each test to confirm the diagnostic
systems’ capacity to reproducibly identify weak analytic signals.
Se
rv
Run controls should be used as additional elements for validating single analytical
series/runs.
The BE shall adopt algorithms for managing initially reactive, repeatedly reactive
and confirmed positive samples in relation both to the donation and to the donor,
in accordance with current legislation.
M
TI
Where the BE decides to extend the set of microbiological tests for biological
qualification purposes in the light of specific local epidemiological situations,
programs/procedures for donors from geographical areas at higher risk of
transmissible diseases, additional screening programs for particular categories of
blood components, etc., specific criteria shall be defined for managing the test
profiles and the acceptability of results.
E.5 S P E C I F I C S T A N D A R D S F O R L E U K O C Y T E A N D P L A T E L E T
IMMUNOHAEMATOLOGY TESTS
SI
For the immunogenetic, serological and molecular tests for HLA typing of donors
and patients, reference should be made to the International Standards of the
European Federation for Immunogenetics (EFI).
©
E.5.1 The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods, control
measures and decision algorithms for managing leukocyte and
platelet immunohaematology tests.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
E.5.1
The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods, control
measures and decision algorithms for managing leukocyte and platelet
immunohaematology tests.
The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods, control measures and
decision algorithms for managing leukocyte and platelet immunohaematology
tests.
164
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
Se
rv
iz
i
The following recommendations should be followed:
a) systems/reagents CE-marked for the specific diagnostic purposes should be
adopted, if available;
b) for antigen typing, positive and negative control samples should be used at
every analytical session;
c) in antibody screening/identification:
- cells or cell panels suitable for identifying the fullest possible quota of
clinically significant antibodies should be used;
- positive and negative control sera should be systematically used at every
analytical session;
d) the nomenclature internationally accepted or defined at specific consensus
conferences should be adopted (HPA for platelets, HNA for neutrophil
granulocytes);
e) differentiated diagnostic procedures should be defined for donors and patients,
where necessary and applicable.
Control samples prepared using international reference standards should be
used, where available, to certify to the sensitivity of the antibody screening/
identification methods.
E.6 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR EXTEMPORANEOUS PREDONATION
DIAGNOSTIC TESTS
M
TI
E.6.1 The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods for
managing any extemporaneous diagnostic tests conducted
prior to a donation.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods for managing
any extemporaneous diagnostic tests conducted prior to a donation.
SI
E.6.1
©
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific working methods for managing
extemporaneous diagnostic tests conducted prior to a donation (either at
the BE or at blood collection units referring thereto) as regards the analytical
instrumentation available, the methods for guaranteeing the availability of backup
equipment and the reagents to use, the control measures to implement and the
management of the results.
E.7 PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
To constantly monitor the quality of the products-services provided and the
compliance of the processes implemented with the established standards, the BE
shall guarantee the monitoring of at least the indicators listed in the following table.
For the general criteria for planning quality monitoring activities, see Section AGeneral organisational requirements, Ch. A.7.1 Quality monitoring.
165
Reference
chapter:
Section E
E.2.2
E.2.5
E.2.5
E.3
E.3
E.4
E.4
N°
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
©
166
E.4.1.1
E.4.1.1
E.3.3
E.3.2
E.2.5.1
E.2.5.1
E.2.2.1.1
Reference
standard:
Section E
No. of nonconformities in requests
or samples out of No. of requests
[data stratified at least by requesting
department and type of nonconformity]
Conformity of requests
for laboratory tests and
samples to established
specifications
Performance of
microbiological tests
for the qualification
of allogeneic blood
components
Performance of
microbiological tests
for the qualification
of allogeneic blood
components
Irregular antibody
screening
Blood group typing
External quality
assessment (EQA)
External quality
assessment (EQA)
Se
rv
No. of run controls found in compliance
with established specifications out of No.
of run controls tested [data stratified by
type of test]
No. of initially reactive tests
not confirmed in 2 subsequent
determinations out of No. of initially
reactive tests [data stratified by type of
test]
Capacity of diagnostic
systems to identify
weak analytical signals
reproducibly
Specificity of immunometric
serological screening tests
for HbsAg, Anti-HCV, AntiHIV1-2, Lue serology
iz
i
No. of antibodies identified out of No. of
screening tests found positive
No. of discrepancies in serum/cell tests
out of No. of ABO typing tests conducted
No. of errors-discrepancies in EQA
exercises out of No. of EQA exercises
conducted [data stratified by test(s)
submitted to EQA]
Performance of analytical
systems and processes used
for screening
Performance of analytical
systems and processes used
for ABO blood group typing
Performance of analytical
systems and processes
Level of participation in EQA
programs
Number of EQA programs
activated/No. of tests managed [data
stratified by: immunohaematological
tests, immunometric/molecular tests for
biological qualification,
serological/molecular tissue typing tests]
Process control indicator
Characteristic to monitor
M
TI
SI
Assessing requests
for laboratory
tests and related
biological samples
Activity
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
Reference
chapter:
Section E
E.4
E.4
N°
8
9
©
E.4.1.1
E.4.1.1
Reference
standard:
Section E
Performance of
microbiological tests
for the qualification
of allogeneic blood
components
No. of invalid analytical sessions/runs
out of No. of analytical sessions/runs
conducted
Performance of analytical
systems and processes used
in molecular HCV, HIV, HBV
screening tests
iz
i
No. of repeatedly reactive tests found
negative on confirmation tests out of
No. of repeatedly reactive tests [data
stratified by type of test]
Specificity of immunometric
serological screening tests
for HbsAg, Anti-HCV,
Anti-HIV1-2, Lue serology
Se
rv
Process control indicator
Characteristic to monitor
M
TI
SI
Performance of
microbiological tests
for the qualification
of allogeneic blood
components
Activity
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities
2nd Edition
167
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section F - Autologous blood transfusion
2nd Edition
©
SI
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
168
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section F - Autologous blood transfusion
2nd Edition
SECTION F
AUTOLOGOUS BLOOD TRANSFUSION
..............................................................................................
Se
rv
F.1 INFORMATION FOR USERS
iz
i
CONTENTS
170
F.2 MANAGEMENT OF PRE-OPERATIVE AUTOLOGOUS
BLOOD DONATION PROGRAMMES ........................................................................... 171
F.3 MANAGEMENT OF OTHER AUTOLOGOUS
BLOOD TRANSFUSION ACTIVITIES ........................................................................ 178
.............................................................................
179
©
SI
M
TI
F.4 PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
169
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section F - Autologous blood transfusion
2nd Edition
F.1 INFORMATION FOR USERS
F.1.1 The BE shall define and formalise its autologous blood
transfusion services and provide interested parties with
adequate information on the methods and timing for accessing
said services.
The BE shall define and formalise its autologous blood transfusion
services, and provide interested parties with adequate information on
the methods and timing for accessing said services.
Se
rv
F.1.1
iz
i
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall define, formalise and make available to users (specialist physicians,
general practitioners, patients) a list of the autologous blood transfusion services
it provides for inpatients and outpatients, indicating:
a) the methods and timing for accessing the services and the single services
provided;
b) any waiting times;
c) the clinician responsible for the activities.
M
TI
Documents containing the above-described information may be part of general
informative material for users (e.g. a Hospital or NHS Service Charter) issued by
the organisation to which the BE refers.
It may be useful to provide informative documents (prepared in cooperation with
the clinicians involved) in hospital wards and outpatient clinics to inform patients
about the opportunity, where appropriate, to have autologous blood transfusion
treatments to avoid/reduce the need for homologous blood transfusions.
©
SI
The BE shall serve in a clinical advisory role in response to specific requests for
autologous blood transfusion services for inpatients and outpatients, establishing
the necessary cooperative relations with the physicians requesting said services.
170
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section F - Autologous blood transfusion
2nd Edition
F.2 MANAGEMENT OF PRE-OPERATIVE AUTOLOGOUS BLOOD DONATION
PROGRAMMES
F.2.1 The BE shall prepare specific procedures for defining and
implementing pre-operative autologous blood donations by
arrangement with the managers of the healthcare services
involved.
These procedures shall define:
iz
i
F.2.1.1 The indications for autologous transfusion and the clinical
suitability and patient eligibility criteria for pre-operative
autologous blood donation programmes.
Se
rv
F.2.1.2 The responsibilities, prerequisites and working methods
for submitting requests to the BE.
F.2.2 The BE shall prepare specific procedures for managing its
activities relating to pre-operative autologous blood donation
programmes.
These procedures shall define:
F.2.2.1 The methods and criteria for assessing the appropriateness
of requests.
M
TI
F.2.2.2 The type of information required and the methods for
obtaining it in order to judge a patient’s clinical suitability
and eligibility for a pre-operative autologous blood donation
programme.
F.2.2.3 Criteria for assessing a patient’s clinical suitability for the
treatment.
SI
F.2.2.4 Specific working methods for receiving patients and
providing them with information on the pre-operative
autologous blood donation programme.
F.2.2.5 Specific working methods for providing patient care and for
completing the autologous blood collection.
©
F.2.2.6 Laboratory tests to conduct for each autologous blood unit
and methods for managing blood units found positive at
one or more of the screening tests required by law.
F.2.2.7 Methods for recording information on patients and the
activities conducted, as well as any adverse reactions or
events.
F.2.2.8 Working methods to adopt for the labelling, storage,
delivery and transportation of autologous blood units.
171
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section F - Autologous blood transfusion
2nd Edition
F.2.2.9 Specific working methods for transferring autologous blood
units to other BEs and for acquiring autologous blood units
from other BE.
F.2.3 The BE shall guarantee the periodic assessment of its preoperative autologous blood donation activities.
The BE shall prepare specific procedures for defining and implementing
pre-operative autologous blood donations by arrangement with the
managers of the healthcare services involved.
Se
rv
F.2.1
iz
i
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall prepare specific procedures for defining and implementing preoperative autologous blood donation programmes by arrangement with the
managers of the healthcare areas involved, in relation to the latter’s clinical needs
and with reference to the Raccomandazioni SIMTI sulla trasfusione perioperatoria
[SIMTI Recommendations on Peri-operative Transfusions].
SI
M
TI
In accordance with current legislation, hospital transfusion committees shall be
created and made fully operational at health care organisations with one or more
BE(s). These committees shall create the institutional opportunity for sharing
and adopting procedures, guidelines and programmes relating to the transfusion
process, promoting the ongoing professional development and training of all
individuals involved in the transfusion process, and systematically auditing the
effective application of the procedures adopted to ensure the safety of the process
and the appropriateness of the transfusion therapies administered.
The procedures for defining and implementing pre-operative autologous blood
donation programmes should therefore be shared and adopted within the context
of the one or more committees on which the BE is institutionally required to serve.
The procedures should be circulated by means of specific provisions issued by the
hospital management.
©
Where “practical guidelines” for users are adopted (see Standard D.1.1), they
should contain a brief summary of the procedures for defining and implementing
autologous transfusion programmes based on pre-operative autologous blood
donations.
The procedures shall define:
F.2.1.1
172
The indications for autologous transfusion and the clinical suitability
and patient eligibility criteria for pre-operative autologous blood
donation programmes.
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section F - Autologous blood transfusion
2nd Edition
With reference to the Raccomandazioni SIMTI sulla trasfusione perioperatoria,
the BE shall define the indications for autologous transfusion and the clinical
suitability and eligibility criteria for including patients in pre-operative autologous
blood donation programmes related to the elective surgery activities conducted in
the areas served by the BE.
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
After ensuring that patients have no clinical contraindications to the treatment,
the definition of pre-operative autologous blood donation programmes shall take
into account:
a) the type of surgery and predicted corresponding peri-operative blood loss, also
in relation to the surgical technique used and the performance of the various
surgical teams;
b) the need to assess the real eligibility of patients with basal Hb values tending
towards the upper limit of normal, bearing in mind that it is unnecessary to
perform transfusions (and autologous blood collections are consequently not
indicated) if a patient’s Hb has basal values that, despite peri-operative blood
losses, will predictably maintain a stable postoperative value higher than 10-11
g/dL;
c) the need to have sufficient time intervals between the programmed collections,
and between the last collection and the surgical procedure to enable a
satisfactory recovery of the RBC mass bled;
d) the possible need to support the patient’s erythropoietic compensation by
administering iron preparations and, where appropriate, accelerating the
process by administering erythropoietin.
SI
Without prejudice to the specific needs of selected cases, criteria based on
evidence of a significant added benefit shall be defined for cases where:
a) autologous whole blood units are fractionated to produce red blood cells and
fresh frozen plasma (a treatment that is not recommended due to the related
risk of technical incidents and because it is impossible to obtain therapeutic
doses of autologous fresh frozen plasma);
b) autologous blood collections are performed using apheretic methods.
F.2.1.2
The responsibilities, prerequisites and working methods for
submitting requests to the BE.
©
Responsibilities, prerequisites and working methods shall be established for
requests that the BE define and implement a pre-operative autologous blood
donation programme, including the forms to be used for this purpose.
Requests for a pre-operative autologous blood donation programme shall be
formulated by a physician belonging to the healthcare area of the patient due to
undergo surgery.
It shall be clearly stated that the final decision regarding the patient’s clinical
suitability and eligibility, the quantity of blood to collect and the details of the
programme, lies with the transfusion medicine physician.
173
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section F - Autologous blood transfusion
2nd Edition
To make the process as efficient as possible and avoid requests being inadequately
documented, the following prerequisites shall be defined:
a) information that the physician requesting the programme must give to the
patient;
b) clinical documentation and diagnostic test results needed to assess the patient’s
clinical suitability and eligibility for the treatment;
c) responsibilities and methods for collecting the patient’s informed consent.
iz
i
Specific forms should be prepared for submitting requests for pre-operative
autologous blood donation programmes, where the physician requesting the
service provides the information needed to assess the appropriateness of the
request and the patient’s clinical suitability and eligibility.
F.2.2
Se
rv
For the management of requests from structures outside the hospital or NHS
management to which the BE refers, see Standard F.2.2.9.
The BE shall prepare specific procedures for managing its activities
relating to pre-operative autologous blood donation programmes.
Specific procedures shall be prepared for managing activities involved in preoperative autologous blood donation programmes conducted at the BE.
F.2.2.1
M
TI
These procedures shall define:
The methods and criteria for assessing the appropriateness of
requests.
SI
The BE shall guarantee the systematic assessment of the appropriateness of
requests for pre-operative autologous blood donation programmes (also in the
light of the contents of Standard F.2.1.1), establishing the necessary cooperative
relations with the physicians making said requests.
The physician at the BE responsible for assessing the request shall notify the
requesting physician of any inappropriate aspects of the request, clearly explaining
and justifying the reasons for said opinion.
©
Activities for evaluating the appropriateness of requests shall be documented.
F.2.2.2
The type of information required and the methods for obtaining
it in order to judge a patient’s clinical suitability and eligibility
for a pre-operative autologous blood donation programme.
The BE shall define the information it needs to judge a patient’s clinical suitability
and eligibility for a pre-operative autologous blood donation programme and the
corresponding methods for presenting said information (e.g. by means of a specific
form, a review of clinical records collected in the hospital ward or prior to admission, or a
review of the anaesthesiologist’s risk assessment sheet for a given surgical procedure).
174
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
F.2.2.3
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section F - Autologous blood transfusion
2nd Edition
Criteria for assessing a patient’s clinical suitability for the
treatment.
The BE shall define the criteria for assessing a patient’s clinical suitability,
particularly concerning diseases of the cardiovascular apparatus that may
contraindicate the treatment, as well as criteria for the clinical assessment of the
bleeding risk relating to the type of surgery and any prior haemorrhagic diathesis.
Specific working methods for receiving patients and providing them
with information on the pre-operative autologous blood donation
programme.
iz
i
F.2.2.4
Specific working methods for providing patient care and for
completing the autologous blood collection.
SI
F.2.2.5
M
TI
Se
rv
The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods relating to:
a) patient acceptance;
b) information for patients about the pre-operative autologous blood donation
programme, particularly as regards:
- the meaning of the informed consent required;
- the meaning of the medical examination;
- the meaning of the clinical history;
- the meaning of the laboratory tests conducted, including screening for HIV,
HCV and HBsAg;
- the autologous blood donation procedure and the related risks and benefits;
- the possibility of being denied said procedure if any risk factors are identified;
- the possible use, where necessary, of allogeneic transfusions if the
autologous blood units prove insufficient;
- the risk of the blood units being lost due to technical incidents or for clinical
reasons (e.g. the presence of cold agglutinins);
- the elimination of unused autologous blood units when they expire, since
they cannot be used for other patients.
©
The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods for providing patient care
and performing autologous blood collections, particularly as concerns:
a) methods for performing the collection (see Section B - Collection of blood and
blood components, Ch. B.3 Whole blood collection and apheresis);
b) the treatment of any low-volume collections (e.g. in adult patients of low body
weight and in paediatric patients), in which the volume of anticoagulant has to
be adjusted;
c) the identification of blood units at the time of their collection, including the
patient’s and physician’s signatures on the corresponding label;
d) patient care measures;
e) the identification and treatment of any adverse reactions.
175
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
F.2.2.6
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section F - Autologous blood transfusion
2nd Edition
Laboratory tests to conduct for each autologous blood unit and
methods for managing blood units found positive at one or more of
the screening tests required by law.
For each autologous blood unit, the BE shall guarantee the performance of the
laboratory tests required by current legislation.
iz
i
For the Standards to guarantee relating to the management of the tests, see
Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities.
F.2.2.7
Se
rv
The BE shall also guarantee the definition of specific working methods for handling
autologous blood units found positive at one of or more screening tests.
Methods for recording information on patients and the activities
conducted, as well as any adverse reactions or events.
The BE shall define methods and tools for recording information relating to the
patient and the activities conducted, also as concerns the records to include in the
patient’s clinical files.
For this purpose, the BE may prepare a specific file/datasheet in which to include
the necessary records.
SI
M
TI
In particular, the following minimum details shall be recorded, or associated with
the records:
a) the patient’s demographic and nosological data;
b) the diagnosis and the type and date of the planned surgical procedure;
c) essential medical history and clinical signs;
d) informed consent to the pre-operative autologous blood donation programme;
e) judgement of the patient’s clinical suitability/unsuitability for the treatment
and eligibility for the programme;
f) the pre-operative autologous blood donation programme;
g) the blood units collected, with the related quantities and identification codes;
h) any infusion/pharmacological support treatments administered;
i) any adverse reactions that occurred and their treatment.
©
The records should enable:
a) a global synopsis of the programme implemented and of the tests performed
each time the patient attended;
b) the information needed to enable an assessment of the appropriateness of the
programme implemented.
The records shall be preserved in accordance with current legislation.
Without prejudice to the need to obtain and preserve the documentation relating
to the programmes implemented on printed paper if it cannot be managed
otherwise, the records should be managed in electronic format.
176
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section F - Autologous blood transfusion
2nd Edition
Procedures shall be prepared and circulated for notifying the Regional Blood
Coordinating Centres and the National Blood Centre of all severe adverse reactions
and incidents relating to the blood collections with reference to the applicable
national and regional directives and using the national blood IT system - SISTRA
(see Section A - General organisational requirements, Ch. A.8 Reporting).
Working methods to adopt for the labelling, storage, delivery and
transportation of autologous blood units.
iz
i
F.2.2.8
Se
rv
The BE shall guarantee that the activities for the labelling (particularly concerning
the specific recommendations to include on the final labels), storage, delivery and
transportation of autologous blood units are conducted in accordance with current
legislation.
As in the case of allogeneic blood units, the BE shall systematically receive
certificates testifying to the final destination of blood units not returned to the
BE or, in the case of returns, of their storage in accordance with the established
procedures.
Specific working methods for transferring autologous blood units
to other BEs and for acquiring autologous blood units from other
BE.
M
TI
F.2.2.9
SI
In cases where:
a) the BE receives written requests for pre-operative autologous blood donation
programmes for patients due to undergo surgery at structures outside the
organisation to which the BE refers (including accredited private hospitals that
have agreements with the BE);
b) the BE has to receive autologous blood units collected at a BE outside the
organisation to which the BE refers, and destined for patients due to undergo
surgery in the healthcare area served by the BE,
©
methods and means shall be defined for transferring/receiving and documenting
the information needed to guarantee the appropriateness and safety of the preoperative autologous blood donation programmes, the product specifications
established by current legislation and the safety of the modes of delivery and
transportation of the autologous blood units collected.
F.2.3
The BE shall guarantee the periodic assessment of its pre-operative
autologous blood donation activities.
The BE shall guarantee the periodic assessment of its pre-operative autologous
blood donation activities in order to monitor its compliance with the established
appropriateness criteria (see Standard F.2.1.1 and Ch. F.4 in this Section, Process
control indicators).
177
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section F - Autologous blood transfusion
2nd Edition
F.3 MANAGEMENT OF OTHER ACTIVITIES
F.3.1 The BE shall ensure the coordination and organisation of
pre-operative acute normovolemic haemodilution and intraand post-operative autologous blood salvage.
The BE shall ensure the coordination and organisation of pre-operative
acute normovolemic haemodilution and intra- and post-operative
autologous blood salvage.
Se
rv
F.3.1
iz
i
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
With reference to current standards and the Raccomandazioni SIMTI sulla
trasfusione perioperatoria, the BE shall be responsible for coordinating and
organising pre-operative acute normovolemic haemodilution and intra- and
post-operative retrieval activities. The responsibility for managing these
activities generally lies with anaesthetists for pre-operative normovolemic
haemodilution and intra-operative blood salvage, and with surgeons and/or
anaesthetists for post-operative blood salvage.
©
SI
M
TI
The coordination and organisation of autologous blood transfusion activities
(other than the pre-operative autologous blood donation procedure) that are
conducted at by the BE by arrangement with the managers of the healthcare
areas concerned, should mainly consist of the following:
a) the definition of indications for the appropriate and safe use of these methods;
b) the definition and organisation of integrated autologous blood transfusion
programmes (e.g. pre-operative autologous blood donation and intra-and/or
post-operative blood salvage);
c) procedures for assessing the quality and safety of blood products deriving from
peri-operative blood salvage procedures (e.g. excessive coagulation factor
activation, excessive haemolysis, contamination from the surgical field);
d) technical contributions with a view to the controlled management of the
peri-operative blood salvage equipment and systems and the qualification
of the related suppliers;
e) the collection of essential data relating to the completed procedures, also
relying on reference persons from the patient care areas concerned;
f) the assessment of the appropriateness and, wherever possible, of the cost-benefit
ratio of the programmes implemented and treatments provided, to report to the
hospital transfusion committee(s) with a view to continuously improving the
quality and safety of these particular transfusion activities.
Concerning its coordination and organisation functions, attributed by current
legislation, the BE should periodically monitor the types and quantities of its preoperative autologous blood donation, pre-operative normovolemic haemodilution
and peri-operative blood salvage activities in the healthcare areas it serves in order
to contribute data for any national and/or regional scale investigations designed to
monitor the qualitative and quantitative dimensions of these activities.
178
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section F - Autologous blood transfusion
2nd Edition
F.4 PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
To constantly monitor the quality of the products-services provided and the
compliance of the processes implemented with the established standards, the BE
shall guarantee the monitoring of at least the indicators listed in the following
table.
©
SI
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
For the general criteria for planning quality monitoring activities, see Section AGeneral organisational requirements, Ch. A.7.1 Quality monitoring.
179
Reference
chapter:
Section F
F.2
F.2
F.2
F.2
N°
1
2
3
4
©
180
F.2.3
F.2.3
F.2.3
F.2.2.3
Reference
standard:
Section F
No. of patients on pre-operative
autologous blood donation
programmes also given homologous
blood out of No. of patients only
given autologous blood
Efficacy of pre-operative
Assessment of
pre-operative autologous autologous blood donation
blood donation
programmes
programmes
iz
i
No. of patients whose donated
autologous blood units are entirely or
partially unused out of No. of patients
on pre-operative autologous blood
donation programmes [data stratified
by type of surgical procedure]
Appropriateness of preAssessment of
pre-operative autologous operative autologous blood
donation programmes
blood donation
programmes
Se
rv
No. of autologous blood units
disposed of due to expiry out of No.
of autologous blood units collected
[data stratified by type of surgical
procedure]
No. of adverse reactions associated
with autologous blood unit collection
out of No. of autologous blood units
collected
Process control indicator
Appropriateness of preAssessment of
pre-operative autologous operative autologous blood
donation programmes
blood donation
programmes
a) Safety of autologous blood
collection
b) Adequacy of patients’
clinical selection
c) Adequacy of established
patient care procedures
Characteristic to monitor
M
TI
SI
Performance of
autologous blood
collections
Activity
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section F - Autologous blood transfusion
2nd Edition
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
SECTION G
Se
rv
CONTENTS
iz
i
HAEMOPOIETIC STEM CELL COLLECTION
AND OTHER CLINICAL ACTIVITIES
IN TRANSFUSION MEDICINE
G.1 LIST OF SERVICES AND INFORMATION FOR USERS
...........................
G.2 GENERAL CRITERIA FOR MANAGING
CLINICAL ACTIVITIES IN TRANSFUSION MEDICINE
.........................
182
183
G.3 SPECIFIC STANDARDS
FOR HAEMOPOIETIC STEM CELL (HSC)
COLLECTION ACTIVITIES .................................................................................................. 188
M
TI
G.3.1 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR COLLECTING BONE MARROW
AND PERIPHERAL HAEMOPOIETIC STEM CELLS .................................. 188
G.3.2 SPECIFIC STANDARDS
FOR UMBILICAL CORD BLOOD DONATION
..............................................
191
G.4 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR OTHER CLINICAL ACTIVITIES
IN TRANSFUSION MEDICINE ........................................................................................ 193
............................................................................
196
©
SI
G.5 PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
181
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
G.1 LIST OF SERVICES AND INFORMATION FOR USERS
G.1.1 The BE shall define and formalise the list of its clinical
transfusion medicine (TM) services, and provide interested
parties with adequate information on the methods and timing
for accessing said services.
iz
i
G.1.2 The BE shall guarantee its services in an advisory role on clinical
TM, in relation to the type of patient care services it provides
for inpatients and outpatients.
G.1.1
Se
rv
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall define and formalise the list of its clinical transfusion
medicine (TM) services and provide interested parties with adequate
information on the methods and timing for accessing said services.
M
TI
The BE shall define, formalise and make available to users (specialist physicians,
general practitioners, patients) a comprehensive list of all the clinical patient care
services it provides for inpatients and outpatients, indicating:
a) the methods for accessing the services and the single services available;
b) the methods for submitting requests for services;
c) any waiting times;
d) the services that can be requested urgently and the methods for making such
requests;
e) the TM specialist(s) responsible for the activities.
SI
Documents containing the above-described information may be part of general
informative material for users (e.g. a Hospital Service Charter) issued by the
organisation to which the BE refers.
The BE shall guarantee its services in an advisory role on clinical TM,
in relation to the type of patient care services it provides for inpatients
and outpatients.
©
G.1.2
The BE shall serve in a clinical advisory role in response to specific requests for
the patient care services it provides for inpatients and outpatients, establishing
the necessary cooperative relations with the physicians requesting said services.
182
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
G.2 GENERAL CRITERIA FOR MANAGING CLINICAL ACTIVITIES IN
TRANSFUSION MEDICINE
G.2.1 The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for managing
its TM-related clinical activities.
G.2.1.1 The BE shall guarantee the systematic recording of
information relating to its TM-related clinical services.
iz
i
G.2.1.2 The BE shall apply specific clinical guidelines for the most
common and/or critical diseases treated in the context of
its TM-related clinical activities.
Se
rv
G.2.1.3 The BE shall guarantee the systematic assessment of the
appropriateness of requests it receives for TM-related
clinical services.
G.2.1.4 The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods
for patient care and for providing TM-related therapeutic
treatments.
G.2.1.5 The BE shall guarantee the systematic assessment of the
efficacy of the treatments it provides.
M
TI
G.2.1.6 The BE shall prepare and adopt procedures and clinical
protocols to guarantee the proper and timely management
of any adverse reactions or adverse events in patients
receiving therapeutic treatments.
SI
G.2.1.6.1 The BE shall guarantee the systematic availability of
the devices and medicinal products needed to deal
with any adverse reactions or adverse events relating
to the therapeutic treatments it provides.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for managing its
TM-related clinical activities.
©
G.2.1
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures for managing its TM-related
clinical activities, particularly relating to:
a) the forms to use for requesting its services and the type of information needed
to assess said requests;
b) methods for booking the services and administrative issues for accessing the
services;
c) methods for managing the list of appointments;
d) methods for managing urgent requests;
e) methods for communicating with the physicians requesting these services;
f) the related clinical responsibilities.
183
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
Depending on the structural features of the environment available, the equipment,
the ability to provide patient care in the event of adverse reactions, and the
availability of medical, nursing and auxiliary personnel, the BE should define a
maximum daily number of appointments and the allowable clinical conditions for
admitting patients.
iz
i
G.2.1.1 The BE shall guarantee the systematic recording of information
relating to its TM-related clinical services.
Se
rv
The BE shall guarantee the systematic recording of information on the TM-related
clinical services it provides. For this purpose, also in the light of any instructions
received from the hospital or other NHS management to which the BE refers, the
BE shall prepare one or more clinical record forms to use in all cases of repetitive
services/treatment and for the taking into care of patients with particular specialist
needs.
In the case of occasional services not followed by monitoring, repetitive treatments
and/or the patient’s taking into care, it is sufficient to record the essential elements
relating to the service provided, including its outcome, instead of creating a clinical file.
Clinical files may consist of a set of all the patient’s records, on printed paper and/
or in electronic format.
SI
M
TI
The minimum elements that shall be recorded in, or associated with, the clinical
file are as follows:
a) the patient’s demographic and nosological details;
b) the diagnosis and related essential documentation;
c) informed consent to the therapeutic treatments;
d) informed consent to the treatment of personal details;
e) essential medical history and clinical findings;
f) clinical and diagnostic tests performed;
g) treatments provided;
h) any adverse reactions and their treatment.
©
The clinical file should enable:
a) a global synopsis of the procedures for each patient to enable an assessment
of the global clinical trend and any trends of specific parameters;
b) the recording of information to enable an assessment of the efficacy of the
treatments, where applicable.
The BE shall define responsibilities and working methods to guarantee that clinical
files are systematically and accurately compiled, kept up-to-date, assessed for the
completeness of the data and preserved; the BE shall also define the criteria for
accessing the clinical files.
Clinical files shall be preserved indefinitely.
Unless there is a need to obtain and preserve otherwise unavailable documentation
relating to the patient care services on printed paper, the clinical file should be
managed entirely in electronic format.
184
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
G.2.1.2 The BE shall apply specific clinical guidelines for the most common
and/or critical diseases treated in the context of its TM-related
clinical activities.
To define the clinical guidelines to adopt, the BE shall identify the most common
and/or most critical diseases treated in its clinical activities, and particularly the
most frequently implemented procedures/treatments.
iz
i
As an example, these may include particular diseases for which transfusion
treatments, infusion treatment with plasma-derived or recombinant medicinal
products, or iron-based preparations are indicated, and/or cell depletion and
plasma exchange treatments.
Se
rv
The guidelines shall:
a) be formulated on the strength of evidence-based criteria, referring to
authoritative and up-to-date bibliographical sources;
b) be shared within the BE;
c) be shared, where necessary, with the healthcare structures referring to the BE;
d) be easy to consult and effectively applicable.
The guidelines shall be circulated to all personnel involved.
M
TI
They shall also be reviewed periodically and whenever new scientific evidence
capable of significantly improving the diagnosis and treatment processes becomes
available.
G.2.1.3 The BE shall guarantee the systematic assessment of the
appropriateness of requests it receives for TM-related clinical
services.
SI
The BE shall guarantee the systematic assessment of the appropriateness of
requests for its services, establishing the necessary cooperative relations with the
physician making said requests.
©
The physicians at the BE responsible for assessing the request shall notify the
physicians making the request of any inappropriate aspects of the request, clearly
explaining and justifying the reasons for said opinion.
Activities for evaluating the appropriateness of requests shall be documented.
185
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
G.2.1.4 The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods for patient
care and for providing TM-related therapeutic treatments.
Se
rv
iz
i
The BE shall define and adopt specific working methods for providing patient care
and completing TM-related therapeutic treatments, particularly relating to:
a) patient acceptance;
b) patient care measures preliminary to providing treatments;
c) patient care measures needed during the treatment;
d) patient care measures needed after the treatment;
e) recognition and treatment of any adverse reactions;
f) management of blood components and transfusions;
g) the controlled, safe and appropriate management of equipment used to
provide treatments (e.g. equipment for therapeutic apheresis, infusion pumps)
and equipment used in the event of emergencies (e.g. defibrillator, vital
signs monitor, aspirator). See also Section A of the present Manual -General
organisational requirements, Ch. A.4.1 - Management of systems, equipment
and instruments;
h) procedures for therapeutic apheresis and for managing the related exchange
fluids;
i) management of medicinal products used for infusions, complementary or
adjuvant treatments and emergencies.
M
TI
G.2.1.5 The BE shall guarantee the systematic assessment of the efficacy
of the treatments it provides.
The BE shall guarantee the systematic assessment of the efficacy of its therapeutic
treatments, and provide evidence of said assessments.
SI
The efficacy of the treatments can be assessed during and after the treatment, for
the purpose of supporting decisions relating to:
a) changes to the treatment plan;
b) termination of the treatment plan;
c) the planning of alternative treatments.
©
The assessment criteria may vary, depending on the disease being treated, but
they are based substantially on:
a) monitoring objective parameters, e.g. laboratory and/or instrumental test
results recorded both after each treatment cycle and as retrospective/
prospective trends in the case of patients receiving long-term treatments;
b) focused clinical evaluations to identify improvements in the patient’s general
clinical conditions, any disappearance/reduction of specific signs and symptoms,
and any interrupted/delayed progression of the disease.
Where justified by the number of cases treated, the records on the efficacy of
therapeutic treatments should be the object of specific statistical analyses to
facilitate continuous improvements in the patient care processes and their
outcome.
186
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
G.2.1.6 The BE shall prepare and adopt procedures and clinical protocols
to guarantee the proper and timely management of any adverse
reactions or adverse events in patients receiving therapeutic
treatments.
iz
i
The BE shall define and adopt procedures and clinical protocols for the prevention,
prompt recognition and treatment of adverse reactions or adverse events occurring
in relation to the therapeutic treatments it provides, particularly focusing on the
most severe and most common.
These procedures and clinical protocols shall be circulated to all the personnel
involved.
Se
rv
The protocols shall also be revised periodically and whenever any new scientific
evidence capable of significantly improving the diagnosis and treatment processes
becomes available.
If it provides treatments carrying a significant risk of severe adverse reactions or
adverse events, the BE shall be in a condition to promptly provide a resuscitation
service.
M
TI
Activities for the identification and treatment of adverse reactions and adverse
events relating to therapeutic treatments involving the transfusion of blood
components shall be systematically recorded and notified, where applicable,
to the competent regional and national authorities (see Section D - Allocation
and distribution of allogeneic blood components, Ch. D.6 Haemovigilance for
recipients).
SI
Information on adverse reactions and adverse events should be the object of
specific statistical analyses designed to facilitate continuous improvements in
patient care processes and the safety of patients involved in TM-related clinical
activities.
©
G.2.1.6.1 The BE shall guarantee the systematic availability of
the devices and medicinal products needed to deal with
any adverse reactions or adverse events relating to the
therapeutic treatments it provides.
Depending on the types of service provided, on current legislation and on the
provisions issued by the organisation to which the BE refers, medicinal products
and devices for coping with any adverse reactions in patients or adverse events
shall be available and ready for use in the rooms used to administer therapeutic
treatments.
The equipment available shall be defined bearing in mind that some adverse
reactions or adverse events potentially associated with therapeutic treatments
routinely provided at BEs may develop into clinical emergencies.
187
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
The healthcare personnel involved shall be adequately trained and periodically
brought up to date on the management of specific adverse reactions, adverse
events and clinical emergencies that can occur in relation to the treatments
being provided (see Section A. General organisational requirements, Ch. A.3.1
Maintenance, development and assessment of the personnel’s skills).
Said personnel shall be qualified to provide basic life support (BLS).
iz
i
G.3 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR HAEMOPOIETIC STEM CELL (HSC)
COLLECTION ACTIVITIES
G.3.1 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR COLLECTING BONE MARROW AND
PERIPHERAL HAEMOPOIETIC STEM CELLS
Se
rv
G.3.1.1 The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures for the
recruitment and subsequent management of potential
unrelated allogeneic donors of peripheral and bone marrow
HSC.
G.3.1.2 By arrangement with the reference HSC transplant
centre(s), the BE shall define and adopt specific procedures
for the assessment and subsequent management of
potential related allogeneic donors of peripheral and bone
marrow HSC.
M
TI
G.3.1.3 The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures for
collecting HSC and lymphocytes from peripheral blood by
apheresis.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
SI
G.3.1.1 The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures for the
recruitment and subsequent management of potential unrelated
allogeneic donors of peripheral and bone marrow HSC.
©
The activities for the recruitment and subsequent management of potential
allogeneic unrelated donors of bone marrow and peripheral HSC shall be handled
exclusively in connection with the regional and national bodies responsible for
managing the corresponding registries.
For these activities, the BE with a HSC donor recruitment centre accredited by the
pertinent national authority (the IBMDR - Italian Bone Marrow Donors Registry)
shall define and adopt specific procedures complying with the criteria established
by said authority, as well as complying with the pertinent provisions of current
national and regional legislation.
188
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
Se
rv
iz
i
In particular, based on the role of the BE in the regional and national network
referring to the IBMDR, and the BE’s consequent connections with the structure
hierarchically immediately above and below it, organisational and working methods
shall be defined for the following activities:
a) information for potential donors;
b) assessment and enrolment of potential donors, and collection of their informed
consent to listing in the IBMDR’s national register;
c) management of donors enrolled in the IBMDR’s national register;
d) invitations and interviews for further assessments after enrolment;
e) immunogenetic selection of donors for the purposes of HSC donations;
f) assessment of the product specifications required by the HSC transplant centre
in relation to the donor’s specific characteristics;
g) clinical assessment of suitability for bone marrow or peripheral HSC donations;
h) obtainment of the donor’s specific informed consent to the donation;
i) collection of peripheral and bone marrow HSC.
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures to define the responsibilities
and working methods for managing the follow-up of unrelated allogeneic HSC
donors, tailored to the type of donation involved, including the management of
any adverse reactions and adverse events in the short, medium and long term
after the donation, in accordance with the provisions of the IBMDR standards and
with reference to the contents of Section B, Ch. B.5 Haemovigilance for donors.
M
TI
G.3.1.2 By arrangement with the reference HSC transplant centre(s), the
BE shall define and adopt specific procedures for the assessment
and subsequent management of potential related allogeneic donors
of peripheral and bone marrow HSC.
SI
For the management of potential related peripheral and bone marrow HSC donors,
the BE shall prepare specific procedures, shared with the reference HSC transplant
centre(s) and compliant with the SIMTI guidelines as well as the IBMDR standards,
to define the global clinical procedure for assessing the donors’ suitability for
donation and for obtaining their informed consent.
©
The related allogeneic donors’ suitability for bone marrow and peripheral HSC
donation procedures shall be assessed jointly by the physician at the BE and the
physician at the transplant centre, with reference to the criteria defined in the
above-mentioned procedures.
In agreement with the reference HSC transplant centre(s), the BE shall prepare
and adopt specific procedures that define the responsibilities and working methods
for managing the follow-up of related allogeneic HSC donors, depending on the
type of donation concerned, including the management of any adverse reactions or
adverse events in the short, medium and long term after the donation, preferably
in accordance with the provisions of the IBMDR standards and with reference to
the contents of Section B, Ch. B.5 Haemovigilance for donors.
189
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
G.3.1.3 The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures for collecting
HSC and lymphocytes from peripheral blood by apheresis.
The activities involved in the allogeneic or autologous collection of HSC and
lymphocytes from peripheral blood should be part of regional programmes for
supporting highly specialised onco-haematological activities.
iz
i
In agreement with the healthcare areas they serve, the BEs involved in collecting
allogeneic or autologous HSC and lymphocytes from peripheral blood shall define
specific procedures governing the organisational methods for managing these
activities as well as the reference clinical protocols for cell collection and storage.
Se
rv
The protocols for the collection of allogeneic HSC and lymphocytes from peripheral
blood shall comply with:
a) the IBMDR standards, where applicable, as concerns both the clinical aspects
and the organisational, logistic and documentation issues;
b) the guidelines for selecting donors of HSC and lymphocytes from peripheral
blood prepared by the SIMTI in co-operation with the principal scientific
organisations involved in the sector.
M
TI
Where hospital managements run accreditation schemes implemented in
accordance with international standards (e.g. JACIE), the organisational and
working procedures, the corresponding documentation and the clinical protocols
shall be aligned with said standards.
The final assessment of a donor’s suitability for allogeneic or autologous HSC and
lymphocyte collection from peripheral blood is up to the TM physician responsible
for apheretic activities at the BE.
SI
The predonation diagnostic investigations and final judgement of suitability for the
collection shall be documented and recorded in the donor’s clinical file.
The donor’s informed consent to the donation of HSC or lymphocytes from
peripheral blood shall be obtained prior to the collection, in compliance with
current legislation.
©
Informed consent shall be obtained for:
a) the destination of the peripheral HSC or lymphocytes from peripheral blood
(allogeneic or autologous therapeutic use, use in clinical experiments,
elimination if they are not used for the intended purpose);
b) if the donor’s identity is known to the recipient (siblings/parents), permission
to notify the recipient of any abnormal outcome of the scheduled tests;
c) administration of growth factors stimulating proliferation and mobilisation of
peripheral HSC.
The BE shall notify donors of the outcome of tests performed at the time of the
HSC and lymphocyte donation from peripheral blood, particularly concerning any
anomalous results emerging from the diagnostic investigations.
190
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
The BE shall prepare and adopt specific procedures defining the responsibilities
and working methods for managing any adverse reactions and adverse events
occurring during the procedures for collecting HSC and lymphocytes from
peripheral blood, in the light of the contents of Section B, Ch. B.5 Haemovigilance
for donors, and Section F, Ch. F.2 Management of pre-operative autologous blood
donation programmes, Standard F.2.2.7.
iz
i
The personnel collecting HSC and lymphocytes from peripheral blood shall
guarantee that a report containing the information on the collection required
by current legislation is sent to the processing/freezing laboratory and/or to the
recipient HSC transplant centre.
G.3.2 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR UMBILICAL CORD BLOOD DONATION
Se
rv
G.3.2.1 The BE shall guarantee an adequate level of information on
all aspects relating to the donation of cord blood.
G.3.2.2 The BE identified by a cord blood bank (CBB) as the support
structure operating within a healthcare organisation that
has a birth centre shall guarantee the systematic application
of the procedures issued by the CBB.
M
TI
G.3.2.3 The BE running a CBB within its organization shall define,
adopt and ensures the application of global management
procedures for the process of HSC donation from umbilical
cord blood.
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
SI
G.3.2.1 The BE shall guarantee an adequate level of information on all
aspects relating to the donation of cord blood.
©
Even if it operates within a healthcare organisation that does not have a birth
centre connected to a CBB, the BE shall guarantee citizens, and particularly
women who are potential donors, an adequate level of information on all aspects
of the donation of cord blood, also providing users with adequate explanatory and
promotional material. The proposed messages and related explanatory material
should be shared with the reference CBB(s), and with the obstetrics departments
and clinics operating in the area that the BE serves.
191
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
G.3.2.2 The BE identified by a cord blood bank (CBB) as the support
structure operating within a healthcare organisation that has
a birth centre shall guarantee the systematic application of the
procedures issued by the CBB.
iz
i
The BE identified by a CBB as the support structure operating within a healthcare
organisation that has a birth centre connected to the CBB, shall guarantee the
formal acceptance and systematic adoption of the procedures issued by the CBB
for the cord blood donation activities at birth centres.
Se
rv
With reference to clinical, organisational and logistic criteria defined by the reference
CBB, and in accordance with the relevant regional and national recommendations,
said BE shall guarantee the following activities:
a) action to actively provide information on and promote the donation of cord
blood;
b) enrolment of potential cord blood donors;
c) coordination and organisation of logistic matters relating to the donation of
cord blood;
d) transmission to the reference CBB of all documentation relating to donations,
including paediatric assessments prior to the newborn’s discharge;
e) co-operation with the CBB in the follow-up of mother and child at 6-12 months
after birth for final validation of donated cord HSC.
M
TI
G.3.2.3 The BE running a CBB within its organization shall define, adopt
and ensure the application of global management procedures for
the process of HSC donation from umbilical cord blood.
©
SI
The BE running a CBB within its organization on the basis of regional and national
plans shall define procedures for the activities of the bank, of other corresponding
BEs and birth centres. These procedures shall comply with national legislation,
with the recommendations and guidelines of the National Blood Centre and
National Transplant Centre, and with the IBMDR reference standards, and they
shall at least describe the following:
a) method for providing information, promoting donations and enrolling potential
donors;
b) methods for collecting cord blood and blood samples for biological qualification
tests;
c) criteria and methods for the identification and traceability of cord blood units
and the corresponding samples for the purposes of biological qualification and
quality control activities;
d) methods for the processing, identification, cryopreservation, validation and
storage of cord blood units;
e) criteria and methods for the follow-up of mother and child at 6-12 months for
the definitive validation of the donated cord blood unit;
f) methods for requesting and allocating, delivering and transporting cord blood
units, focusing particularly on reporting with the IBMDR, which is the sole
national centre for dealing with requests for cord blood units and for peripheral
and bone marrow HSC from unrelated donors.
192
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
The CBB shall adopt the established procedures and circulate them to the
subordinate structures (i.e. birth centres, other BEs at hospitals with birth
centres involved in the activities), ensuring their effective acceptance and timely
application.
G.4 SPECIFIC STANDARDS FOR OTHER CLINICAL ACTIVITIES IN
TRANSFUSION MEDICINE
iz
i
G.4.1 For transfusion and infusion treatments, the BE shall guarantee
the systematic application of its hospital management’s
guidelines, where available and applicable.
Se
rv
G.4.2 The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures for managing
therapeutic apheresis activities.
G.4.3 The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures for managing
its clinical and advisory activities relating to the prevention,
diagnosis and treatment of haemolytic disease of the newborn
(HDN).
G.4.4 The BE shall prepare specific informative documents and
procedures governing home transfusions.
G.4.1
M
TI
APPLICATION GUIDELINES
For transfusion and infusion treatments, the BE shall guarantee the
systematic application of its hospital management’s guidelines, where
available and applicable.
©
SI
For transfusions and infusions of medicinal products (plasma derivatives,
recombinant coagulation factors, growth factors, etc), in addition to the guidelines
in Standard G.2.1.2, the BE shall guarantee the adoption of any available and
applicable guidelines issued by its hospital management, particularly relating to
the appropriate use of blood components and plasma derivatives as defined by
the hospital transfusion committees on which the BE is institutionally required to
serve.
193
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
G.4.2
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures for managing
therapeutic apheresis activities.
Se
rv
iz
i
The BE shall guarantee the adoption of specific procedures defining the
organisational and working methods for managing therapeutic apheresis activities
in the area it serves, which shall be shared with other interested healthcare areas,
and which shall take into account:
a) the needs of the healthcare areas served by the BE;
b) the availability of staff at the BE, particularly concerning the feasibility of
implementing procedures 7 days a week;
c) the technological equipment available at the BE;
d) the structural and logistic conditions at the BE, particularly concerning the
feasibility of ensuring any necessary emergency treatment during the
procedure.
The clinical conditions of patients requiring apheretic treatments sometimes imply
that the treatment has to be started without delay, particularly for certain diseases
for which this is considered the elective treatment (e.g. acute polyradiculoneuritis
and thrombotic microangiopathies). The BE shall consequently guarantee that
therapeutic apheresis procedures are implemented within a period of time judged
appropriate, case by case, to avoid any delays having a negative fallout on the
efficacy of the treatment.
M
TI
For said purpose, the BE shall define the amount of time allowable between
receiving a request and completing the assessment of its clinical appropriateness/
feasibility, and between receiving a request and implementing the therapeutic
apheresis procedure, in agreement with the healthcare areas it serves. This time
interval shall be defined in relation to the disease to treat, its state of progression
and the patient’s clinical conditions at the time.
SI
Where organisational and/or logistic conditions prevent the systematic performance
of therapeutic apheresis procedures within an acceptable period of time, the BE
should adopt appropriate alternative organisational methods with the cooperation
of other BE(s).
©
All therapeutic apheresis procedures shall be conducted under the responsibility
and supervision of a TM physician at the BE, who shall be on hand and ready to
take timely action at the request of the nursing personnel.
The practical performance of therapeutic apheresis procedures and patient care
before, during and after said procedures shall be entrusted to adequately trained
nurses, particularly concerning the handling of the equipment, the procedural
methods and the clinical emergencies potentially associated with said treatments.
194
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
G.4.3
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures for managing its
clinical and advisory activities relating to the prevention, diagnosis and
treatment of haemolytic disease of the newborn (HDN).
The patient care and diagnostic-therapeutic activities for the prevention, diagnosis
and treatment of HDN should be defined by a multidisciplinary team representing
the parties involved (obstetricians, paediatricians, TM specialists, and any others).
iz
i
Where these activities are not defined or need revision or updating, the BE should
be proactive in ensuring that they are defined, revised or updated and effectively
implemented.
Se
rv
The BE shall define and adopt specific procedures for managing its clinical and
advisory activities relating to the prevention, diagnosis and treatment of HDN,
in addition to the content of Section E - Laboratory diagnostic activities in this
manual, as regards the diagnostic activities.
In compliance with current legislation, the BE shall guarantee the maintenance
of a register of the women requiring prophylactic treatment with anti-D
immunoglobulins within 72 hours of delivery. Postnatal prophylaxis and/or any
antenatal prophylaxis should be documented in the same register.
M
TI
Patients given prophylactic treatment with anti-D immunoglobulins should be
followed up for 6 months, preferably recording their outcome in the same register.
SI
The patient care and diagnostic-therapeutic activities, and the BE’s organisational
and working methods should be defined and/or revised in the light of the
Raccomandazioni per la gestione della Malattia Emolitica del Neonato developed
by the SIMTI in co-operation with the Italian Gynaecology and Obstetrics Society
(SIGO), which include the essential technical and clinical recommendations on the
topic.
G.4.4
The BE shall prepare specific informative documents and procedures
governing home transfusions.
©
For some years there has been a growing tendency to provide patient care at
home as an alternative to hospitalisation, particularly for patients suffering from
malignancies; these patients are known to frequently need transfusions.
Transfusions at home are at potentially higher risk than transfusions in hospital,
because the therapeutic resources available (i.e. the services and technologies
for dealing with emergencies) are necessarily limited if any severe adverse events
occur.
For home transfusions, it is therefore particularly important to define specific
transfusion procedures capable of minimising the likelihood of clinically relevant
adverse events that, judging from available epidemiological evidence, are
attributable to human error in most cases.
195
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
For physicians and nurses performing home transfusions, the BE shall prepare and
provide explanatory documents and practical procedures designed to guarantee
the proper performance of all stages of the process and its adequate control.
M
TI
Se
rv
iz
i
In particular, detailed information and work instructions shall be provided on the
topics of:
a) the appropriate clinical use of blood components;
b) obtaining informed consent to transfusion treatments;
c) methods for compiling requests and identifying patients, and for the collection,
control and identification of biological samples;
d) methods for the collection, transportation and treatment of blood components;
e) the management of documents accompanying blood units and the unequivocal
association of a patient with a blood unit;
f) responsibilities for transfusion (which always lie with a physician);
g) methods for handling blood units and the related accessories; in the light of
current legislation on matters of personal safety;
h) working methods for performing the transfusion and providing patient care
during and after the procedure;
i) possible adverse events and their management, including the use of medicinal
products needed to deal with clinical emergencies;
j) disposal of empty containers and the related accessories in the light of current
legislation on matters of personal and environmental safety;
k) methods for notifying the BE of the performance of transfusions or for returning
blood unit(s) if a transfusion has not been administered.
G.5 PROCESS CONTROL INDICATORS
SI
To constantly monitor the quality of the products-services provided and the
compliance of the processes implemented with the established standards, the BE
shall guarantee the monitoring of at least the indicators listed in the following
table.
©
For the general criteria for planning quality monitoring activities, see Section AGeneral organisational requirements, Ch. A.7.1 Quality monitoring.
196
Reference
chapter:
Section G
/
G.2
G.2
G.2
G.3
G.3
G.4
N°
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
©
G.4.2
G.3.2.3
G.3.2.3.
G.2.1.4
G.2.1.6
G.2.1.3
G.2.1.2
/
Reference
standard:
Section G
Therapeutic apheresis
Collection
and management
of cord blood
Collection of cord blood
No. of adverse events out of No. of
treatments provided [data stratified
by type of treatment and adverse
event]
Treatments started within
established time limits
Adequacy of the cord blood
management process
at the BE
iz
i
No. of treatments started within the
established time limits out of No.
of treatments with an established
time limit [data stratified by type of
disorder and/or type of treatment]
No. of cord blood units validated at
6-12 month follow-up out of No. of
cord blood units stocked
Quality of cord blood collection No. of cord blood units collected with
at birth centres
an adequate cellularity out of No. of
cord blood units collected
Se
rv
Adverse events associated
with therapeutic treatments
Appropriateness
of requests for services
M
TI
Management of adverse
events associated with
therapeutic treatments
Assessment
of appropriateness
of requests for services
No. of inappropriate requests out of
No. of requests received
No. of guidelines adopted out of No.
of different disorders treated
SI
Application
Management
of diagnostic-therapeutic of clinical guidelines
activities
Process control indicator
No. of services provided a year [data
stratified by type of service]
Characteristic to monitor
Types and volumes
of activities
Clinical activities in TM
Activity
Società Italiana
di Medicina Trasfusionale
e Immunoematologia
Standards of Transfusion Medicine
Section G - Haemopoietic stem cell collection
and other clinical activities in Transfusion Medicine
2nd Edition
197
1
©
M
TI
SI
Se
rv
iz
i
iz
i
Se
rv
M
TI
SI
©
Printed in November 2012
Editor: SIMTI Servizi Srl, Via Desiderio 21, 20131 Milano - Italy
Printing: Grafica Briantea Srl, Usmate Velate (MI) - Italy
199
1
©
M
TI
SI
Se
rv
iz
i